Attached files

file filename
EX-12 - EX-12 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv12.htm
EX-24 - EX-24 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv24.htm
EX-21 - EX-21 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv21.htm
EX-23 - EX-23 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv23.htm
EX-31.2 - EX-31.2 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv31w2.htm
EX-32.1 - EX-32.1 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv32w1.htm
EX-31.1 - EX-31.1 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv31w1.htm
EX-32.2 - EX-32.2 - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCy80504exv32w2.htm
EXCEL - IDEA: XBRL DOCUMENT - PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP INCFinancial_Report.xls
Table of Contents

 
 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM 10-K
     
þ   Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
For the Fiscal Year Ended December 26, 2009
or
     
o   Transition report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (No Fee Required)
For the transition period from                      to                     
Commission file number 1-14893
The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
(Exact name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)
     
Incorporated in Delaware   13-4038356
(State or other Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization)   (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
     
One Pepsi Way, Somers, New York   10589
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip code)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (914) 767-6000
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
     
Title of Each Class   Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $.01 per share   New York Stock Exchange
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes þ No o
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes o No þ
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes þ No o
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Date File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes þ No o
     Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
             
Large accelerated filer þ   Accelerated filer o   Non-accelerated filer o   Smaller reporting company o
        (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes o No þ
     The number of shares of Common Stock and Class B Common Stock of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. outstanding as of February 12, 2010 was 221,798,326 and 100,000, respectively. The aggregate market value of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. Capital Stock held by non-affiliates of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. (assuming for the sole purpose of this calculation, that all executive officers and directors of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. are affiliates of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.) as of June 12, 2009 was $4,858,397,101 (based on the closing sale price of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.’s Capital Stock on that date as reported on the New York Stock Exchange).
     
Documents of Which Portions Are Incorporated by Reference   Parts of Form 10-K into Which Portion of Documents Are Incorporated
     
N/A   N/A
 
 


 

Table of Contents   The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
    Annual Report 2009
         
    3  
    3  
    10  
    15  
    15  
    15  
    15  
    16  
    16  
    19  
    20  
    83  
    83  
    83  
    83  
    84  
    85  
    85  
    88  
    122  
    124  
    127  
    128  
    128  
 
       
    129  
 
       
    130  
 
       
    132  
 EX-12
 EX-21
 EX-23
 EX-24
 EX-31.1
 EX-31.2
 EX-32.1
 EX-32.2
 EX-101 INSTANCE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 SCHEMA DOCUMENT
 EX-101 CALCULATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 LABELS LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 PRESENTATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 DEFINITION LINKBASE DOCUMENT

2


Table of Contents

PART I
ITEM 1.   BUSINESS
Introduction
          The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. (“PBG”) was incorporated in Delaware in January, 1999, as a wholly owned subsidiary of PepsiCo, Inc. (“PepsiCo”) to effect the separation of most of PepsiCo’s company-owned bottling businesses. PBG became a publicly traded company on March 31, 1999. As of January 22, 2010, PepsiCo’s ownership represented 31.6% of the outstanding common stock and 100% of the outstanding Class B common stock, together representing 38.6% of the voting power of all classes of PBG’s voting stock. PepsiCo also owned approximately 6.6% of the equity interest of Bottling Group, LLC, PBG’s principal operating subsidiary, as of January 22, 2010. When used in this Report, “PBG,” “we,” “us,” “our” and the “Company” each refers to The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and, where appropriate, to Bottling Group, LLC, which we also refer to as “Bottling LLC.”
          On August 3, 2009, we entered into a merger agreement with PepsiCo and Pepsi-Cola Metropolitan Bottling Company, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of PepsiCo (“Metro”), pursuant to which we will merge with and into Metro, with Metro continuing as the surviving company and a wholly owned subsidiary of PepsiCo. Under the terms of the merger agreement, PepsiCo will acquire all outstanding shares of PBG common stock it does not already own for the price of $36.50 in cash or 0.6432 shares of PepsiCo common stock, subject to proration such that the aggregate consideration to be paid to PBG shareholders shall be 50 percent in cash and 50 percent in PepsiCo common stock. At a special meeting of our shareholders held on February 17, 2010, our shareholders adopted the merger agreement. The transaction is subject to certain regulatory approvals and is expected to be finalized by the end of the first quarter of 2010.
          PBG operates in one industry, carbonated soft drinks and other ready-to-drink beverages, and all of our segments derive revenue from these products. We conduct business in all or a portion of the United States, Mexico, Canada, Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey. PBG manages and reports operating results through three reportable segments: U.S. & Canada, Europe (which includes Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey) and Mexico. Operationally, the Company is organized along geographic lines with specific regional management teams having responsibility for the financial results in each reportable segment.
          In 2009, approximately 78% of our net revenues were generated in the U.S. & Canada, 13% of our net revenues were generated in Europe, and the remaining 9% of our net revenues were generated in Mexico. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Note 13 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information regarding the business and operating results of our reportable segments.
Principal Products
          PBG is the world’s largest manufacturer, seller and distributor of Pepsi-Cola beverages. In addition, in some of our territories we have the right to manufacture, sell and distribute soft drink products of companies other than PepsiCo, including Dr Pepper, Crush and Squirt. We also have the right in some of our territories to manufacture, sell and distribute beverages under trademarks that we own, including Electropura, e-pura and Garci Crespo. The majority of our volume is derived from brands licensed from PepsiCo or PepsiCo joint ventures.
          We have the exclusive right to manufacture, sell and distribute Pepsi-Cola beverages in all or a portion of 42 states and the District of Columbia in the United States, nine Canadian provinces, Spain, Greece, Russia, Turkey and 23 states in Mexico.

3


Table of Contents

          In 2009, approximately 76% of our sales volume in the U.S. & Canada was derived from carbonated soft drinks and the remaining 24% was derived from non-carbonated beverages, 69% of our sales volume in Europe was derived from carbonated soft drinks and the remaining 31% was derived from non-carbonated beverages, and 53% of our Mexico sales volume was derived from carbonated soft drinks and the remaining 47% was derived from non-carbonated beverages. Our principal beverage brands include the following:
         
U.S. & Canada
Pepsi
  Sierra Mist   Lipton
Diet Pepsi
  Sierra Mist Free   SoBe
Diet Pepsi Max
  Aquafina   SoBe Adrenaline Rush
Wild Cherry Pepsi
  Aquafina FlavorSplash   SoBe Lifewater
Pepsi Lime
  G2 from Gatorade   Starbucks Frappuccino®
Pepsi ONE
  Propel   Dole
Mountain Dew
  Crush   Muscle Milk
Diet Mountain Dew
  Tropicana juice drinks   Rockstar
Amp Energy
  Mug Root Beer    
Mountain Dew Code Red
  Trademark Dr Pepper    
 
       
Europe
       
Pepsi
  Tropicana   Fruko
Pepsi Light
  Aqua Minerale   Yedigun
Pepsi Max
  Mirinda   Tamek
7UP
  IVI   Lipton
KAS
  Fiesta    
 
       
Mexico
       
Pepsi
  Mirinda   Electropura
Pepsi Light
  Manzanita Sol   e-pura
7UP
  Squirt   Jarritos
KAS
  Garci Crespo   Lipton
Belight
  Aguas Frescas   Sangria Casera
          No individual customer accounted for 10% or more of our total revenues in 2009, except for sales to Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. and its affiliated companies which accounted for 11% of our revenues in 2009, primarily as a result of transactions in the U.S. & Canada segment. We have an extensive direct store distribution system in the United States, Canada and Mexico. In Europe, we use a combination of direct store distribution and distribution through wholesalers, depending on local marketplace considerations.
Raw Materials and Other Supplies
          We purchase the concentrates to manufacture Pepsi-Cola beverages and other beverage products from PepsiCo and other beverage companies.
          In addition to concentrates, we purchase various ingredients, packaging materials and energy such as sweeteners, glass and plastic bottles, cans, closures, syrup containers, other packaging materials, carbon dioxide, some finished goods, electricity, natural gas and motor fuel. We generally purchase our raw materials, other than concentrates, from multiple suppliers. PepsiCo acts as our agent for the purchase of such raw materials in the United States and Canada and, with respect to some of our raw materials, in certain of our international markets. The Pepsi beverage agreements, as described below, provide that, with respect to the beverage products of PepsiCo, all authorized containers, closures, cases, cartons and other packages and labels may be purchased only from manufacturers approved by PepsiCo. There are no materials or supplies used by PBG that are currently in short supply. The supply or cost of specific materials could be adversely affected by various factors, including price changes, economic conditions, strikes, weather conditions and governmental controls.
Franchise and Venture Agreements
          We conduct our business primarily under agreements with PepsiCo. These agreements give us the exclusive right to market, distribute, and produce beverage products of PepsiCo in authorized containers and to use the related trade names and trademarks in specified territories.
          Set forth below is a description of the Pepsi beverage agreements and other bottling agreements to which we are a party.

4


Table of Contents

          Terms of the Master Bottling Agreement. The Master Bottling Agreement under which we manufacture, package, sell and distribute the cola beverages bearing the Pepsi-Cola and Pepsi trademarks in the United States was entered into in March of 1999. The Master Bottling Agreement gives us the exclusive and perpetual right to distribute cola beverages for sale in specified territories in authorized containers of the nature currently used by us. The Master Bottling Agreement provides that we will purchase our entire requirements of concentrates for the cola beverages from PepsiCo at prices, and on terms and conditions, determined from time to time by PepsiCo. PepsiCo may determine from time to time what types of containers to authorize for use by us. PepsiCo has no rights under the Master Bottling Agreement with respect to the prices at which we sell our products.
          Under the Master Bottling Agreement we are obligated to:
  (1)   maintain such plant and equipment, staff, distribution facilities and vending equipment that are capable of manufacturing, packaging, and distributing the cola beverages in sufficient quantities to fully meet the demand for these beverages in our territories;
 
  (2)   undertake adequate quality control measures prescribed by PepsiCo;
 
  (3)   push vigorously the sale of the cola beverages in our territories;
 
  (4)   increase and fully meet the demand for the cola beverages in our territories;
 
  (5)   use all approved means and spend such funds on advertising and other forms of marketing beverages as may be reasonably required to push vigorously the sale of cola beverages in our territories; and
 
  (6)   maintain such financial capacity as may be reasonably necessary to assure performance under the Master Bottling Agreement by us.
          The Master Bottling Agreement requires us to meet annually with PepsiCo to discuss plans for the ensuing year and the following two years. At such meetings, we are obligated to present plans that set out in reasonable detail our marketing plan, our management plan and advertising plan with respect to the cola beverages for the year. We must also present a financial plan showing that we have the financial capacity to perform our duties and obligations under the Master Bottling Agreement for that year, as well as sales, marketing, advertising and capital expenditure plans for the two years following such year. PepsiCo has the right to approve such plans, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld. In 2009, PepsiCo approved our plans.
          If we carry out our annual plan in all material respects, we will be deemed to have satisfied our obligations to push vigorously the sale of the cola beverages, increase and fully meet the demand for the cola beverages in our territories and maintain the financial capacity required under the Master Bottling Agreement. Failure to present a plan or carry out approved plans in all material respects would constitute an event of default that, if not cured within 120 days of notice of the failure, would give PepsiCo the right to terminate the Master Bottling Agreement.
          If we present a plan that PepsiCo does not approve, such failure shall constitute a primary consideration for determining whether we have satisfied our obligations to maintain our financial capacity, push vigorously the sale of the cola beverages and increase and fully meet the demand for the cola beverages in our territories.
          If we fail to carry out our annual plan in all material respects in any segment of our territory, whether defined geographically or by type of market or outlet, and if such failure is not cured within six months of notice of the failure, PepsiCo may reduce the territory covered by the Master Bottling Agreement by eliminating the territory, market or outlet with respect to which such failure has occurred.
          PepsiCo has no obligation to participate with us in advertising and marketing spending, but it may contribute to such expenditures and undertake independent advertising and marketing activities, as well as cooperative advertising and sales promotion programs that would require our cooperation and support. Although PepsiCo has advised us that it intends to continue to provide cooperative advertising funds, it is not obligated to do so under the Master Bottling Agreement.
          The Master Bottling Agreement provides that PepsiCo may in its sole discretion reformulate any of the cola beverages or discontinue them, with some limitations, so long as all cola beverages are not discontinued. PepsiCo may also introduce new beverages under the Pepsi-Cola trademarks or any modification thereof. When that occurs, we are obligated to manufacture, package, distribute and sell such new beverages with the same obligations as then exist with respect to other cola beverages. We are prohibited from producing or handling cola products, other than those of PepsiCo, or products or packages that imitate, infringe or cause confusion with the products, containers or trademarks of PepsiCo. The Master Bottling Agreement also imposes requirements with respect to the use of PepsiCo’s trademarks, authorized containers, packaging and labeling.

5


Table of Contents

          If we acquire control, directly or indirectly, of any bottler of cola beverages, we must cause the acquired bottler to amend its bottling appointments for the cola beverages to conform to the terms of the Master Bottling Agreement. Under the Master Bottling Agreement, PepsiCo has agreed not to withhold approval for any acquisition of rights to manufacture and sell Pepsi trademarked cola beverages within a specific area — currently representing approximately 10.3% of PepsiCo’s U.S. bottling system in terms of volume — if we have successfully negotiated the acquisition and, in PepsiCo’s reasonable judgment, satisfactorily performed our obligations under the Master Bottling Agreement. We have agreed not to acquire or attempt to acquire any rights to manufacture and sell Pepsi trademarked cola beverages outside of that specific area without PepsiCo’s prior written approval.
          The Master Bottling Agreement is perpetual, but may be terminated by PepsiCo in the event of our default. Events of default include:
  (1)   our insolvency, bankruptcy, dissolution, receivership or the like;
 
  (2)   any disposition of any voting securities of one of our bottling subsidiaries or substantially all of our bottling assets without the consent of PepsiCo;
 
  (3)   our entry into any business other than the business of manufacturing, selling or distributing non-alcoholic beverages or any business which is directly related and incidental to such beverage business; and
 
  (4)   any material breach under the contract that remains uncured for 120 days after notice by PepsiCo.
          An event of default will also occur if any person or affiliated group acquires any contract, option, conversion privilege, or other right to acquire, directly or indirectly, beneficial ownership of more than 15% of any class or series of our voting securities without the consent of PepsiCo. As of February 12, 2010, to our knowledge, no shareholder of PBG, other than PepsiCo, held more than 5% of our common stock.
          We are prohibited from assigning, transferring or pledging the Master Bottling Agreement, or any interest therein, whether voluntarily, or by operation of law, including by merger or liquidation, without the prior consent of PepsiCo.
          The Master Bottling Agreement was entered into by us in the context of our separation from PepsiCo and, therefore, its provisions were not the result of arm’s-length negotiations. Consequently, the agreement contains provisions that are less favorable to us than the exclusive bottling appointments for cola beverages currently in effect for independent bottlers in the United States.
          Terms of the Non-Cola Bottling Agreements. The beverage products covered by the non-cola bottling agreements are beverages licensed to us by PepsiCo, including Mountain Dew, Aquafina, Sierra Mist, Diet Mountain Dew, Mug Root Beer and Mountain Dew Code Red. The non-cola bottling agreements contain provisions that are similar to those contained in the Master Bottling Agreement with respect to pricing, territorial restrictions, authorized containers, planning, quality control, transfer restrictions, term and related matters. Our non-cola bottling agreements will terminate if PepsiCo terminates our Master Bottling Agreement. The exclusivity provisions contained in the non-cola bottling agreements would prevent us from manufacturing, selling or distributing beverage products that imitate, infringe upon, or cause confusion with, the beverage products covered by the non-cola bottling agreements. PepsiCo may also elect to discontinue the manufacture, sale or distribution of a non-cola beverage and terminate the applicable non-cola bottling agreement upon six months notice to us.
          Terms of Certain Distribution Agreements. We also have agreements with PepsiCo granting us exclusive rights to distribute AMP and Dole in all of our territories, SoBe in certain specified territories and Gatorade and G2 in certain specified channels. The distribution agreements contain provisions generally similar to those in the Master Bottling Agreement as to use of trademarks, trade names, approved containers and labels and causes for termination. We also have the right to sell Tropicana juice drinks in the United States and Canada, Tropicana juices in Russia and Spain, and Gatorade in Spain, Greece and Russia and in certain limited channels of distribution in the United States and Canada. Some of these beverage agreements have limited terms and, in most instances, prohibit us from dealing in similar beverage products.
          Terms of the Master Syrup Agreement. The Master Syrup Agreement grants us the exclusive right to manufacture, sell and distribute fountain syrup to local customers in our territories. We have agreed to act as a manufacturing and delivery agent for national accounts within our territories that specifically request direct delivery without using a middleman. In addition, PepsiCo may appoint us to manufacture and deliver fountain syrup to national accounts that elect delivery through independent distributors. Under the Master Syrup Agreement, we have the exclusive right to service fountain equipment for all of the national account customers within our territories. The Master Syrup Agreement provides that the determination of whether an account is local or national is at the sole discretion of PepsiCo.

6


Table of Contents

          The Master Syrup Agreement contains provisions that are similar to those contained in the Master Bottling Agreement with respect to concentrate pricing, territorial restrictions with respect to local customers and national customers electing direct-to-store delivery only, planning, quality control, transfer restrictions and related matters. The Master Syrup Agreement had an initial term of five years which expired in 2004 and has thereafter automatically renewed for two additional five-year periods, including the most recent renewal in 2009. The Master Syrup Agreement will automatically renew for additional five-year periods, unless PepsiCo terminates it for cause. PepsiCo has the right to terminate the Master Syrup Agreement without cause at any time upon twenty-four months notice. In the event PepsiCo terminates the Master Syrup Agreement without cause, PepsiCo is required to pay us the fair market value of our rights thereunder. Our Master Syrup Agreement will terminate if PepsiCo terminates our Master Bottling Agreement.
          Terms of Other U.S. Bottling Agreements. The bottling agreements between us and other licensors of beverage products, including Dr Pepper Snapple Group for Dr Pepper, Crush, Schweppes, Canada Dry, Hawaiian Punch and Squirt, the Pepsi/Lipton Tea Partnership for Lipton Brisk and Lipton Iced Tea, and the North American Coffee Partnership for Starbucks Frappuccino®, contain provisions generally similar to those in the Master Bottling Agreement as to use of trademarks, trade names, approved containers and labels, sales of imitations and causes for termination. Some of these beverage agreements have limited terms and, in most instances, prohibit us from dealing in similar beverage products. The agreements with Dr Pepper Snapple Group contain a provision that permits the Dr Pepper Snapple Group to terminate the agreements in the event of a sale of more than 10% of our stock. Because the pending PepsiCo merger would trigger this provision, PepsiCo and Dr Pepper Snapple Group have entered into new bottling agreements that will be effective upon closing of the merger.
          Terms of the Country-Specific Bottling Agreements. The country-specific bottling agreements contain provisions generally similar to those contained in the Master Bottling Agreement and the non-cola bottling agreements and, in Canada, the Master Syrup Agreement with respect to authorized containers, planning, quality control, transfer restrictions, term, causes for termination and related matters. These bottling agreements differ from the Master Bottling Agreement because, except for Canada, they include both fountain syrup and non-fountain beverages. Certain of these bottling agreements contain provisions that have been modified to reflect the laws and regulations of the applicable country. For example, the bottling agreements in Spain do not contain a restriction on the sale and shipment of Pepsi-Cola beverages into our territory by others in response to unsolicited orders. In addition, in Mexico and Turkey we are restricted in our ability to manufacture, sell and distribute beverages sold under non-PepsiCo trademarks.
          Terms of the Russia Venture Agreement. In 2007, PBG together with PepsiCo formed PR Beverages Limited (“PR Beverages”), a venture that enables us to strategically invest in Russia to accelerate our growth. We contributed our business in Russia to PR Beverages, and PepsiCo entered into bottling agreements with PR Beverages for PepsiCo beverage products sold in Russia on the same terms as in effect for us immediately prior to the venture. PepsiCo also granted PR Beverages an exclusive license to manufacture and sell the concentrate for such products.
          Terms of Russia Snack Food Distribution Agreement. Effective January 2009, PR Beverages entered into an agreement with Frito-Lay Manufacturing, LLC (“FLM”), a wholly owned subsidiary of PepsiCo, pursuant to which PR Beverages purchases Frito-Lay snack products from FLM for sale and distribution in the Russian Federation. This agreement provides FLM access to the infrastructure of our distribution network in Russia and allows us to more effectively utilize some of our distribution network assets. This agreement replaced a similar agreement, which expired on December 31, 2008.
Seasonality
          Sales of our products are seasonal, particularly in our Europe segment, where sales volumes tend to be more sensitive to weather conditions. Our peak season across all of our segments is the warm summer months beginning in May and ending in September. More than 70% of our operating income is typically earned during the second and third quarters and more than 80% of cash flow from operations is typically generated in the third and fourth quarters.
Competition
          The carbonated soft drink market and the non-carbonated beverage market are highly competitive. Our competitors in these markets include bottlers and distributors of nationally advertised and marketed products, bottlers and distributors of regionally advertised and marketed products, as well as bottlers of private label soft drinks sold in chain stores. Among our major competitors are bottlers that distribute products from The Coca-Cola Company including Coca-Cola Enterprises Inc., Coca-Cola Hellenic Bottling Company S.A., Coca-Cola FEMSA S.A. de C.V. and Coca-Cola Bottling Co. Consolidated.
          Our market share for carbonated soft drinks sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo in our U.S. territories ranges from approximately 23% to approximately 43%. Our market share for carbonated soft drinks sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo for each country outside the United States in which we do business is as follows: Canada 46%; Russia 17%; Turkey 18%; Spain

7


Table of Contents

10% and Greece 14% (including market share for our IVI brand). In addition, market share for our territories and the territories of other Pepsi bottlers in Mexico is 16% for carbonated soft drinks sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo.
          Our market share for liquid refreshment beverages sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo in our U.S. territories is approximately 26%. Our market share for liquid refreshment beverages sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo for each country outside the United States in which we do business is as follows: Canada 23%; Russia 21%; Turkey 17%; Spain 7% and Greece 11% (including market share for our IVI brand). In addition, market share for our territories and the territories of other Pepsi bottlers in Mexico is 18% for liquid refreshment beverage sold under trademarks owned by PepsiCo.
          All market share figures are based on generally available data published by third parties. Actions by our major competitors and others in the beverage industry, as well as the general economic environment, could have an impact on our future market share.
          We compete primarily on the basis of advertising and marketing programs to create brand awareness, price and promotions, retail space management, customer service, consumer points of access, new products, packaging innovations and distribution methods. We believe that brand recognition, market place pricing, consumer value, customer service, availability and consumer and customer goodwill are primary factors affecting our competitive position.
Governmental Regulation Applicable to PBG
          Our operations and properties are subject to regulation by various federal, state and local governmental entities and agencies in the United States as well as foreign governmental entities and agencies in Canada, Spain, Greece, Russia, Turkey and Mexico. As a producer of food products, we are subject to production, packaging, quality, labeling and distribution standards in each of the countries where we have operations, including, in the United States, those of the Federal Food, Drug and Cosmetic Act and the Public Health Security and Bioterrorism Preparedness and Response Act. The operations of our production and distribution facilities are subject to laws and regulations relating to the protection of our employees’ health and safety and the environment in the countries in which we do business. In the United States, we are subject to the laws and regulations of various governmental entities, including the Department of Labor, the Environmental Protection Agency and the Department of Transportation, and various federal, state and local occupational, labor and employment and environmental laws. These laws and regulations include the Occupational Safety and Health Act, the Clean Air Act, the Clean Water Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, the Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act, the Federal Motor Carrier Safety Act and the Fair Labor Standards Act.
          We believe that our current legal, operational and environmental compliance programs are adequate and that we are in substantial compliance with applicable laws and regulations of the countries in which we do business. We do not anticipate making any material expenditures in connection with environmental remediation and compliance. However, compliance with, or any violation of, future laws or regulations could require material expenditures by us or otherwise have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
          Bottle and Can Legislation. Legislation has been enacted in certain U.S. states and Canadian provinces where we operate that generally prohibits the sale of certain beverages in non-refillable containers unless a deposit or levy is charged for the container. These include California, Connecticut, Delaware, Hawaii, Iowa, Maine, Massachusetts, Michigan, New York, Oregon, British Columbia, Alberta, Saskatchewan, Manitoba, New Brunswick, Nova Scotia and Quebec.
          Connecticut, Massachusetts, Michigan and New York have statutes that require us to pay all or a portion of unclaimed container deposits to the state. Hawaii and California impose a levy on beverage containers to fund a waste recovery system.
          In addition to the Canadian deposit legislation described above, Ontario, Canada currently has a regulation requiring that at least 30% of all soft drinks sold in Ontario be bottled in refillable containers.
          The European Commission issued a packaging and packing waste directive that was incorporated into the national legislation of most member states. This has resulted in targets being set for the recovery and recycling of household, commercial and industrial packaging waste and imposes substantial responsibilities upon bottlers and retailers for implementation. Similar legislation has been enacted in Turkey.
          Mexico adopted legislation regulating the disposal of solid waste products. In response to this legislation, PBG Mexico maintains agreements with local and federal Mexican governmental authorities as well as with civil associations, which require PBG Mexico, and other participating bottlers, to provide for collection and recycling of certain minimum amounts of plastic bottles.

8


Table of Contents

          We are not aware of similar material legislation being enacted in any other areas served by us. The recent economic downturn, however, has resulted in reduced tax revenue for many states and has increased the need for some states to identify new revenue sources. Some states may pursue additional revenue through new or amended bottle and can legislation. We are unable to predict, however, whether such legislation will be enacted or what impact its enactment would have on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
          Soft Drink Excise Tax Legislation. Specific soft drink excise taxes have been in place in certain states for several years. The states in which we operate that currently impose such a tax are West Virginia and Arkansas and, with respect to fountain syrup only, Washington.
          Value-added taxes on soft drinks vary in our territories located in Canada, Spain, Greece, Russia, Turkey and Mexico, but are consistent with the value-added tax rate for other consumer products. In addition, there is a special consumption tax applicable to cola products in Turkey. In Mexico, bottled water in containers over 10.1 liters are exempt from value-added tax, and we obtained a tax exemption for containers holding less than 10.1 liters of water. The tax exemption currently also applies to non-carbonated soft drinks.
          We are not aware of any material soft drink taxes that have been enacted in any other market served by us. The recent economic downturn, however, has resulted in reduced tax revenue for many states and has increased the need for some states to identify new revenue sources. Some states may pursue additional revenue through new or amended soft drink or similar excise tax legislation. We are unable to predict, however, whether such legislation will be enacted or what impact its enactment would have on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
          New York State Governor, David Paterson, has included a recommendation in his 2011 proposed budget that essentially would place a one cent per ounce tax on sweetened beverages sold in that state. Whether such tax will be enacted is unknown at this point. A similar proposal was included in the 2010 proposed budget, but was withdrawn before legislative consideration due to strong public and political opposition.
          Trade Regulation. As a manufacturer, seller and distributor of bottled and canned soft drink products of PepsiCo and other soft drink manufacturers in exclusive territories in the United States and internationally, we are subject to antitrust and competition laws. Under the Soft Drink Interbrand Competition Act, soft drink bottlers operating in the United States, such as us, may have an exclusive right to manufacture, distribute and sell a soft drink product in a geographic territory if the soft drink product is in substantial and effective competition with other products of the same class in the same market or markets. We believe that there is such substantial and effective competition in each of the exclusive geographic territories in which we operate.
          School Sales Legislation; Industry Guidelines. In 2004, the U.S. Congress passed the Child Nutrition Act, which required school districts to implement a school wellness policy by July 2006. In May 2006, members of the American Beverage Association, the Alliance for a Healthier Generation, the American Heart Association and The William J. Clinton Foundation entered into a memorandum of understanding that sets forth standards for what beverages can be sold in elementary, middle and high schools in the United States (the “ABA Policy”). Also, the beverage associations in the European Union and Canada have recently issued guidelines relating to the sale of beverages in schools. We intend to comply fully with the ABA Policy and these guidelines. In addition, legislation has been proposed in Mexico that would restrict the sale of certain high-calorie products, including soft drinks, in schools and that would require these products to include a label that warns consumers that consumption abuse may lead to obesity.
          California Carcinogen and Reproductive Toxin Legislation. A California law requires that any person who exposes another to a carcinogen or a reproductive toxin must provide a warning to that effect. Because the law does not define quantitative thresholds below which a warning is not required, virtually all manufacturers of food products are confronted with the possibility of having to provide warnings due to the presence of trace amounts of defined substances. Regulations implementing the law exempt manufacturers from providing the required warning if it can be demonstrated that the defined substances occur naturally in the product or are present in municipal water used to manufacture the product. We have assessed the impact of the law and its implementing regulations on our beverage products and have concluded that none of our products currently requires a warning under the law. We cannot predict whether or to what extent food industry efforts to minimize the law’s impact on food products will succeed. We also cannot predict what impact, either in terms of direct costs or diminished sales, imposition of the law may have.
          Mexican Water Regulation. In Mexico, we pump water from our own wells and we purchase water directly from municipal water companies pursuant to concessions obtained from the Mexican government on a plant-by-plant basis. The concessions are generally for ten-year terms and can generally be renewed by us prior to expiration with minimal cost and effort. Our concessions may be terminated if, among other things, (a) we use materially more water than permitted by the concession, (b) we use materially less water than required by the concession, (c) we fail to pay for the rights for water usage or (d) we carry out, without governmental authorization, any material construction on or improvement to, our wells. Our concessions generally satisfy our current water requirements and we believe that we are generally in compliance in all material respects with the terms of our existing concessions.

9


Table of Contents

Employees
          As of December 26, 2009, we employed approximately 64,900 workers, of whom approximately 32,500 were employed in the United States. Approximately 8,500 of our workers in the United States are union members and approximately 15,100 of our workers outside the United States are union members. We consider relations with our employees to be good and have not experienced significant interruptions of operations due to labor disagreements.
Available Information
          We maintain a website at www.pbg.com. We make available, free of charge, through the Investor Relations — Financial Information — SEC Filings section of our website, our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as soon as reasonably practicable after such reports are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”).
          Additionally, we have made available, free of charge, the following governance materials on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance: Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws, Corporate Governance Principles and Practices, Worldwide Code of Conduct (including any amendment thereto), Director Independence Policy, the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee Charter, the Compensation and Management Development Committee Charter, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee Charter, the Disclosure Committee Charter and the Policy and Procedures Governing Related-Person Transactions. These governance materials are available in print, free of charge, to any PBG shareholder upon request.
Financial Information on Industry Segments and Geographic Areas
          We operate in one industry, carbonated soft drinks and other ready-to-drink beverages, and all of our segments derive revenue from these products. PBG has three reportable segments: U.S. & Canada, Europe (which includes Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey) and Mexico. Operationally, the Company is organized along geographic lines with specific regional management teams having responsibility for the financial results in each reportable segment.
          For additional information, see Note 13 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 7 below.
ITEM 1A.   RISK FACTORS
          Our business and operations entail a variety of risks and uncertainties, including those described below.
We may not be able to respond successfully to consumer trends related to carbonated and non-carbonated beverages.
          Consumer trends with respect to the products we sell are subject to change. Consumers are seeking increased variety in their beverages, and there is a growing interest among the public regarding the ingredients in our products, the attributes of those ingredients and health and wellness issues generally. This interest has resulted in a decline in consumer demand for carbonated soft drinks and an increase in consumer demand for products associated with health and wellness, such as water, enhanced water, teas and certain other non-carbonated beverages. Consumer preferences may change due to a variety of other factors, including the aging of the general population, changes in social trends, the real or perceived impact the manufacturing of our products has on the environment, changes in consumer demographics, changes in travel, vacation or leisure activity patterns, a downturn in economic conditions or taxes specifically targeting the consumption of our products. Any of these changes may reduce consumers’ demand for our products. For example, the recent downturn in economic conditions has adversely impacted sales of certain of our higher margin products, including our products sold for immediate consumption in restaurants.
          Because we rely mainly on PepsiCo to provide us with the products we sell, if PepsiCo fails to develop innovative products and packaging that respond to consumer trends, we could be put at a competitive disadvantage in the marketplace and our business and financial results could be adversely affected. In addition, PepsiCo is under no obligation to provide us distribution rights to all of its products in all of the channels in which we operate. If we are unable to enter into agreements with PepsiCo to distribute innovative products in all of these channels or otherwise gain broad access to products that respond to consumer trends, we could be put at a competitive disadvantage in the marketplace and our business and financial results could be adversely affected.
We may not be able to respond successfully to the demands of our largest customers.
          Our retail customers are consolidating, leaving fewer customers with greater overall purchasing power and, consequently, greater influence over our pricing, promotions and distribution methods. Because we do not operate in all markets in which these customers operate, we must rely on PepsiCo and other Pepsi bottlers to service such customers outside of our markets. The inability of

10


Table of Contents

PepsiCo or Pepsi bottlers as a whole to meet the product, packaging and service demands of our largest customers could lead to a loss or decrease in business from such customers and have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
Our business requires a significant supply of raw materials and energy, the limited availability or increased costs of which could adversely affect our business and financial results.
          The production and distribution of our beverage products is highly dependent on certain ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials, and energy. To produce our products, we require significant amounts of ingredients, such as beverage concentrate and high fructose corn syrup, as well as access to significant amounts of water. We also require significant amounts of packaging materials, such as aluminum and plastic bottle components, such as resin (a petroleum-based product). In addition, we use a significant amount of electricity, natural gas, motor fuel and other energy sources to operate our fleet of trucks and our bottling plants.
          If the suppliers of our ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials or energy are impacted by an increased demand for their products, business downturn, weather conditions (including those related to climate change), natural disasters, governmental regulation, terrorism, strikes or other events, and we are not able to effectively obtain the products from another supplier, we could incur an interruption in the supply of such products or increased costs of such products. Any sustained interruption in the supply of our ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials or energy, or increased costs thereof, could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
          The prices of some of our ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials and energy, including aluminum, resin, high fructose corn syrup and motor fuel, have recently experienced unprecedented volatility, which in turn can unpredictably and substantially alter our costs. We have implemented a hedging strategy to better predict our costs of some of these products. In a volatile market, however, such strategy includes a risk that, during a particular period of time, market prices fall below our hedged price and we pay higher than market prices for certain products. As a result, under certain circumstances, our hedging strategy may increase our overall costs.
          If there is a significant or sustained increase in the costs of our ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials or energy, and we are unable to pass effectively the increased costs on to our customers in the form of higher prices, there could be a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
Changes in the legal and regulatory environment, including those related to climate change, could increase our costs or liabilities or impact the sale of our products.
          Our operations and properties are subject to regulation by various federal, state and local governmental entities and agencies as well as foreign governmental entities. Such regulations relate to, among other things, food and drug laws, competition laws, labor laws, taxation requirements (including taxes specifically targeting the consumption of our products), bottle and can legislation (see above under “Governmental Regulation Applicable to PBG”), accounting standards and environmental laws.
          There is also growing support for the conclusion that emissions of greenhouse gases are linked to global climate change, which may result in more regional, federal and/or global legal and regulatory requirements to reduce or mitigate the effects of greenhouse gases. Until any such requirements come into effect, it is difficult to predict their impact on our business or financial results, including any impact on our supply chain costs. In the interim, we are working to improve our systems to record baseline data and monitor our greenhouse gas emissions and, during the process of developing our business strategies, we consider the impact our plans may have on the environment.
          We cannot assure you that we have been or will at all times be in compliance with all regulatory requirements or that we will not incur material costs or liabilities in connection with existing or new regulatory requirements, including those related to climate change.
Our pending merger with PepsiCo may cause disruption in our business and, if the pending merger does not occur, we will have incurred significant expenses and our stock price may decline.
          The announcement of our pending merger with PepsiCo, whether or not consummated, may result in a loss of key personnel and may disrupt our sales and operations, which may have an impact on our financial performance. The merger agreement generally requires us to operate our business in the ordinary course pending consummation of the merger, but includes certain contractual restrictions on the conduct of our business that may affect our ability to execute on our business strategies and attain our financial goals. Additionally, the announcement of the pending merger, whether or not consummated, may impact our relationships with third parties.

11


Table of Contents

          The completion of the pending merger is subject to certain conditions, including, among others (i) adoption of the merger agreement by our shareholders, (ii) the absence of certain legal impediments to the consummation of the pending merger, (iii) the expiration or termination of the applicable waiting period under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as amended (the “HSR Act”), and obtaining antitrust approvals in certain other jurisdictions, (iv) subject to certain materiality exceptions, the accuracy of the representations and warranties made by us and PepsiCo, respectively, and compliance by us and PepsiCo with our and their respective obligations under the merger agreement, (v) declaration of the effectiveness by the SEC of the Registration Statement on Form S-4/A filed by PepsiCo on January 12, 2010, and (vi) the non-occurrence of a Material Adverse Effect (as defined in the merger agreement) on PBG or PepsiCo. As of February 22, 2010, some of these closing conditions, such as adoption of the merger agreement by our shareholders, obtaining antitrust approval in jurisdictions outside the United States, and declaration of the effectiveness by the SEC of the Form S-4/A filed by PepsiCo, have been satisfied. Other closing conditions, however, remained unsatisfied as of February 22, 2010, including, but not limited to, the expiration or termination of the applicable waiting period under the HSR Act.
          If the merger agreement is terminated under certain circumstances, then we would be required to pay PepsiCo a termination fee of approximately $165 million. On November 16, 2009, in connection with the settlement of certain stockholder litigation, PepsiCo agreed, among other things, to reduce the termination fee to $115 million. Upon approval of the merger agreement by our shareholders on February 17, 2010, the circumstances under which we would be required to pay PepsiCo a termination fee ceased to exist.
          We cannot predict whether all of the closing conditions for the pending merger set forth in the merger agreement will be satisfied. As a result, we cannot assure you that the pending merger will be completed. If the closing conditions for the pending merger set forth in the merger agreement are not satisfied or waived pursuant to the merger agreement, or if the transaction is not completed for any other reason, the market price of our common stock may decline. In addition, if the pending merger does not occur, we will nonetheless remain liable for significant expenses that we have incurred related to the transaction.
          Additionally, we and members of our Board of Directors have been named in a number of lawsuits relating to the pending merger. The parties to these lawsuits entered into a settlement stipulation, which is subject to customary conditions, as more fully described in Note 18 “Contingencies” to our Consolidated Financial Statements.
          These matters, alone or in combination, could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
PepsiCo’s equity ownership of PBG could affect matters concerning us.
          As of January 22, 2010, PepsiCo owned approximately 38.6% of the combined voting power of our voting stock (with the balance owned by the public). PepsiCo will be able to significantly affect the outcome of PBG’s shareholder votes, thereby affecting matters concerning us.
Because we depend upon PepsiCo to provide us with concentrate, certain funding and various services, changes in our relationship with PepsiCo could adversely affect our business and financial results.
          We conduct our business primarily under beverage agreements with PepsiCo. If our beverage agreements with PepsiCo are terminated for any reason, it would have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. These agreements provide that we must purchase all of the concentrate for such beverages at prices and on other terms which are set by PepsiCo in its sole discretion. Any significant concentrate price increases could materially affect our business and financial results.
          PepsiCo has also traditionally provided bottler incentives and funding to its bottling operations. PepsiCo does not have to maintain or continue these incentives or funding. Termination or decreases in bottler incentives or funding levels could materially affect our business and financial results.
          Under our shared services agreement, we obtain various services from PepsiCo, including procurement of raw materials and certain administrative services. If any of the services under the shared services agreement were terminated, we would have to obtain such services on our own. This could result in a disruption of such services, and we might not be able to obtain these services on terms, including cost, that are as favorable as those we receive through PepsiCo.
We may have potential conflicts of interest with PepsiCo, which could result in PepsiCo’s objectives being favored over our objectives.
          Our past and ongoing relationship with PepsiCo could give rise to conflicts of interests. In addition, two members of our Board of Directors are executive officers of PepsiCo, and one of the three Managing Directors of Bottling LLC, our principal operating subsidiary, is an officer of PepsiCo, a situation which may create conflicts of interest.

12


Table of Contents

          These potential conflicts include balancing the objectives of increasing sales volume of PepsiCo beverages and maintaining or increasing our profitability. Other possible conflicts could relate to the nature, quality and pricing of services or products provided to us by PepsiCo or by us to PepsiCo.
          Conflicts could also arise in the context of our potential acquisition of bottling territories and/or assets from PepsiCo or other independent Pepsi bottlers. Under our Master Bottling Agreement with PepsiCo, we must obtain PepsiCo’s approval to acquire any independent Pepsi bottler. PepsiCo has agreed not to withhold approval for any acquisition within agreed-upon U.S. territories if we have successfully negotiated the acquisition and, in PepsiCo’s reasonable judgment, satisfactorily performed our obligations under the Master Bottling Agreement. We have agreed not to attempt to acquire any independent Pepsi bottler outside of those agreed-upon territories without PepsiCo’s prior written approval.
          In addition, we are subject to certain contractual restrictions on the conduct of our business pursuant to the terms of the merger agreement between us and PepsiCo, as more fully described in the risk factor above entitled “Our pending merger with PepsiCo may cause disruption in our business and, if the pending merger does not occur, we will have incurred significant expenses and our stock price may decline.”
Our acquisition strategy may be limited by our ability to successfully integrate acquired businesses into ours or our failure to realize our expected return on acquired businesses.
          We intend to continue to pursue acquisitions of bottling assets and territories from PepsiCo’s independent bottlers. The success of our acquisition strategy may be limited because of unforeseen costs and complexities. We may not be able to acquire, integrate successfully or manage profitably additional businesses without substantial costs, delays or other difficulties. Unforeseen costs and complexities may also prevent us from realizing our expected rate of return on an acquired business. Any of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
We may not be able to compete successfully within the highly competitive carbonated and non-carbonated beverage markets.
          The carbonated and non-carbonated beverage markets are highly competitive. Competitive pressures in our markets could cause us to reduce prices or forego price increases required to off-set increased costs of raw materials and fuel, increase capital and other expenditures, or lose market share, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
If we are unable to fund our substantial capital requirements, it could cause us to reduce our planned capital expenditures and could result in a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
          We require substantial capital expenditures to implement our business plans. If we do not have sufficient funds or if we are unable to obtain financing in the amounts desired or on acceptable terms, we may have to reduce our planned capital expenditures, which could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
The level of our indebtedness could adversely affect our financial health.
          The level of our indebtedness requires us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our debt. This could limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to competitors that have less debt. Our indebtedness also exposes us to interest rate fluctuations, because the interest on some of our indebtedness is at variable rates, and makes us vulnerable to general adverse economic and industry conditions. All of the above could make it more difficult for us, or make us unable to satisfy our obligations with respect to all or a portion of such indebtedness and could limit our ability to obtain additional financing for future working capital expenditures, strategic acquisitions and other general corporate requirements.
Deterioration of economic conditions could harm our business.
          Our business may be adversely affected by changes in national or global economic conditions, including inflation, interest rates, availability of capital markets, consumer spending rates, energy availability and costs (including fuel surcharges) and the effects of governmental initiatives to manage economic conditions. Any such changes could adversely affect the demand for our products or increase our costs, thereby negatively affecting our financial results.
          The recent deterioration of economic conditions, could, among other things, make it more difficult or costly for us to obtain financing for our operations or investments, adversely impact the credit worthiness of our customers or suppliers, and decrease the value of our investments in equity and debt securities, including our marketable debt securities and pension and other postretirement plan assets.

13


Table of Contents

Our foreign operations are subject to social, political and economic risks and may be adversely affected by foreign currency fluctuations.
          In the fiscal year ended December 26, 2009, approximately 30% of our net revenues were generated in territories outside the United States. Social, economic and political developments in our international markets (including Russia, Mexico, Canada, Spain, Turkey and Greece) may adversely affect our business and financial results. These developments may lead to new product pricing, tax or other policies and monetary fluctuations that may adversely impact our business and financial results. The overall risks to our international businesses also include changes in foreign governmental policies. In addition, we are expanding our investment and sales and marketing efforts in certain emerging markets, such as Russia. Expanding our business into emerging markets may present additional risks beyond those associated with more developed international markets. For example, Russia has been a significant source of our profit growth, but is now experiencing an economic downturn, which if sustained may have a material adverse impact on our business and financial results. Additionally, our cost of goods, our results of operations and the value of our foreign assets are affected by fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates. For example, the recent weakening of foreign currencies negatively impacted our earnings in 2009 compared with the prior year.
If we are unable to maintain brand image and product quality, or if we encounter other product issues such as product recalls, our business may suffer.
          Maintaining a good reputation globally is critical to our success. If we fail to maintain high standards for product quality, or if we fail to maintain high ethical, social and environmental standards for all of our operations and activities, our reputation could be jeopardized. In addition, we may be liable if the consumption of any of our products causes injury or illness, and we may be required to recall products if they become contaminated or are damaged or mislabeled. A significant product liability or other product-related legal judgment against us or a widespread recall of our products could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
Our success depends on key members of our management, the loss of whom could disrupt our business operations.
          Our success depends largely on the efforts and abilities of key management employees. Key management employees are not parties to employment agreements with us. The loss of the services of key personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
If we are unable to renew collective bargaining agreements on satisfactory terms, or if we experience strikes, work stoppages or labor unrest, our business may suffer.
          Approximately 30% of our U.S. and Canadian employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements. These agreements generally expire at various dates over the next five years. Our inability to successfully renegotiate these agreements could cause work stoppages and interruptions, which may adversely impact our operating results. The terms and conditions of existing or renegotiated agreements could also increase our costs or otherwise affect our ability to increase our operational efficiency.
Benefits cost increases could reduce our profitability or cash flow.
          Our profitability and cash flow is substantially affected by the costs of pension, postretirement medical and employee medical and other benefits. Recently, these costs have increased significantly due to factors such as fluctuations in investment returns on pension assets, changes in discount rates used to calculate pension and related liabilities, and increases in health care costs. Although we actively seek to control increases, there can be no assurance that we will succeed in limiting future cost increases, and continued upward pressure in these costs could have a material adverse affect on our business and financial performance.
Our failure to effectively manage our information technology infrastructure could disrupt our operations and negatively impact our business.
          We rely on information technology systems to process, transmit, store and protect electronic information. Additionally, a significant portion of the communications between our personnel, customers, and suppliers depends on information technology. If we do not effectively manage our information technology infrastructure, we could be subject to transaction errors, processing inefficiencies, the loss of customers, business disruptions and data security breaches.
Adverse weather conditions could reduce the demand for our products.
          Demand for our products is influenced to some extent by the weather conditions in the markets in which we operate. Weather conditions in these markets, such as unseasonably cool temperatures, could have a material adverse effect on our sales volume and financial results.

14


Table of Contents

Catastrophic events in the markets in which we operate could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition.
          Natural disasters, terrorism, pandemic, strikes or other catastrophic events could impair our ability to manufacture or sell our products. Failure to take adequate steps to mitigate the likelihood or potential impact of such events, or to manage such events effectively if they occur, could adversely affect our sales volume, cost of raw materials, earnings and financial results.
ITEM 1B.   UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
          None.
ITEM 2.   PROPERTIES
          Our corporate headquarters is located in leased property in Somers, New York. In addition, we have a total of 590 manufacturing and distribution facilities, as follows:
                         
    U.S. & Canada   Europe   Mexico
 
Manufacturing Facilities
                       
Owned
    50       15       22  
Leased
    2             3  
Other
    3              
 
Total
    55       15       25  
 
Distribution Facilities
                       
Owned
    222       11       81  
Leased
    51       55       75  
 
Total
    273       66       156  
 
          We also own or lease and operate approximately 37,100 vehicles, including delivery trucks, delivery and transport tractors and trailers and other trucks and vans used in the sale and distribution of our beverage products. We also own more than two million coolers, soft drink dispensing fountains and vending machines.
          With a few exceptions, leases of plants in the U.S. & Canada are on a long-term basis, expiring at various times, with options to renew for additional periods. Our leased facilities in Europe and Mexico are generally leased for varying and usually shorter periods, with or without renewal options. We believe that our properties are in good operating condition and are adequate to serve our current operational needs.
ITEM 3.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
          From time to time we are a party to various litigation proceedings arising in the ordinary course of our business, none of which, in the opinion of management, is likely to have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.
          For further information about our legal proceedings see Note 18 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, which discussion is incorporated herein by reference.
ITEM 4.   SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS
          None.

15


Table of Contents

PART II
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
          Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “PBG.” Our Class B common stock is not publicly traded. On February 12, 2010, the last sales price for our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange was $37.82 per share. The following table sets forth the intra-day high and low sales prices per share of our common stock during each of our fiscal quarters in 2009 and 2008.
                 
2009     High       Low  
 
First Quarter
  $23.76     $16.82  
Second Quarter
  $34.83     $19.59  
Third Quarter
  $36.57     $32.52  
Fourth Quarter
  $38.74     $36.02  
 
 
2008       High       Low  
 
First Quarter
  $42.02     $31.53  
Second Quarter
  $35.10     $30.40  
Third Quarter
  $31.97     $26.02  
Fourth Quarter
  $33.13     $15.78  
 
Shareholders
          As of February 5, 2010, there were approximately 47,893 registered and beneficial holders of our common stock. PepsiCo is the holder of all of our outstanding shares of Class B common stock.
Dividend Policy
          Quarterly cash dividends are usually declared in late January or early February, March, July and October and paid at the end of March, June, and September and at the beginning of January. The dividend record date for the first quarter of 2010 is March 5, 2010.
          We declared the following dividends on our common stock during fiscal years 2009 and 2008:
                 
Quarter     2009       2008  
 
1
  $.17     $.14  
2
  $.18     $.17  
3
  $.18     $.17  
4
  $.18     $.17  
 
Total
  $.71     $.65  
 

16


Table of Contents

Performance Graph
          The following performance graph compares the cumulative total return of our common stock to the Standard & Poor’s 500 Stock Index and to an index of peer companies selected by us (the “Bottling Group Index”). The Bottling Group Index consists of Coca-Cola Hellenic Bottling Company S.A., Coca-Cola Bottling Co. Consolidated, Coca-Cola Enterprises Inc., Coca-Cola FEMSA ADRs, and PepsiAmericas, Inc. The graph assumes the return on $100 invested on December 25, 2004 until December 26, 2009. The returns of each member of the Bottling Group Index are weighted according to each member’s stock market capitalization as of the beginning of the period measured and includes the subsequent reinvestment of dividends.
(PERFORMANCE GRAPH)
                                                 
    Year-ended
    2004   2005   2006   2007   2008   2009
 
PBG(1)
    100       108       118       154       87       152  
Bottling Group Index
    100       110       133       193       100       169  
S & P 500 Index
    100       105       122       129       78       103  
 
(1)   The closing price for a share of our common stock on December 24, 2009, the last trading day of our fiscal year, was $37.56.

17


Table of Contents

PBG Purchases of Equity Securities
          We did not repurchase shares in 2009. Since the inception of our share repurchase program in October 1999 and through the end of fiscal year 2009, approximately 146 million shares of PBG common stock have been repurchased. Our share repurchases for the fourth quarter of 2009 are as follows:
                                 
                            Maximum
                            Number (or
                    Total Number   Approximate
                    of Shares   Dollar Value)
                    (or Units)   of Shares
                    Purchased   (or Units)
    Total           as Part of   that May Yet
    Number   Average   Publicly   Be Purchased
    of Shares   Price Paid   Announced   Under the
    (or Units)   per Share   Plans or   Plans or
Period   Purchased(1)   (or Unit)(2)   Programs(3)   Programs(3)
 
Period 10
                               
09/06/09-10/03/09
                      28,540,400  
Period 11
                               
10/04/09-10/31/09
                      28,540,400  
Period 12
                               
11/01/09-11/28/09
                      28,540,400  
Period 13
                               
11/29/09-12/26/09
                      28,540,400  
 
Total
                         
         
 
(1)   Shares have only been repurchased through publicly announced programs.
 
(2)   Average share price excludes brokerage fees.
 
(3)   Our Board has authorized the repurchase of shares of our common stock on the open market and through negotiated transactions as follows:
         
    Number of Shares
Date Share Repurchase Programs   Authorized to be
were Publicly Announced   Repurchased
 
October 14, 1999
    20,000,000  
July 13, 2000
    10,000,000  
July 11, 2001
    20,000,000  
May 28, 2003
    25,000,000  
March 25, 2004
    25,000,000  
March 24, 2005
    25,000,000  
December 15, 2006
    25,000,000  
March 27, 2008
    25,000,000  
 
Total shares authorized to be repurchased as of December 26, 2009
    175,000,000  
 
          Unless terminated by resolution of our Board, each share repurchase program expires when we have repurchased all shares authorized for repurchase thereunder.

18


Table of Contents

ITEM 6.   SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
SELECTED FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA
in millions, except per share data
                                         
Fiscal years ended   2009(1)     2008(2)     2007(3)     2006(4)     2005(5)  
Statement of Operations Data:
                                       
Net revenues
  $ 13,219     $ 13,796     $ 13,591     $ 12,730     $ 11,885  
Cost of sales
    7,379       7,586       7,370       6,900       6,345  
 
                             
Gross profit
    5,840       6,210       6,221       5,830       5,540  
Selling, delivery and administrative expenses
    4,792       5,149       5,150       4,813       4,517  
Impairment charges
          412                    
 
                             
Operating income
    1,048       649       1,071       1,017       1,023  
Interest expense, net
    303       290       274       266       250  
Other non-operating (income) expenses, net
    (4 )     25       (6 )     11       1  
 
                             
Income before income taxes
    749       334       803       740       772  
Income tax expense (6) (7) (8)
    43       112       177       159       247  
 
                             
Net income
    706       222       626       581       525  
Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
    94       60       94       59       59  
 
                             
Net income attributable to PBG
  $ 612     $ 162     $ 532     $ 522     $ 466  
 
                             
Per Share Data Attributable to PBG’s Common Shareholders:
                                       
Basic earnings per share
  $ 2.84     $ 0.75     $ 2.35     $ 2.22     $ 1.91  
Diluted earnings per share
  $ 2.77     $ 0.74     $ 2.29     $ 2.16     $ 1.86  
Cash dividends declared per share
  $ 0.71     $ 0.65     $ 0.53     $ 0.41     $ 0.29  
Weighted-average basic shares outstanding
    216       216       226       236       243  
Weighted-average diluted shares outstanding
    221       220       233       242       250  
 
                                       
Other Financial Data:
                                       
Cash provided by operations
  $ 1,108     $ 1,284     $ 1,437     $ 1,228     $ 1,219  
Capital expenditures
  $ (556 )   $ (760 )   $ (854 )   $ (725 )   $ (715 )
Balance Sheet Data (at period end):
                                       
Total assets
  $ 13,570     $ 12,982     $ 13,115     $ 11,927     $ 11,524  
Long-term debt
  $ 5,449     $ 4,784     $ 4,770     $ 4,754     $ 3,939  
Noncontrolling interests
  $ 1,292     $ 1,148     $ 973     $ 540     $ 496  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss(9)
  $ (596 )   $ (938 )   $ (48 )   $ (361 )   $ (262 )
PBG shareholders’ equity
  $ 2,417     $ 1,343     $ 2,615     $ 2,084     $ 2,043  
 
(1)   Our fiscal year 2009 results include a $40 million pre-tax charge for advisory fees related to the pending merger with PepsiCo and a $24 million pre-tax charge related to restructuring charges. See Items Affecting Comparability of Our Financial Results in Item 7.
 
(2)   Our fiscal year 2008 results include $412 million in pre-tax non-cash impairment charges relating primarily to distribution rights and product brands in Mexico and an $83 million pre-tax charge related to restructuring charges. See Items Affecting Comparability of Our Financial Results in Item 7.
 
(3)   Our fiscal year 2007 results include a $30 million pre-tax charge related to restructuring charges and a $23 million pre-tax charge related to our asset disposal plan. See Items Affecting Comparability of Our Financial Results in Item 7.
 
(4)   In fiscal year 2006, we adopted accounting guidance related to share-based payments resulting in a $65 million decrease in operating income or $0.17 per diluted earnings per share. Results for prior periods have not been restated as provided for under the modified prospective approach.
 
(5)   Our fiscal year 2005 results include an extra week of activity. The pre-tax income generated from the extra week was spent back in strategic initiatives within our selling, delivery and administrative expenses and, accordingly, had no impact on our diluted earnings per share.
 
(6)   Our fiscal year 2009 results include a non-cash tax benefit of $158 million due to tax audit settlements in the U.S., Canada and our international jurisdictions, partially offset by a net non-cash tax charge of $65 million due to tax law changes in Canada and Mexico. See Items Affecting Comparability of Our Financial Results in Item 7.
 
(7)   Our fiscal year 2007 results include a non-cash tax benefit of $46 million due to the reversal of net tax contingency reserves and a net non-cash tax benefit of $13 million due to tax law changes in Canada and Mexico. See Items Affecting Comparability of Our Financial Results in Item 7.
 
(8)   Our fiscal year 2006 results include a tax benefit of $11 million from tax law changes in Canada, Turkey, and in various U.S. jurisdictions and a $55 million tax benefit from the reversal of tax contingency reserves due to completion of our IRS audit of our 1999-2000 income tax returns.
 
(9)   In fiscal year 2006, we recorded a $159 million loss, net of taxes and noncontrolling interests, to accumulated other comprehensive loss related to the adoption of new pension and postretirement rules, requiring the Company to record the funded status of each of our pension and postretirement plans.

19


Table of Contents

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
         
       
    21  
    22  
    22  
    23  
    25  
    26  
    26  
    27  
    30  
    31  
    37  
    40  
 
       
       
 
       
    43  
    44  
    45  
    46  
    47  
       
    48  
    48  
    53  
    54  
    56  
    57  
    58  
    60  
    61  
    62  
    64  
    69  
    73  
    74  
    76  
    77  
    77  
    78  
    79  
    80  
    81  
    82  

20


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S FINANCIAL REVIEW
Tabular dollars in millions, except per share data
OUR BUSINESS
     The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. is the world’s largest manufacturer, seller and distributor of Pepsi-Cola beverages. When used in these Consolidated Financial Statements, “PBG,” “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” each refers to The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and, where appropriate, to Bottling Group, LLC (“Bottling LLC”), our principal operating subsidiary.
     We have the exclusive right to manufacture, sell and distribute Pepsi-Cola beverages in all or a portion of the U.S., Mexico, Canada, Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey. PBG manages and reports operating results through three reportable segments: U.S. & Canada, Europe (which includes Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey) and Mexico. As shown in the graph below, the U.S. & Canada segment is the dominant driver of our results, generating 68 percent of our volume, 78 percent of our net revenues and 84 percent of our operating income.
(PERFORMANCE GRAPH)
     The majority of our volume is derived from brands licensed from PepsiCo, Inc. (“PepsiCo”) or PepsiCo joint ventures. These brands are some of the most recognized in the world and consist of carbonated soft drinks (“CSDs”) and non-carbonated beverages. Our CSDs include brands such as Pepsi-Cola, Diet Pepsi, Diet Pepsi Max, Mountain Dew and Sierra Mist. Our non-carbonated beverages portfolio includes brands with Starbucks Frapuccino in the ready-to-drink coffee category; Amp Energy and SoBe Adrenaline Rush in the energy drink category; SoBe and Tropicana in the juice and juice drinks category; Aquafina in the water category; and Lipton Iced Tea in the tea category. We continue to strengthen our powerful portfolio highlighted by our focus on the hydration category with SoBe Lifewater, Propel fitness water and G2 in the United States. In some of our territories we have the right to manufacture, sell and distribute soft drink products of companies other than PepsiCo, including Dr Pepper, Crush, Squirt and Rockstar. We also have the right in some of our territories to manufacture, sell and distribute beverages under brands that we own, including Electropura, e-pura and Garci Crespo. See Part I, Item 1 of this report for a listing of our principal products by segment.
     We sell our products through cold-drink and take-home channels. Our cold-drink channel consists of chilled products sold in the retail and foodservice channels. We earn the highest profit margins on a per-case basis in the cold-drink channel. Our take-home channel consists of unchilled products that are sold in the retail, mass merchandiser and club store channels for at-home consumption.
     Our products are brought to market primarily through direct store delivery (“DSD”) or third-party distribution, including foodservice and vending distribution networks. The hallmarks of the Company’s DSD system are customer service, speed to market, flexibility and reach. These are all critical factors in bringing new products to market, adding accounts to our existing base and meeting increasingly diverse volume demands.
     Our customers range from large format accounts, including large chain foodstores, supercenters, mass merchandisers, chain drug stores, club stores and military bases, to small independently owned shops and foodservice businesses. Changes in consumer shopping trends and current economic trends are shifting more of our volume to channels such as supercenters, club and dollar stores. Retail consolidation continues to increase the strategic significance of our large-volume customers. No individual customer accounted for 10 percent or more of

21


Table of Contents

our total revenue in 2009, except for sales to Walmart Stores, Inc. and its affiliates which were 11 percent of our revenue in 2009, primarily as a result of transactions in the U.S. & Canada segment. Sales to our top five retail customers represented approximately 21 percent of our net revenues in 2009.
     PBG’s focus is on superior sales execution, customer service, merchandising and operating excellence. Our goal is to help our customers grow their beverage business by making our portfolio of brands readily available to consumers at every shopping occasion, using proven methods to grow not only PepsiCo brand sales, but the overall beverage category. Our objective is to ensure we have the right product in the right package to satisfy the ever changing needs of today’s consumers.
     We measure our sales in terms of physical cases sold to our customers. Each package, as sold to our customers, regardless of configuration or number of units within a package, represents one physical case. Our net price and gross margin on a per-case basis are impacted by how much we charge for the product, the mix of brands and packages we sell, and the channels through which the product is sold. For example, we realize a higher net revenue and gross margin per case on a 20-ounce chilled bottle sold in a convenience store than on a 2-liter unchilled bottle sold in a grocery store.
     Our financial success is dependent on a number of factors, including: our strong partnership with PepsiCo, the customer relationships we cultivate, the pricing we achieve in the marketplace, our market execution, our ability to meet changing consumer preferences and the efficiencies we achieve in manufacturing and distributing our products. Key indicators of our financial success are: the number of physical cases we sell, the net price and gross margin we achieve on a per-case basis, cash and capital management and our overall cost productivity which reflects how well we manage our raw material, manufacturing, distribution and other overhead costs.
     The discussion and analysis throughout Management’s Financial Review should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and the related accompanying notes. The preparation of our Consolidated Financial Statements and the related accompanying notes in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“GAAP”) requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts in our Consolidated Financial Statements and the related accompanying notes, including various claims and contingencies related to lawsuits, taxes, environmental and other matters arising out of the normal course of business. We apply our best judgment, our knowledge of existing facts and circumstances and actions that we may undertake in the future, in determining the estimates that affect our Consolidated Financial Statements. We evaluate our estimates on an on-going basis using our historical experience as well as other factors we believe appropriate under the circumstances, such as current economic conditions, and adjust or revise our estimates as circumstances change. As future events and their effect cannot be determined with precision, actual results may differ from these estimates.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     Our significant accounting policies are discussed in Note 2 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Management believes the following policies, which require the use of estimates, assumptions and the application of judgment, to be the most critical to the portrayal of PBG’s results of operations and financial condition. We applied these accounting policies and estimation methods consistently in all material respects and have discussed the selection of these policies and related disclosures with the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee of our Board of Directors.
OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS, NET AND GOODWILL
     Our intangible assets consist primarily of franchise rights, distribution rights, licensing rights, brands and goodwill and principally arise from the allocation of the purchase price of businesses acquired. These intangible assets, other than goodwill, are classified as either finite-lived intangibles or indefinite-lived intangibles.
     The classification of intangible assets and the determination of the appropriate useful life require substantial judgment. The determination of the expected life depends upon the use and underlying characteristics of the intangible asset. In our evaluation of the expected life of these intangible assets, we consider the nature and terms of the underlying agreements; our intent and ability to use the specific asset; the age and market position of the products within the territories in which we are entitled to sell; the historical and projected growth of those products; and costs, if any, to renew the related agreement.
     Intangible assets that are determined to have a finite life are amortized over their expected useful life, which generally ranges from five to twenty years. For intangible assets with finite lives, evaluations for impairment are performed only if facts and circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable.

22


Table of Contents

     Intangible assets with indefinite lives and goodwill are not amortized; however, they are evaluated for impairment at least annually or more frequently if facts and circumstances indicate that the assets may be impaired.
     We evaluate intangible assets with indefinite useful lives for impairment by comparing the fair values of the assets with their carrying values. The fair value of our franchise rights and distribution rights is measured using a multi-period excess earnings method that is based upon estimated discounted future cash flows. The fair value of our brands and licensing rights is measured using a multi-period royalty savings method, which reflects the savings realized by owning the brand or licensing right and, therefore, not requiring payment of third party royalty fees.
     We evaluate goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level, which we determined to be the countries in which we operate. We evaluate goodwill for impairment by comparing the fair value of the reporting unit, as determined by its discounted cash flows, with its carrying value. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, we compare the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill with its carrying amount to measure the amount of impairment loss.
     Considerable management judgment is necessary to estimate discounted future cash flows in conducting an impairment analysis for goodwill and other intangible assets. The cash flows may be impacted by future actions taken by us and our competitors and the volatility of macroeconomic conditions in the markets in which we conduct business. Assumptions used in our impairment analysis, such as forecasted growth rates, cost of capital and additional risk premiums used in the valuations, are based on the best available market information and are consistent with our long-term strategic plans. An inability to achieve strategic business plan targets in a reporting unit, a change in our discount rate or other assumptions could have a significant impact on the fair value of our reporting units and other intangible assets, which could then result in a material non-cash impairment charge to our results of operations. The weakening of global macroeconomic conditions has had a negative impact on our business results. If these conditions continue, the fair value of our intangible assets could be adversely impacted.
     In the third quarter of 2009, the Company completed its impairment test of goodwill and indefinite lived assets and recorded no impairment charge. During 2008, the Company recorded $412 million in non-cash impairment charges relating primarily to distribution rights and brands for the Electropura water business in Mexico. The impairment charge relating to these intangible assets was based upon the findings of an extensive strategic review and the finalization of restructuring plans for our Mexican business.
     For further information about our goodwill and other intangible assets see Note 6 Other Intangible Assets, net and Goodwill in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
PENSION AND POSTRETIREMENT MEDICAL BENEFIT PLANS
     We sponsor pension and other postretirement medical benefit plans in various forms in the United States and similar pension plans in our international locations, covering employees who meet specified eligibility requirements. The assets, liabilities and expenses associated with our international plans were not significant to our worldwide results of operations or financial position, and accordingly, assumptions, expenses, sensitivity analyses and other data regarding these plans are not included in any of the discussions provided below.
     In the U.S., the non-contributory defined benefit pension plans provide benefits to certain full-time salaried and hourly employees. Benefits are generally based on years of service and compensation, or stated amounts for each year of service. Effective January 1, 2007, newly hired salaried and non-union hourly employees are not eligible to participate in these plans. Additionally, effective April 1, 2009, benefits from these plans are no longer accrued for certain salaried and non-union employees that did not meet specified age and service requirements. The impact of these plan changes will significantly reduce the Company’s future long-term pension obligation, pension expense and cash contributions to the plans. Employees not eligible to participate in these plans or employees whose benefits have been frozen are receiving additional retirement contributions under the Company’s defined contribution plans.
     Substantially all of our U.S. employees meeting age and service requirements are eligible to participate in our postretirement medical benefit plans.
Assumptions
     During 2008, the Company changed the measurement date for plan assets and benefit obligations from September 30 to its fiscal year-end as required by the new pension accounting rules.
     The determination of pension and postretirement medical benefit plan obligations and related expenses requires the use of assumptions to estimate the amount of benefits that employees earn while working, as well as the present value of those benefit obligations. Significant assumptions include discount rate; expected return on plan assets;

23


Table of Contents

certain employee-related factors such as retirement age, mortality, and turnover; rate of salary increases for plans where benefits are based on earnings; and for retiree medical plans, health care cost trend rates.
     On an annual basis we evaluate these assumptions, which are based upon historical experience of the plans and management’s best judgment regarding future expectations. These assumptions may differ materially from actual results due to changing market and economic conditions. A change in the assumptions or economic events outside our control could have a material impact on the measurement of our pension and postretirement medical benefit expenses and obligations as well as related funding requirements.
     The discount rates used in calculating the present value of our pension and postretirement medical benefit plan obligations are developed based on a yield curve that is comprised of high-quality, non-callable corporate bonds. These bonds are rated Aa or better by Moody’s; have a principal amount of at least $250 million; are denominated in U.S. dollars; and have maturity dates ranging from six months to thirty years, which matches the timing of our expected benefit payments.
     The expected rate of return on plan assets for a given fiscal year is based upon actual historical returns and the long-term outlook on asset classes in the pension plans’ investment portfolio. The current target asset allocation for the U.S. pension plans is 65 percent equity investments, of which approximately half is to be invested in domestic equities and half is to be invested in foreign equities. The remaining 35 percent is to be invested primarily in long-term corporate bonds. Based on our asset allocation, historical returns and estimated future outlook of the pension plans’ portfolio, we estimate the long-term rate of return on plan assets assumption to be 8.0 percent in 2010.
     Differences between the assumed rate of return and actual rate of return on plan assets are deferred in accumulated other comprehensive loss (“AOCL”) in equity and amortized to earnings utilizing the market-related value method. Under this method, differences between the assumed rate of return and actual rate of return from any one year will be recognized over a five-year period to determine the market-related value.
     Differences between assumed and actual returns on plan assets and other gains and losses resulting from changes in actuarial assumptions are determined at each measurement date and deferred in AOCL in equity. To the extent the amount of all unrecognized gains and losses exceeds 10 percent of the larger of the benefit obligation or the market-related value of plan assets, such amount is amortized to earnings over the average remaining service period of active participants.
     The cost or benefit from benefit plan changes is also deferred in AOCL in equity and amortized to earnings on a straight-line basis over the average remaining service period of the employees expected to receive benefits.
     Net unrecognized losses and unamortized prior service costs relating to the pension and postretirement plans in the United States totaled $763 million and $969 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
     The following tables provide the weighted-average assumptions for our 2010 and 2009 pension and postretirement medical plans’ expense:
                 
Pension   2010   2009
Discount rate
    6.25 %     6.20 %
Expected rate of return on plan assets (net of administrative expenses)
    8.00 %     8.00 %
Rate of compensation increase
    3.04 %     3.53 %
                 
Postretirement   2010   2009
Discount rate
    5.75 %     6.50 %
Rate of compensation increase
    3.43 %     3.53 %
Health care cost trend rate
    8.00 %     8.75 %
     During 2009, our ongoing defined benefit pension and postretirement medical plan expenses totaled $98 million. In 2010, these expenses are expected to decrease by approximately $15 million to $83 million as a result of the following factors:
    Funding to the pension trust will decrease 2010 pension expense by $16 million.
 
    Recognition of net asset losses will increase our pension expense by $14 million.
 
    An increase in our weighted-average discount rate for our pension expense from 6.20 percent to 6.25 percent, reflecting increases in the yields of long-term corporate bonds comprising the yield curve, will decrease our 2010 pension expense by approximately $3 million.

24


Table of Contents

    Other factors, including the full-year benefit of plan changes and improved health care experience, will decrease our 2010 defined benefit pension and postretirement medical expenses by approximately $10 million.
Sensitivity Analysis
     It is unlikely that in any given year the actual rate of return will be the same as the assumed long-term rate of return. The following table provides a summary for the last three years of actual rates of return versus expected long-term rates of return for our pension plan assets:
                         
    2009   2008   2007
Expected rates of return on plan assets (net of administrative expenses)
    8.00 %     8.50 %     8.50 %
Actual rates of return on plan assets (net of administrative expenses)
    25.3 %     (28.50 )%     12.64 %
     Sensitivity of changes in key assumptions for our pension and postretirement plans’ expense in 2010 are as follows:
    Discount rate – A 25 basis point change in the discount rate would increase or decrease the 2010 expense for the pension and postretirement medical benefit plans by approximately $10 million.
 
    Expected rate of return on plan assets – A 25 basis point change in the expected return on plan assets would increase or decrease the 2010 expense for the pension plans by approximately $4 million. The postretirement medical benefit plans have no expected return on plan assets as they are funded from the general assets of the Company as the payments come due.
 
    Contribution to the plan – A $20 million decrease in planned contributions to the plan for 2010 will increase our pension expense by $1 million.
Funding
     We make contributions to the pension trust to provide plan benefits for certain pension plans. Generally, we do not fund the pension plans if current contributions would not be tax deductible. Effective in 2008, under the Pension Protection Act, funding requirements are more stringent and require companies to make minimum contributions equal to their service cost plus amortization of their deficit over a seven year period. Failure to achieve appropriate funding levels will result in restrictions on employee benefits. Failure to contribute the minimum required contributions will result in excise taxes for the Company and an obligation to report to the regulatory agencies. During 2009, the Company contributed $229 million to its funded pension trusts. The Company expects to contribute an additional $132 million to its funded pension trusts in 2010. These amounts exclude $30 million of contributions and $26 million of expected contributions to the unfunded plans for the years ended December 26, 2009 and December 25, 2010, respectively.
     For further information about our pension and postretirement plans see Note 11 Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
CASUALTY INSURANCE COSTS
     Due to the nature of our business, we require insurance coverage for certain casualty risks. In the United States, we use a combination of insurance and self-insurance mechanisms, including a wholly owned captive insurance entity. This captive entity participates in a reinsurance pool for a portion of our workers’ compensation risk. We provide self-insurance for the workers’ compensation risk retained by the Company and automobile risks up to $10 million per occurrence, and product and general liability risks up to $5 million per occurrence. For losses exceeding these self-insurance thresholds, we purchase casualty insurance from third-party providers.
     At December 26, 2009, our net liability for casualty costs was $240 million, of which $70 million was considered short-term in nature. At December 27, 2008, our net liability for casualty costs was $235 million, of which $70 million was considered short-term in nature.
     Our liability for casualty costs is estimated using individual case-based valuations and statistical analyses and is based upon historical experience, actuarial assumptions and professional judgment. We do not discount our loss expense reserves. These estimates are subject to the effects of trends in loss severity and frequency and are subject to a significant degree of inherent variability. We evaluate these estimates periodically during the year and we believe that they are appropriate; however, an increase or decrease in the estimates or events outside our control could have a material impact on reported net income. Accordingly, the ultimate settlement of these costs may vary significantly from the estimates included in our financial statements.

25


Table of Contents

INCOME TAXES
     Our effective tax rate is based on pre-tax income, statutory tax rates, tax laws and regulations and tax planning strategies available to us in the various jurisdictions in which we operate. Significant management judgment is required in evaluating our tax positions and in determining our effective tax rate.
     Our deferred tax assets and liabilities reflect our best estimate of the tax benefits and costs we expect to realize in the future. We establish valuation allowances to reduce our deferred tax assets to an amount that will more likely than not be realized.
     We recognize the impact of our tax positions in our financial statements if those positions will more likely than not be sustained on audit, based on the technical merits of the position. A number of years may elapse before an uncertain tax position for which we have established a tax reserve is audited and finally resolved, and the number of years for which we have audits that are open varies depending on the tax jurisdiction. While it is often difficult to predict the final outcome or the timing of the resolution of an audit, we believe that our reserves for uncertain tax benefits reflect the outcome of tax positions that is more likely than not to occur. Nevertheless, it is possible that tax authorities may disagree with our tax positions, which could have a significant impact on our results of operations, financial position and cash flows. The resolution of a tax position could be recognized as an adjustment to our provision for income taxes and our deferred taxes in the period of resolution, and may also require the use of cash.
     For further information about our income taxes see “Income Tax Expense” in the Results of Operations and Note 12 Income Taxes in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
RELATIONSHIP WITH PEPSICO
     PepsiCo is a related party due to the nature of our franchise relationship and its ownership interest in our company. More than 80 percent of our volume is derived from the sale of PepsiCo or PepsiCo joint venture brands. At December 26, 2009, PepsiCo owned approximately 31.7 percent of our outstanding common stock and 100 percent of our outstanding class B common stock, together representing approximately 38.6 percent of the voting power of all classes of our voting stock. In addition, at December 26, 2009, PepsiCo owned 6.6 percent of the equity of Bottling LLC.
     While we manage all phases of our operations, including pricing of our products, we exchange production, marketing and distribution information with PepsiCo, which benefits both companies’ respective efforts to lower costs, improve quality and productivity and increase product sales. We have a significant ongoing relationship with PepsiCo and enter into various transactions and agreements with them. We purchase concentrate, pay royalties related to Aquafina products, and manufacture, package, sell and distribute cola and non-cola beverages under various bottling and fountain syrup agreements with PepsiCo. These agreements give us the right to manufacture, sell and distribute beverage products of PepsiCo in both bottles and cans, as well as fountain syrup in specified territories. PepsiCo has the right under these agreements to set prices of beverage concentrate, as well as the terms of payment and other terms and conditions under which we purchase concentrate. PepsiCo also provides us with bottler funding to support a variety of trade and consumer programs such as consumer incentives, advertising support, new product support and vending and cooler equipment placement. The nature and type of programs, as well as the level of funding, vary annually. Additionally, under a shared services agreement, we obtain various services from PepsiCo, which include services for information technology maintenance and procurement of raw materials. We also provide services to PepsiCo, including facility and credit and collection support. Because we depend on PepsiCo to provide us with concentrate, bottler incentives and various services, changes in our relationship with PepsiCo could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
     We also enter into various transactions with joint ventures in which PepsiCo holds an equity interest. In particular, we purchase tea concentrate and finished beverage products from the Pepsi/Lipton Tea Partnership, a joint venture between PepsiCo and Unilever, in which PepsiCo holds a 50 percent interest. We also purchase finished beverage products from the North American Coffee Partnership, a joint venture between PepsiCo and Starbucks Corporation in which PepsiCo holds a 50 percent interest.
     PepsiCo owns 40 percent of PR Beverages Limited (“PR Beverages”), a consolidated venture for our Russian operations, which was formed on March 1, 2007. PR Beverages has an exclusive license to manufacture and sell PepsiCo concentrate for beverage products sold in Russia. PR Beverages has also entered into a Russian Snack Food Distribution Agreement with Frito Lay, Inc., a subsidiary of PepsiCo, to sell and distribute their snack products in the Russian Federation.
     For further information about our relationship with PepsiCo and its affiliates see Note 14 Related Party Transactions in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

26


Table of Contents

ITEMS AFFECTING COMPARABILITY OF OUR FINANCIAL RESULTS
     The year-over-year comparisons of our financial results are affected by the following items included in our reported results:
                         
    December     December     December  
Income/(Expense)   26, 2009     27, 2008     29, 2007  
 
Operating Income
                       
Advisory Fees
  $ (40 )   $     $  
Mark-to-Market Net Impact
    12              
Impairment Charges
          (412 )      
2008 Restructuring Actions
    (24 )     (83 )      
2007 Restructuring Actions
          (3 )     (30 )
Asset Disposal Charges
          (2 )     (23 )
 
                 
Operating Income Impact
  $ (52 )   $ (500 )   $ (53 )
 
 
                       
Net Income Attributable to PBG(1)
                       
Advisory Fees(2)
  $ (34 )   $     $  
Mark-to-Market Net Impact(3)
    7              
Impairment Charges(4)
          (277 )      
2008 Restructuring Actions(5)
    (16 )     (58 )      
2007 Restructuring Actions (6)
          (2 )     (22 )
Asset Disposal Charges(7)
          (1 )     (13 )
Tax Audit Settlements(8)
    151             46  
Tax Law Changes(9)
    (61 )           10  
 
                 
Net Income Attributable to PBG Impact
  $ 47     $ (338 )   $ 21  
 
 
                       
Diluted Earnings Per Share
                       
Advisory Fees
  $ (0.15 )   $     $  
Mark-to-Market Net Impact
    0.04              
Impairment Charges
          (1.26 )      
2008 Restructuring Actions
    (0.07 )     (0.26 )      
2007 Restructuring Actions
          (0.01 )     (0.09 )
Asset Disposal Charges
                (0.06 )
Tax Audit Settlements
    0.68             0.20  
Tax Law Changes
    (0.28 )           0.04  
 
                 
Diluted Earnings Per Share Impact
  $ 0.22     $ (1.53 )   $ 0.09  
 
 
(1)   Represents items net of taxes and noncontrolling interests. Taxes have been calculated based on the tax rate of the tax jurisdiction in which the item was recorded. Noncontrolling interests has been calculated based upon the ownership structure within the entity in which the item was recorded.
 
(2)   Net of taxes of $6 million.
 
(3)   Net of taxes and noncontrolling interests of $4 million and $1 million, respectively.
 
(4)   Net of taxes and noncontrolling interests of $115 million and $20 million, respectively.
 
(5)   Net of taxes and noncontrolling interests of $7 million and $1 million, respectively, in 2009 and $19 million and $6 million, respectively, in 2008.
 
(6)   Net of both taxes and noncontrolling interests of $1 million in 2008 and net of taxes and noncontrolling interests of $6 million and $2 million, respectively, in 2007.
 
(7)   Net of both taxes and noncontrolling interests of $1 million in 2008 and net of taxes and noncontrolling interests of $8 million and $2 million, respectively, in 2007.
 
(8)   Net of noncontrolling interests of $7 million in 2009.
 
(9)   Net of noncontrolling interests of $4 million in 2009 and $1 million in 2007.

27


Table of Contents

     Advisory Fees
     On August 3, 2009, PBG and PepsiCo entered into a definitive merger agreement, under which PepsiCo will acquire, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, all outstanding shares of PBG common stock it does not already own. In connection with this transaction, the Company has retained certain external advisors and expects to incur aggregate fees in the range of $50 million to $60 million. During 2009, the Company recorded pre-tax charges of $40 million, or $0.15 per diluted share, relating to these services, which were recorded in selling, delivery and administrative expenses (“SD&A”).
     For further information about the pending merger with PepsiCo see Note 18 Contingencies in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Mark-to-Market Net Impact
     The Company’s corporate headquarters centrally manages commodity derivatives on behalf of our segments. During 2009, we expanded our hedging program to mitigate price changes associated with certain commodities utilized in our production process. These derivatives hedge the underlying price risk associated with the commodity and are not entered into for speculative purposes. Certain commodity derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment. Others receive hedge accounting treatment but may have some element of ineffectiveness based on the accounting standard. These commodity derivatives are marked-to-market each period until settlement, resulting in gains and losses being reflected in corporate headquarters’ results. The gains and losses are subsequently reflected in the segment results when the underlying commodity’s cost is recognized. Therefore, segment results reflect the contract purchase price of these commodities. During 2009, the Company recognized a net pre-tax gain of $12 million, or $0.04 per diluted share, related to these commodity derivatives. The Company did not have any comparable activity in prior years.
     Impairment Charges
     During the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company recorded $412 million, or $1.26 per diluted share, in non-cash impairment charges relating primarily to distribution rights and brands for the Electropura water business in Mexico. For further information about the impairment charges see Note 6 Other Intangibles, net and Goodwill in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
     2008 Restructuring Actions
     In the fourth quarter of 2008, we announced a restructuring program to enhance the Company’s operating capabilities in each of our reportable segments. The program was substantially complete in December of 2009 and certain restructuring actions previously planned for 2010 have been cancelled as a result of the pending merger with PepsiCo.
     The program will result in annual pre-tax savings of approximately $110 million. The Company recorded pre-tax charges of $107 million, or $0.33 per diluted share, over the course of the restructuring program, which were recorded in SD&A. These charges were primarily for severance and related benefits, pension and other employee-related costs and other charges, including employee relocation and asset disposal costs. In 2009, we recorded pre-tax charges of $24 million, or $0.07 per diluted share, of which $10 million was recorded in the U.S. & Canada segment and $14 million was recorded in the Mexico segment.
     As part of the restructuring program, approximately 4,000 positions were eliminated including 600 positions in the U.S. & Canada, 500 positions in Europe and 2,900 positions in Mexico.
     The Company expects to incur approximately $80 million in pre-tax cash expenditures from these restructuring actions, of which $75 million has been paid since the inception of the program, with the balance expected to occur in 2010. During 2009, we paid $62 million in pre-tax cash expenditures for these restructuring actions.
     For further information about our restructuring charges see Note 15 Restructuring Charges in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
     2007 Restructuring Actions
     In the third quarter of 2007, we announced a restructuring program to realign the Company’s organization to adapt to changes in the marketplace, improve operating efficiencies and enhance the growth potential of the Company’s product portfolio. We completed the organizational realignment during the first quarter of 2008, which resulted in the elimination of approximately 800 positions. Annual cost savings from this restructuring program are approximately $30 million. Over the course of the program we incurred a pre-tax charge of approximately $29 million, which was recorded in SD&A. During 2007, we recorded pre-tax charges of $26 million, of which $18 million was recorded in the U.S. & Canada segment and the remaining $8 million was recorded in the Europe segment. During the first half of 2008, we recorded an additional $3 million of

28


Table of Contents

pre-tax charges primarily relating to relocation expenses in our U.S. & Canada segment. We made approximately $24 million of after-tax cash payments associated with these restructuring charges.
     In the fourth quarter of 2007, we implemented and completed an additional phase of restructuring actions to improve operating efficiencies. In addition to the amounts discussed above, we recorded a pre-tax charge of approximately $4 million in SD&A, primarily related to employee termination costs in Mexico, where an additional 800 positions were eliminated as a result of this phase of the restructuring. Annual cost savings from this restructuring program are approximately $7 million.
     Asset Disposal Charges
     In the fourth quarter of 2007, we adopted a Full Service Vending (“FSV”) Rationalization plan to rationalize our vending asset base in our U.S. & Canada segment by disposing of older underperforming assets and redeploying certain assets to higher return accounts. Our FSV business portfolio consists of accounts where we stock and service vending equipment. This plan, which we completed in the second quarter of 2008, was part of the Company’s broader initiative to improve operating income margins of our FSV business.
     Over the course of the FSV Rationalization plan, we incurred a pre-tax asset disposal charge of approximately $25 million, the majority of which was non-cash. The charge included costs associated with the removal of these assets from service, disposal costs and redeployment expenses. Of this amount, we recorded a pre-tax charge of approximately $23 million in 2007 with the remainder being recorded in 2008. This charge is recorded in SD&A.
     Tax Audit Settlements
     In 2009, our tax provision was reduced by the reversal of tax reserves, net of noncontrolling interests, of approximately $151 million, or $0.68 per diluted share, from the resolution of tax audits and the expiration of statute of limitations in the U.S. and in our international jurisdictions.
     During 2007, PBG recorded a net non-cash tax benefit of approximately $46 million, or $0.20 per diluted share, to income tax expense related to the reversal of tax reserves resulting from the expiration of the statute of limitations on the IRS audit of our U.S. 2001 and 2002 tax returns.
     For further information about our tax audit settlements see Note 12 Income Taxes in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Tax Law Changes
     In the fourth quarter of 2009, there was a significant tax law change in Mexico which required us to re-measure our deferred tax assets and liabilities resulting in a net provision expense, net of noncontrolling interests, of $68 million, or $0.31 per diluted share. Certain aspects of the tax law change in Mexico are still subject to clarification with the tax authorities and may require that we revise our deferred taxes in the future as new information becomes available. There was also a tax law change in Canada which reduced certain provincial tax rates and which resulted in a tax provision benefit, net of noncontrolling interests, of $7 million, or $0.03 per diluted share.
     In addition, during 2007, tax law changes were enacted in Canada and Mexico, which required us to re-measure our deferred tax assets and liabilities. The impact of the tax law change in Canada was partially offset by the tax law change in Mexico decreasing our income tax expense on a net basis. As a result of these changes, net income attributable to PBG increased approximately $10 million, or $0.04 per diluted share.

29


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE SUMMARY AND WORLDWIDE FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS FOR FISCAL YEAR 2009
                         
                    % Change  
    December     December     Better/  
    26, 2009     27, 2008     (Worse)  
Net revenues
  $ 13,219     $ 13,796       (4 )%
Gross profit
    5,840       6,210       (6 )%
Selling, delivery and administrative expenses
    4,792       5,149       7 %
Operating income
                       
U.S. & Canada
  $ 868     $ 886       (2 )%
Europe
    112       101       11 %
Mexico
    56       (338 )     116 %
 
                   
Total segments
    1,036       649       60 %
Corporate – net impact of mark-to-market on commodity hedges
    12           NM  
 
                   
Total operating income
  $ 1,048     $ 649       61 %
 
                   
Net income attributable to PBG
  $ 612     $ 162       277 %
 
                   
Diluted earnings per share (1)
  $ 2.77     $ 0.74       275 %
 
                   
 
(1)   Percentage change for diluted earnings per share is calculated using earnings per share data expanded to the fourth decimal place.
 
NM – Not meaningful.
     Reported net revenues decreased four percent versus the prior year driven by volume declines and the negative impact from foreign currency translation. This impact was partially offset by increases in rate per case in each of our reportable segments.
     On a currency neutral basis*, net revenues increased one percent and net revenue per case increased four percent versus the prior year, reflecting the solid execution of our revenue and margin management strategy in a challenging economic environment. Reported net revenue per case declined one percent, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of five percentage points.
     Reported gross profit declined six percent versus the prior year, driven by the negative impact of foreign currency translation and volume declines. This impact was partially offset by a two percent increase in gross profit per case on a currency neutral basis, as rate gains from the Company’s global pricing strategy and savings from productivity initiatives more than offset higher raw material costs. Reported gross profit per case declined three percent, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of five percentage points.
     Reported SD&A declined by seven percent versus the prior year, driven by lower operating costs due to continued productivity improvements across all segments coupled with the favorable impact of foreign currency translation. Foreign currency translation contributed five percentage points to the decline in SD&A growth.
     Reported operating income increased 61 percent versus the prior year. Items impacting comparability** in the current and prior year contributed 65 percent to the operating income growth for the year. The remaining four percent decrease in operating income growth for the year was impacted by the negative impact of foreign currency translation of four percentage points and volume declines. This impact was partially offset by increases in currency neutral gross profit per case, cost and productivity improvements and the positive impact from acquisitions.
     Net income attributable to PBG increased 277 percent versus the prior year to $612 million and includes a net after-tax gain of $47 million, or $0.22 per diluted share, resulting from items impacting comparability**. Items impacting comparability in the current and prior year contributed 264 percentage points to the growth rate for the year. The remaining 13 percentage point increase in growth for the year was driven by a lower effective tax rate in the current year and the impact from foreign currency transactional losses which occurred in the prior year.
 
*   Currency neutral results are calculated using prior year’s exchange rates when calculating foreign currency translation effects.
 
**   See section entitled Items Affecting Comparability of our Financial Results for further information about these items.

30


Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS BY SEGMENT
     Except where noted, tables and discussion are presented as compared to the prior fiscal year. Growth rates are rounded to the nearest whole percentage.
Volume
     2009 vs. 2008
                                 
            U.S. &        
    Worldwide   Canada   Europe   Mexico
Base volume
    (4 )%     (4 )%     (8 )%     (4 )%
Acquisitions
    1       1              
 
                               
Total Volume Change
    (3 )%     (2) %*     (8 )%     (4 )%
 
                               
 
*   Does not add due to rounding to the whole percentage.
     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, base volume, which excludes the impact of acquisitions, decreased four percent for the year due primarily to the macroeconomic factors negatively impacting the liquid refreshment beverage category. Our newly acquired rights to distribute Crush, Rockstar and Muscle Milk in the U.S. contributed three percentage points to our base volume for the year.
     Take-home and cold-drink channels declined by three percent and six percent, respectively, versus last year. The decline in the take-home channel was driven primarily by our small format stores as changes in consumer shopping trends are shifting more of our volume to channels such as supercenters, club and dollar stores due to the economic downturn. Declines in our cold-drink channel were mainly driven by our foodservice channel, including restaurants, travel and leisure, education and workplace, which have been particularly impacted by the economic downturn in the United States.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, volume declined by eight percent versus the prior year. Soft volume performance reflected the overall weak macroeconomic environment and category softness throughout Europe, driven by double digit declines in Russia.
     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, volume decreased four percent versus the prior year. Volume declines were driven by difficult macroeconomic conditions and category softness, coupled with pricing actions taken by the Company to drive improved margins across its portfolio.
     2008 vs. 2007
                                 
            U.S. &        
    Worldwide   Canada   Europe   Mexico
Total Volume Change
    (4 )%     (4 )%     (3 )%     (5 )%
 
                               
     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, volume decreased four percent due to declining consumer confidence and spending, which has negatively impacted the liquid refreshment beverage category. Cold-drink and take-home channels both declined by four percent versus last year. The decline in the take-home channel was driven primarily by our large format stores, which was impacted by the overall declines in the liquid refreshment beverage category as well as pricing actions taken to improve profitability in our take-home packages including our unflavored water business. Decline in the cold-drink channel was driven by our foodservice channel, including restaurants, travel and leisure and workplace, which has been particularly impacted by the economic downturn in the United States.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, volume declined by three percent resulting from a soft volume performance in the second half of the year. Results reflect overall weak macroeconomic environments throughout Europe with high single digit declines in Spain and flat volume growth in Russia. Despite the slowing growth in Russia, we showed improvements in our energy and tea categories, partially offset by declines in the CSD category. In Spain, there were declines across all channels due to a weakening economy and our continued focus on improving revenue and gross profit growth.

31


Table of Contents

     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, volume decreased five percent driven by slower economic growth coupled with pricing actions taken by the Company to drive improved margins across its portfolio. This drove single digit declines in our jug water and multi-serve packages, which were partially offset by one percent improvement in our bottled water package.
Net Revenues
     2009 vs. 2008
                                 
            U.S. &              
    Worldwide     Canada     Europe     Mexico  
2009 Net revenues
  $ 13,219     $ 10,315     $ 1,755     $ 1,149  
2008 Net revenues
  $ 13,796     $ 10,300     $ 2,115     $ 1,381  
 
                               
% Impact of:
                               
Volume
    (4 )%     (4 )%     (8 )%     (4 )%
Net price impact (rate/mix)
    4       3       6       6  
Acquisitions
    1       1              
Currency translation
    (5 )     (1 )     (16 )     (19 )
 
                       
Total Net Revenues Change
    (4 )%     %*     (17) %*     (17 )%
 
                       
 
*   Does not add due to rounding to the whole percentage.
     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, net revenues were flat for the year. The results reflect improvements in net pricing, partially offset by volume declines and the negative impact of foreign currency translation. Net revenue per case on a currency neutral basis improved by three percent, driven by rate increases. Reported net revenue per case increased two percent, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of one percentage point.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, net revenues declined 17 percent, due primarily to the negative impact of foreign currency translation and volume declines. This was offset by growth in net revenue per case on a currency neutral basis of seven percent driven primarily by rate actions and disciplined promotional spending. Europe’s reported net revenue per case declined 10 percent, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of 17 percentage points.
     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, declines in net revenues of 17 percent reflected the negative impact of foreign currency translation and volume declines, partially offset by improvements in currency neutral net revenue per case. Net revenue per case on a currency neutral basis grew six percent, primarily due to rate increases to drive margin improvement. Mexico’s reported net revenue per case declined 14 percent, which includes a 20 percentage point negative impact from foreign currency translation.

32


Table of Contents

     2008 vs. 2007
                                 
            U.S. &              
    Worldwide     Canada     Europe     Mexico  
2008 Net revenues
  $ 13,796     $ 10,300     $ 2,115     $ 1,381  
2007 Net revenues
  $ 13,591     $ 10,336     $ 1,872     $ 1,383  
 
                               
% Impact of:
                               
Volume
    (4 )%     (4 )%     (3 )%     (5 )%
Net price impact (rate/mix)
    5       4       10       6  
Currency translation
    1             6       (1 )
 
                       
Total Net Revenues Change
    2 %     %     13 %     %
 
                       
     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, net revenues were flat versus the prior year driven by net price per case improvement offset by volume declines. The four percent improvement in net price per case was primarily driven by rate increases taken to offset rising raw material costs and to improve profitability in our take-home packages, including our unflavored water business.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, growth in net revenues for the year reflects an increase in net price per case and the positive impact of foreign currency translation, partially offset by volume declines. Net revenue per case grew in every country in Europe led by double-digit growth in Russia and Turkey due mainly to rate increases.
     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, net revenues were flat versus the prior year reflecting increases in net price per case offset by declines in volume and the negative impact of foreign currency translation. Growth in net price per case was primarily due to rate increases taken within our multi-serve CSDs, jugs and bottled water packages.
Operating Income
     2009 vs. 2008
                                         
            U.S. &                    
    Worldwide     Canada     Europe     Mexico     Corporate  
2009 Operating income
  $ 1,048     $ 868     $ 112     $ 56     $ 12  
2008 Operating income (loss)
  $ 649     $ 886     $ 101     $ (338 )   $  
 
% Impact of:
                                       
Operating activities
    (3 )%     (4 )%     (12 )%     17 %     %
Advisory fees
    (6 )     (5 )                  
Mark-to-market net impact
    2                       NM  
Impairment charges
    60             2       125        
2008 Restructuring actions
    8       5       23       (3 )      
2007 Restructuring actions
    1       1                    
Asset disposal charges
                             
Acquisitions
    3       2       14              
Currency translation
    (4 )     (1 )     (17 )     (23 )      
 
                             
Total operating income change
    61 %     (2 )%     11 %*     116 %   NM%
 
                             
 
*   Does not add due to rounding to the whole percentage.
 
NM – Not meaningful.
     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, operating income decreased two percent versus the prior year, driven by volume declines, partially offset by an improvement in gross profit per case, cost and productivity savings and the favorable impact of acquisitions.

33


Table of Contents

     Reported gross profit per case increased one percent, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of one percentage point for the year. Gross profit per case on a currency neutral basis increased two percent for the year driven by growth in net revenue per case and savings from productivity initiatives, which more than offset higher raw material costs.
     SD&A improved one percent for the year. The decrease in SD&A expenses for the year reflects lower costs resulting from productivity initiatives and volume declines coupled with a favorable impact from foreign currency translation of one percentage point, partially offset by higher pension and employee related costs.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, operating income increased 11 percent driven primarily by the impact of restructuring and other charges taken in the prior year and additional income from our newly acquired equity investment in Russia, partially offset by decreases in volume and the negative impact of foreign currency.
     Reported gross profit per case in Europe declined 14 percent for the year, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of 15 percentage points. Gross profit per case on a currency neutral basis increased one percent driven by strong rate increases which offset higher raw material costs resulting from the foreign currency transactional impact for U.S. dollar denominated purchases.
     SD&A in Europe improved 24 percent for the year, which includes a benefit from foreign currency translation of 13 percentage points. The remaining improvement in SD&A was driven by volume declines, restructuring and other customer related charges taken in the prior year, lower costs resulting from productivity initiatives throughout Europe and income generated from our equity investment in Russia.
     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, operating income increased 116 percent versus the prior year. Impairment and restructuring charges contributed 122 percent to the growth, which was partially offset by foreign currency translation of 23 percent. The remaining 17 percent of growth for the year was driven primarily by improved pricing actions and lower costs resulting from productivity initiatives.
     Reported gross profit per case declined 15 percent for the year, which includes the negative impact from foreign currency translation of 19 percentage points. Gross profit per case on a currency neutral basis increased four percent, reflecting solid margin management and cost savings from productivity initiatives, which offset rising raw material costs. Higher raw material costs were driven by the negative impact of foreign currency transactional costs resulting from U.S. dollar denominated purchases.
     SD&A improved 18 percent for the year, which includes an 18 percentage point benefit from foreign currency translation. Restructuring charges increased SD&A by two percentage points. The remaining decrease in SD&A growth was driven by improved route and cost productivity initiatives.
     Corporate
     Corporate reflects a net gain of $12 million for the year related to the mark-to-market of commodity derivatives used to hedge against price changes associated with certain commodities utilized primarily in our U.S. and Canada production processes. The Company did not have any comparable mark-to-market commodity derivative activity in prior years.
     2008 vs. 2007
                                 
            U.S. &              
    Worldwide     Canada     Europe     Mexico  
2008 Operating income (loss)
  $ 649     $ 886     $ 101     $ (338 )
2007 Operating income
  $ 1,071     $ 893     $ 106     $ 72  
 
                               
% Impact of:
                               
Operating activities
    1 %     1 %     2 %     (3 )%
Impairment charges
    (38 )           (3 )     (571 )
2008 Restructuring charges
    (8 )     (6 )     (25 )     (4 )
2007 Restructuring charges
    3       2       8       4  
Asset disposal charges
    2       2              
Currency translation
    1             12       2  
 
                       
Total Operating Income Change
    (39 )%     (1 )%     (5) %*     (572 )%
 
                       
 
*   Does not add due to rounding to the whole percentage.

34


Table of Contents

     U.S. & Canada
     In our U.S. & Canada segment, operating income was $886 million in 2008, decreasing one percent versus the prior year. Restructuring and asset disposal charges taken in the current and prior year together contributed a decrease of two percentage points to the operating income decline. The remaining one percentage point of growth includes increases in gross profit per case and lower operating costs, partially offset by lower volume in the United States.
     Gross profit per case improved two percent versus the prior year in our U.S. & Canada segment. This includes growth in net revenue per case, which was partially offset by a six percent increase in cost of sales per case. Growth in cost of sales per case includes higher concentrate, sweetener and packaging costs.
     SD&A expenses improved three percent versus the prior year in our U.S. & Canada segment due to lower volume and pension costs and cost productivity initiatives. These productivity initiatives reflect a combination of headcount savings, reduced discretionary spending and leveraged manufacturing and logistics benefits. Results also include one percentage point of growth due to restructuring and asset disposal charges taken in the current and prior year.
     Europe
     In our Europe segment, operating income was $101 million in 2008, decreasing five percent versus the prior year. The net impact of restructuring and impairment charges contributed 20 percentage points to the decline for the year. The remaining 14 percentage point increase in operating income growth for the year reflects improvements in gross profit per case and the positive impact from foreign currency translation, partially offset by higher SD&A expenses.
     Gross profit per case in Europe increased 16 percent versus the prior year due to net price per case increases and foreign currency translation, partially offset by higher sweetener and packaging costs. Foreign currency contributed six percentage points of growth to gross profit for the year.
     SD&A expenses in Europe increased 16 percent due to additional operating costs associated with our investments in Europe coupled with charges in Russia due to softening volume and weakening economic conditions in the fourth quarter. Foreign currency contributed five percentage points to SD&A growth. Restructuring charges taken in the current and prior year contributed approximately two percentage points of growth to SD&A expenses for the year.
     Mexico
     In our Mexico segment, we had an operating loss of $338 million in 2008 driven primarily by impairment and restructuring charges taken in the current and prior years. The remaining one percent decrease in operating income growth for the year was driven by volume declines, partially offset by increases in gross profit per case and the positive impact from foreign currency translation.
     Gross profit per case improved six percent versus the prior year driven by improvements in net revenue per case, as we continue to improve our segment profitability in our jug water and multi-serve packages. Cost of sales per case in Mexico increased by five percent due primarily to rising packaging costs.
     SD&A remained flat versus the prior year driven by lower volume and reduced operating costs as we focus on route productivity, partially offset by cost inflation.
Interest Expense, net
     2009 vs. 2008
     Net interest expense increased by $13 million largely due to higher debt levels, proceeds of which were utilized to fund our acquisitions, coupled by the pre-funding of our $1.3 billion debt that matured in February 2009.
     2008 vs. 2007
     Net interest expense increased by $16 million largely due to higher average debt balances throughout the year and our treasury rate locks that were settled in the fourth quarter. These increases were partially offset by lower effective interest rates from interest rate swaps which convert our fixed-rate debt to variable-rate debt.

35


Table of Contents

Other Non-Operating (Income) Expenses, net
     2009 vs. 2008
     Other net non-operating income was $4 million in 2009 as compared to $25 million of net non-operating expenses in 2008 reflecting the transactional impact of U.S. dollar and euro purchases in Mexico and Europe. The positive change versus the prior year reflects the stabilization of the Mexican peso and Russian ruble during 2009.
     2008 vs. 2007
     Other net non-operating expenses were $25 million in 2008 as compared to $6 million of net non-operating income in 2007. Foreign currency transactional losses in 2008 resulted primarily from our U.S. dollar and euro purchases in Mexico and Russia, reflecting the impact of the weakening peso and ruble during the second half of 2008.
Net Income Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
     2009 vs. 2008
     Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests primarily reflects PepsiCo’s ownership in Bottling LLC of 6.6 percent, coupled with their 40 percent ownership in the PR Beverages venture in Russia. The $34 million increase versus the prior year was primarily driven by higher net income due to the impairment and restructuring charges taken in the prior year.
     2008 vs. 2007
     The $34 million decrease versus the prior year was primarily driven by lower operating results due to the impairment and restructuring charges taken in the fourth quarter of 2008.
Income Tax Expense
     2009 vs. 2008
     Our effective tax rate for 2009 and 2008 was 5.7 percent and 33.4 percent, respectively. The decrease in our effective tax rate is primarily due to year-over-year comparability associated with the following:
     During 2009, our tax provision was reduced by $158 million due to the reversal of tax reserves from the resolution of tax audits and the expiration of the statute of limitations in the U.S. and in our international jurisdictions, for an effective tax rate benefit of approximately 21.1 percentage points.
     In the fourth quarter, we reversed approximately $39 million of valuation allowances on some of our deferred tax assets as we anticipate receiving future benefit from those tax assets, which decreased our effective tax rate by approximately 5.2 percentage points.
     Our effective tax rate was also favorably impacted in 2009 by favorable country earnings mix, lower carrying charges on tax reserves due to the audit settlements discussed above, as well as tax planning strategies.
     Also, in the fourth quarter of 2009, there was a significant tax law change in Mexico which required us to re-measure our deferred tax assets and liabilities resulting in a net provision expense of $72 million. Certain aspects of the tax law change in Mexico are still subject to clarification with the tax authorities and may require that we revise our deferred taxes in the future as new information becomes available. There was also a tax law change in Canada which reduced certain provincial tax rates and which resulted in a tax provision benefit of $7 million. The net effect of these law changes increased our effective tax rate by approximately 8.7 percentage points.
     In 2008, our effective tax rate was unfavorably impacted by the impairment charges primarily related to Mexico and restructuring charges, the net effect of which increased our effective tax rate by 3.8 percentage points.
     2008 vs. 2007
     Our effective tax rates for 2008 and 2007 were 33.4 percent and 22.1 percent, respectively. The increase in our effective tax rate is primarily due to year-over-year comparability associated with the 2008 impairment charges primarily related to Mexico and restructuring charges the net effect of which increased our effective tax rate by 3.8 percentage points and a 2007 tax audit settlement which reduced our tax provision by $46 million, coupled with tax law changes that reduced our deferred income tax provision by $13 million, which decreased our effective tax rate by 7.3 percentage points.

36


Table of Contents

Diluted Weighted-Average Shares Outstanding
     Diluted weighted-average shares outstanding includes the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding plus the potential dilution that could occur if equity awards from our stock compensation plans were exercised and converted into common stock.
     Our diluted weighted-average shares outstanding for 2009, 2008 and 2007 were 221 million, 220 million and 233 million, respectively. The increase in diluted shares outstanding for 2009 reflects share issuances from the exercise of equity awards and a higher share price, partially offset by the effect of our share repurchase program in the prior year. The amount of shares authorized by the Board of Directors to be repurchased totals 175 million shares, of which we have repurchased approximately 146 million shares since the inception of our share repurchase program. We did not repurchase shares of PBG common stock in 2009. For further discussion on our earnings per share calculation see Note 3 Earnings per Share in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
LIQUIDITY AND FINANCIAL CONDITION
Cash Flows
     2009 vs. 2008
     PBG generated $1,108 million of net cash from operations, a decrease of $176 million from 2008. The decrease in net cash provided by operations was driven primarily by an increase in pension contributions offset by the timing of disbursements, net of collections primarily related to promotional activities and tax.
     Net cash used for investments was $714 million, a decrease of $1,044 million from 2008. The decline in cash used for investments was due to $742 million of payments made in 2008, associated with our investment in JSC Lebedyansky (“Lebedyansky”) and lower capital expenditures and acquisition spending in 2009. This was partially offset by a loan made to Lebedyansky in 2009, which was contemplated as part of the initial capitalization of the purchase of Lebedyansky between PepsiCo and us.
     Net cash used for financing activities was $470 million, an increase of $1,320 million from 2008. This increase in cash used for financing activities reflects the repayment of our $1.3 billion bond that matured in February 2009. In addition in 2008, the Company issued $1.3 billion in senior notes to pre-fund the 2009 bond maturity and received $308 million of cash from PepsiCo for their proportional share in the acquisitions by PR Beverages. This was partially offset by the issuance of a $750 million bond in 2009, lower share repurchases and short-term borrowings, and more proceeds from stock option exercises in 2009.
     2008 vs. 2007
     Net cash provided by operations decreased $153 million to $1,284 million in 2008, driven primarily by a change in working capital due largely to timing of accounts payable disbursements and higher payments relating to promotional activities and pensions.
     Net cash used for investments increased $875 million to $1,758 million in 2008, primarily due to payments associated with our investment in Lebedyansky and payments for acquisitions, partially offset by lower capital expenditures.
     Net cash provided by financing activities increased $1,414 million to $850 million in 2008, primarily due to a debt issuance and cash received from PepsiCo for their proportional share in the acquisitions by PR Beverages.
Capital Expenditures
     Our business requires substantial infrastructure investments to maintain our existing level of operations and to fund investments targeted at growing our business. Capital expenditures included in our cash flows from investing activities totaled $556 million, $760 million and $854 million during 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Capital expenditures decreased $204 million in 2009 due to our disciplined approach to capital spending.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
     Our principal sources of cash include cash from our operating activities and the issuance of debt and bank borrowings. We believe that these cash inflows will be sufficient to fund capital expenditures, benefit plan contributions, acquisitions, share repurchases, dividends and working capital requirements for the foreseeable future. Our liquidity remains healthy and management does not expect that it will be materially impacted in the near-future.

37


Table of Contents

     Acquisitions and Investments
     During 2009, we acquired a Pepsi-Cola and Dr Pepper franchise bottler serving portions of central Texas, as well as a Pepsi-Cola franchise bottler serving northeastern Massachusetts. The total cost of these acquisitions during 2009 was approximately $92 million.
     During 2009, we acquired distribution rights for certain energy drinks in the United States and Canada and protein-enhanced functional beverages in the United States. In addition, we acquired rights to manufacture and distribute Crush in portions of the United States. The total cost of these distribution and franchise rights during 2009 was approximately $40 million, of which $20 million will be paid over the next four years.
     During 2008, we completed a joint acquisition with PepsiCo of Russia’s leading branded juice company Lebedyansky for approximately $1.8 billion. Lebedyansky was acquired 58.3 percent by PepsiCo and 41.7 percent by PR Beverages, our Russian venture with PepsiCo. We have recorded an equity investment for PR Beverages’ share in Lebedyansky and a noncontrolling interest for PepsiCo’s proportional contribution to PR Beverages relating to Lebedyansky. As a result of PepsiCo’s 40 percent ownership of PR Beverages, PepsiCo and PBG have acquired a 75 percent and 25 percent economic stake in Lebedyansky, respectively.
     Also during 2008, we acquired two Pepsi-Cola franchise bottlers serving certain New York counties and portions of Colorado, Arizona and New Mexico. In addition we acquired a company that will manufacture various Pepsi products in Siberia and Eastern Russia. The total cost of acquisitions during 2008 was approximately $279 million.
     Long-Term Debt Activities
     During the first quarter of 2009, we issued $750 million in senior notes, with a coupon rate of 5.125 percent, maturing in 2019. The net proceeds of the offering, together with a portion of the proceeds from the offering of our senior notes issued in the fourth quarter of 2008, were used to repay our senior notes due at their scheduled maturity on February 17, 2009. The next significant scheduled debt maturity is not until 2012.
     During the fourth quarter of 2008, we issued $1.3 billion in senior notes with a coupon rate of 6.95 percent, maturing in 2014. A portion of the proceeds of this debt was used to finance acquisitions and repay short-term commercial paper debt.
     Short-Term Debt Activities
     We have a committed revolving credit facility of $1.2 billion and an uncommitted credit facility of $500 million. Both of these credit facilities are guaranteed by Bottling LLC and are used to support our $1.2 billion commercial paper program and working capital requirements. We had no commercial paper outstanding at December 26, 2009 or December 27, 2008.
     In addition to the revolving credit facilities discussed above, we had available short-term bank credit lines of approximately $892 million at December 26, 2009, of which the majority was uncommitted. These lines were primarily used to support the general operating needs of our international locations. As of December 26, 2009, we had $188 million outstanding under these lines of credit at a weighted-average interest rate of 3.1 percent. As of December 27, 2008, we had available short-term bank credit lines of approximately $772 million, of which $103 million was outstanding at a weighted-average interest rate of 10.0 percent.
     Our peak borrowing timeframe varies with our working capital requirements and the seasonality of our business. Additionally, throughout the year, we may have further short-term borrowing requirements driven by other operational needs of our business. During 2009, borrowings from our commercial paper program in the U.S. peaked at $240 million. Borrowings from our line of credit facilities peaked at $245 million, reflecting payments for working capital requirements.
     Debt Covenants and Credit Ratings
     Certain of our senior notes have redemption features and non-financial covenants that will, among other things, limit our ability to create or assume liens, enter into sale and lease-back transactions, engage in mergers or consolidations and transfer or lease all or substantially all of our assets. Additionally, certain of our credit facilities and senior notes have financial covenants. These covenants are not, and it is not anticipated that they will become restrictive to our liquidity or capital resources. We are in compliance with all debt covenants. For a discussion of our covenants, see Note 8 Short-Term Borrowings and Long-Term Debt in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

38


Table of Contents

     Our credit ratings are periodically reviewed by rating agencies. Currently our long-term ratings from Moody’s and Standard and Poor’s are A2 and A, respectively. Changes in our operating results or financial position could impact the ratings assigned by the various agencies resulting in higher or lower borrowing costs.
     Pensions
     During 2010, we expect to contribute $158 million to fund our U.S. pension and postretirement plans. For further information about our pension and postretirement plan funding see section entitled “Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans” in our Critical Accounting Policies.
     Dividends
     On March 26, 2009, the Company announced that its Board of Directors approved an increase in the Company’s quarterly dividend from $0.17 to $0.18 per share on the outstanding common stock of the Company. This action resulted in a six percent increase in our quarterly dividend.
Contractual Obligations
     The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of December 26, 2009:
                                         
            Payments Due by Period  
                    2011-     2013-     2015 and  
Contractual Obligations   Total     2010     2012     2014     beyond  
Long-term debt obligations(1)
  $ 5,516     $ 8     $ 1,008     $ 1,700     $ 2,800  
Capital lease obligations(2)
    28       8       13       5       2  
Operating leases(2)
    249       56       61       31       101  
Interest obligations(3)
    2,666       287       639       481       1,259  
Purchase obligations:
                                       
Raw material obligations(4)
    408       387       21              
Capital expenditure obligations(5)
    50       50                    
Other obligations(6)
    224       127       62       13       22  
Other long-term liabilities(7)
    47       10       19       12       6  
 
                             
 
  $ 9,188     $ 933     $ 1,823     $ 2,242     $ 4,190  
 
                             
 
(1)   See Note 8 Short-Term Borrowings and Long-Term Debt in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information relating to our long-term debt obligations.
 
(2)   Capital lease obligation balances include imputed interest. See Note 9 Leases in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information relating to our lease obligations.
 
(3)   Represents interest payment obligations related to our long-term fixed-rate debt as specified in the applicable debt agreements. A portion of our long-term debt has variable interest rates due to existing swap agreements. We have estimated our variable interest payment obligations by using the interest rate forward curve where practical. Given uncertainties in future interest rates we have not included the beneficial impact of interest rate swaps after the year 2010.
 
(4)   Represents obligations to purchase raw materials pursuant to contracts entered into by PepsiCo on our behalf and international agreements to purchase raw materials.
 
(5)   Represents legally binding commitments to suppliers under capital expenditure related contracts or purchase orders.
 
(6)   Represents legally binding agreements to purchase goods or services that specify all significant terms, including: fixed or minimum quantities, price arrangements and timing of payments. If applicable, penalty, notice, or minimum purchase amount is used in the calculation. Balances also include non-cancelable customer contracts for sports marketing arrangements.
 
(7)   Primarily represents non-compete contracts and future payment obligations related to distribution rights that resulted from various acquisitions. The non-current portion of unrecognized tax benefits recorded on the balance sheet as of December 26, 2009 is not included in the table. There was no current portion of unrecognized tax benefits as of December 26, 2009. For additional information about our income taxes see Note 12 Income Taxes in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
     This table excludes our pension and postretirement liabilities recorded on the balance sheet. For a discussion of our future pension contributions, as well as expected pension and postretirement benefit payments see Note 11 Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

39


Table of Contents

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
     There are no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future material effect on our results of operations, financial condition, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.
MARKET RISKS AND CAUTIONARY STATEMENTS
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
     In the normal course of business, our financial position is routinely subject to a variety of risks. These risks include changes in the price of commodities purchased and used in our business, interest rates on outstanding debt and currency movements impacting our non-U.S. dollar denominated assets and liabilities. We are also subject to the risks associated with the business environment in which we operate. We regularly assess these risks and have strategies in place to reduce the adverse effects of these exposures.
     Our objective in managing our exposure to fluctuations in commodity prices, interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates is to minimize the volatility of earnings and cash flows associated with changes in the applicable rates and prices. To achieve this objective, we have derivative instruments to hedge against the risk of adverse movements in commodity prices, interest rates and foreign currency. We monitor our counterparty credit risk on an ongoing basis. Our corporate policy prohibits the use of derivative instruments for trading or speculative purposes, and we have procedures in place to monitor and control their use. See Note 10 Financial Instruments and Risk Management in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information relating to our derivative instruments.
     A sensitivity analysis has been prepared to determine the effects that market risk exposures may have on our financial instruments. These sensitivity analyses evaluate the effect of hypothetical changes in commodity prices, interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates and changes in our stock price on our unfunded deferred compensation liability. Information provided by these sensitivity analyses does not necessarily represent the actual changes in fair value that we would incur under normal market conditions because, due to practical limitations, all variables other than the specific market risk factor were held constant. As a result, the reported changes in the values of some financial instruments that are affected by the sensitivity analyses are not matched with the offsetting changes in the values of the items that those instruments are designed to finance or hedge.
     Commodity Price Risk
     We are subject to market risks with respect to commodities because our ability to recover increased costs through higher pricing may be limited by the competitive business environment in which we operate. We use forward and option contracts to hedge the risk of adverse movements in commodity prices related primarily to anticipated purchases of raw materials and energy used in our operations. With respect to commodity price risk, we currently have various contracts outstanding for commodity purchases in 2010 and 2011, which establish our purchase prices within defined ranges. We estimate that a 10 percent decrease in commodity prices with all other variables held constant would have resulted in a change in the fair value of our financial instruments of $48 million and $14 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
     Interest Rate Risk
     Interest rate risk is inherent to both fixed-rate and floating-rate debt. We effectively converted $1.25 billion of our senior notes to floating-rate debt through the use of interest rate swaps. Changes in interest rates on our interest rate swaps and other variable debt would change our interest expense. We estimate that a 50 basis point increase in interest rates on our variable rate debt and cash equivalents, with all other variables held constant, would have resulted in an increase to net interest expense of $4 million and $1 million in fiscal years 2009 and 2008, respectively.
     Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Risk
     In 2009, approximately 30 percent of our net revenues were generated from outside the United States. Social, economic and political conditions in these international markets may adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. The overall risks to our international businesses include changes in foreign governmental policies and other social, political or economic developments. These developments may lead to new product pricing, tax or other policies and monetary fluctuations that may adversely impact our business. In addition, our results of operations and the value of our foreign assets and liabilities are affected by fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates.

40


Table of Contents

     As currency exchange rates change, translation of the statements of operations of our businesses outside the U.S. into U.S. dollars affects year-over-year comparability. We generally have not hedged against these types of currency risks because cash flows from our international operations have been reinvested locally. We have foreign currency transactional risks in certain of our international territories for transactions that are denominated in currencies that are different from their functional currency. We have entered into forward exchange contracts to hedge portions of our forecasted U.S. dollar cash flows in these international territories. A 10 percent weaker U.S. dollar against the applicable foreign currency, with all other variables held constant, would result in a change in the fair value of these contracts of $16 million and $5 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
     In 2007, we entered into forward exchange contracts to economically hedge a portion of intercompany receivable balances that are denominated in Mexican pesos. A 10 percent weaker U.S. dollar versus the Mexican peso, with all other variables held constant, would result in a change of $4 million in the fair value of these contracts at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008.
     Unfunded Deferred Compensation Liability
     Our unfunded deferred compensation liability is subject to changes in our stock price, as well as price changes in certain other equity and fixed-income investments. We use prepaid forward contracts to hedge the portion of our deferred compensation liability that is based on our stock price. Therefore, changes in compensation expense as a result of changes in our stock price are substantially offset by the changes in the fair value of these contracts. We estimate that a 10 percent unfavorable change in the year-end stock price would have reduced the fair value from these forward contract commitments by $2 million and $1 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
Cautionary Statements
     Except for the historical information and discussions contained herein, statements contained in this annual report on Form 10-K may constitute forward-looking statements as defined by the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking statements are based on currently available competitive, financial and economic data and our operating plans. These statements involve a number of risks, uncertainties and other factors that could cause actual results to be materially different. Among the events and uncertainties that could adversely affect future periods are:
  risk associated with our pending merger with PepsiCo, including satisfaction of certain conditions of the pending merger, contractual restrictions on the conduct of our business included in the merger agreement, and the potential for loss of key personnel, disruption of our sales and operations or any impact on our relationships with third parties as a result of the pending merger;
  PepsiCo’s ability to affect matters concerning us through its equity ownership of PBG, representation on our Board and approval rights under our Master Bottling Agreement;
  material changes in expected levels of bottler incentive payments from PepsiCo;
  restrictions imposed by PepsiCo on our raw material suppliers that could increase our costs;
  material changes from expectations in the cost or availability of ingredients, packaging materials, other raw materials or energy, including changes resulting from restrictions on our suppliers required by PepsiCo;
  limitations on the availability of water or obtaining water rights;
  an inability to achieve strategic business plan targets;
  an inability to achieve cost savings;
  material changes in capital investment for infrastructure and an inability to achieve the expected timing for returns on cold-drink equipment and related infrastructure expenditures;
  decreased demand for our product resulting from changes in consumers’ preferences;
  an inability to achieve volume growth through product and packaging initiatives;
  impact of competitive activities on our business;
  impact of customer consolidations on our business;
  unfavorable weather conditions in our markets;
  an inability to successfully integrate acquired businesses or to meet projections for performance in newly acquired territories;
  loss of business from a significant customer;
  loss of key members of management;
  failure or inability to comply with laws and regulations;
  litigation, other claims and negative publicity relating to alleged unhealthy properties or environmental impact of our products;

41


Table of Contents

  changes in laws and regulations governing the manufacture and sale of food and beverages (including taxes on sweetened beverages), the environment, transportation, employee safety, labor and government contracts;
  changes in accounting standards and taxation requirements (including unfavorable outcomes from audits performed by various tax authorities);
  an increase in costs of pension, medical and other employee benefit costs;
  unfavorable market performance of assets in our pension plans or material changes in key assumptions used to calculate the liability of our pension plans, such as discount rate;
  unforeseen social, economic and political changes;
  possible recalls of our products;
  interruptions of operations due to labor disagreements;
  limitations on our ability to invest in our business as a result of our repayment obligations under our existing indebtedness;
  changes in our debt ratings, an increase in financing costs or limitations on our ability to obtain credit; and
  material changes in expected interest and currency exchange rates.

42


Table of Contents

AUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Operations
Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007
in millions, except per share data
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Net Revenues
  $ 13,219     $ 13,796     $ 13,591  
Cost of sales
    7,379       7,586       7,370  
 
                 
 
                       
Gross Profit
    5,840       6,210       6,221  
Selling, delivery and administrative expenses
    4,792       5,149       5,150  
Impairment charges
          412        
 
                 
 
                       
Operating Income
    1,048       649       1,071  
Interest expense, net
    303       290       274  
Other non-operating (income) expenses, net
    (4 )     25       (6 )
 
                 
 
                       
Income Before Income Taxes
    749       334       803  
Income tax expense
    43       112       177  
 
                 
 
                       
Net Income
    706       222       626  
Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
    94       60       94  
 
                 
Net Income Attributable to PBG
  $ 612     $ 162     $ 532  
 
                 
 
                       
Earnings per Share Attributable to PBG’s Common Shareholders
                       
Basic Earnings per Share
  $ 2.84     $ 0.75     $ 2.35  
 
                 
 
                       
Weighted-average shares outstanding
    216       216       226  
 
                       
Diluted Earnings per Share
  $ 2.77     $ 0.74     $ 2.29  
 
                 
 
                       
Weighted-average shares outstanding
    221       220       233  
 
                       
Dividends Declared per Common Share
  $ 0.71     $ 0.65     $ 0.53  
 
                 
See accompanying notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

43


Table of Contents

The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007
in millions
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Cash Flows—Operations
                       
Net income
  $ 706     $ 222     $ 626  
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operations:
                       
Depreciation and amortization
    637       673       669  
Deferred income taxes
    88       (47 )     (42 )
Share-based compensation
    58       56       62  
Impairment charges
          412        
Defined benefit pension and postretirement expenses
    98       114       121  
Casualty self-insurance expense
    76       87       90  
Net other non-cash charges and credits
    52       95       79  
Changes in operating working capital, excluding effects of acquisitions:
                       
Accounts receivable, net
    (67 )     40       (110 )
Inventories
    (46 )     3       (19 )
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    (26 )     10       (17 )
Accounts payable and other current liabilities
    55       (134 )     185  
Income taxes payable
    (147 )     14       9  
 
                 
Net change in operating working capital
    (231 )     (67 )     48  
Casualty insurance payments
    (70 )     (79 )     (70 )
Pension contributions to funded plans
    (229 )     (85 )     (70 )
Other operating activities, net
    (77 )     (97 )     (76 )
 
                 
Net Cash Provided by Operations
    1,108       1,284       1,437  
 
                 
 
                       
Cash Flows—Investments
                       
Capital expenditures
    (556 )     (760 )     (854 )
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
    (112 )     (279 )     (49 )
Investments in noncontrolled affiliates
    (2 )     (742 )      
Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment
    15       24       14  
Issuance of note receivable from noncontrolled affiliate
    (92 )            
Repayments of note receivable from noncontrolled affiliate
    28              
Other investing activities, net
    5       (1 )     6  
 
                 
Net Cash Used for Investments
    (714 )     (1,758 )     (883 )
 
                 
 
                       
Cash Flows—Financing
                       
Short-term borrowings, net—three months or less
    66       (108 )     (106 )
Proceeds from short-term borrowings – more than three months
          117       167  
Payments of short-term borrowings – more than three months
          (91 )     (211 )
Proceeds from issuances of long-term debt
    741       1,290       24  
Payments of long-term debt
    (1,330 )     (10 )     (42 )
Distribution to noncontrolling interest holder
    (30 )     (73 )     (17 )
Dividends paid
    (150 )     (135 )     (113 )
Excess tax benefit from the exercise of equity awards
    10       2       14  
Proceeds from the exercise of stock options
    202       42       159  
Share repurchases
          (489 )     (439 )
Contributions from noncontrolling interest holder
    33       308        
Other financing activities, net
    (12 )     (3 )      
 
                 
Net Cash (Used for) Provided by Financing
    (470 )     850       (564 )
 
                 
Effect of Exchange Rate Changes on Cash and Cash Equivalents
    17       (57 )     28  
 
                 
Net (Decrease) Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents
    (59 )     319       18  
Cash and Cash Equivalents—Beginning of Year
    966       647       629  
 
                 
Cash and Cash Equivalents—End of Year
  $ 907     $ 966     $ 647  
 
                 
See accompanying notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

44


Table of Contents

The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Consolidated Balance Sheets
December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008
in millions, except per share data
                 
    2009     2008  
ASSETS
               
Current Assets
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 907     $ 966  
Accounts receivable, net
    1,491       1,371  
Inventories
    600       528  
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    414       276  
 
           
Total Current Assets
    3,412       3,141  
 
               
Property, plant and equipment, net
    3,899       3,882  
Other intangible assets, net
    3,941       3,751  
Goodwill
    1,506       1,434  
Investments in noncontrolled affiliates
    627       619  
Other assets
    185       155  
 
           
Total Assets
  $ 13,570     $ 12,982  
 
           
 
               
LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
               
Current Liabilities
               
Accounts payable and other current liabilities
  $ 1,762     $ 1,675  
Short-term borrowings
    188       103  
Current maturities of long-term debt
    15       1,305  
 
           
Total Current Liabilities
    1,965       3,083  
 
               
Long-term debt
    5,449       4,784  
Other liabilities
    1,162       1,658  
Deferred income taxes
    1,285       966  
 
           
Total Liabilities
    9,861       10,491  
 
           
 
               
Equity
               
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share:
               
authorized 900 shares, issued 310 shares
    3       3  
Additional paid-in capital
    1,861       1,851  
Retained earnings
    3,585       3,130  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (596 )     (938 )
Treasury stock: 89 shares and 99 shares in 2009 and 2008, respectively, at cost
    (2,436 )     (2,703 )
 
           
Total PBG Shareholders’ Equity
    2,417       1,343  
Noncontrolling interests
    1,292       1,148  
 
           
Total Equity
    3,709       2,491  
 
           
Total Liabilities and Equity
  $ 13,570     $ 12,982  
 
           
See accompanying notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

45


Table of Contents

The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity
Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007

in millions, except per share data
                                                                         
                            Accumulated                                        
                            Other                                     Compre-  
            Additional             Compre-             Total PBG     Noncon-             hensive  
    Common     Paid-In     Retained     hensive     Treasury     Shareholders’     trolling     Total     Income  
    Stock     Capital     Earnings     Loss     Stock     Equity     Interests     Equity     (Loss)  
Balance at December 30, 2006
  $ 3     $ 1,751     $ 2,708     $ (361 )   $ (2,017 )   $ 2,084     $ 540     $ 2,624          
Comprehensive income:
                                                                       
Net income
                532                   532       94       626     $ 626  
Net currency translation adjustment
                      220             220       15       235       235  
Cash flow hedge adjustment, net of tax of $(1)
                      (1 )           (1 )           (1 )     (1 )
Pension and postretirement medical benefit plans adjustment, net of tax of $(61)
                      94             94       11       105       105  
 
                                                                     
Total comprehensive income
                                                                  $ 965  
 
                                                                     
Equity awards exercises: 7 shares
          (28 )                 187       159             159          
Tax benefit – equity awards
          22                         22             22          
Share repurchases: 13 shares
                            (439 )     (439 )           (439 )        
Share-based compensation
          60                         60             60          
Impact from the adoption of new income tax standard
                5                   5       (3 )     2          
Cash dividends declared on common stock (per share: $0.53)
                (121 )                 (121 )           (121 )        
Distribution to noncontrolling interest holder
                                        (17 )     (17 )        
Contributions from noncontrolling interest holder
                                        333       333          
 
                                                       
 
                                                                       
Balance at December 29, 2007
    3       1,805       3,124       (48 )     (2,269 )     2,615       973       3,588          
Comprehensive income (loss):
                                                                       
Net income
                162                   162       60       222     $ 222  
Net currency translation adjustment
                      (554 )           (554 )     (109 )     (663 )     (663 )
Cash flow hedge adjustment, net of tax of $24
                      (33 )           (33 )     (4 )     (37 )     (37 )
Pension and postretirement medical benefit plans adjustment, net of tax of $204
                      (322 )           (322 )     (38 )     (360 )     (360 )
 
                                                                     
Total comprehensive loss
                                                                  $ (838 )
 
                                                                     
Pension and postretirement measurement date adjustment, net of tax of $(5)
                (16 )     19             3             3          
Equity awards exercises: 2 shares
          (13 )                 55       42             42          
Tax benefit and withholding tax – equity awards
          2                         2             2          
Share repurchases: 15 shares
                            (489 )     (489 )           (489 )        
Share-based compensation
          57                         57             57          
Cash dividends declared on common stock (per share: $0.65)
                (140 )                 (140 )           (140 )        
Distribution to noncontrolling interest holder
                                        (73 )     (73 )        
Contributions from noncontrolling interest holder
                                        339       339          
 
                                                       
Balance at December 27, 2008
    3       1,851       3,130       (938 )     (2,703 )     1,343       1,148       2,491          
Comprehensive income:
                                                                       
Net income
                612                   612       94       706     $ 706  
Net currency translation adjustment
                      160             160       3       163       163  
Cash flow hedge adjustment, net of tax of $(43)
                      63             63       7       70       70  
Pension and postretirement medical benefit plans adjustment, net of tax of $(78)
                      119             119       14       133       133  
 
                                                                     
Total comprehensive income
                                                                  $ 1,072  
 
                                                                     
Equity awards exercises: 10 shares
          (65 )                 267       202             202          
Tax benefit – equity awards
          21                         21             21          
Withholding tax – equity awards
          (7 )                       (7 )           (7 )        
Share-based compensation
          55                         55             55          
Dividends declared on common stock and equity awards (per share: $0.71)
          6       (157 )                 (151 )           (151 )        
Distribution to noncontrolling interest holders
                                        (30 )     (30 )        
Contributions from noncontrolling interest holder
                                        56       56          
 
                                                       
Balance at December 26, 2009
  $ 3     $ 1,861     $ 3,585     $ (596 )   $ (2,436 )   $ 2,417     $ 1,292     $ 3,709          
 
                                                       
See accompanying notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

46


Table of Contents

The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007

in millions
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Net income
  $ 706     $ 222     $ 626  
Net currency translation adjustment
    163       (663 )     235  
Cash flow hedge adjustment, net of tax
    70       (37 )     (1 )
Pension and postretirement medical benefit plans adjustment, net of tax
    133       (360 )     105  
 
                 
Comprehensive income (loss)
    1,072       (838 )     965  
Less: Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests
    118       (91 )     120  
 
                 
Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to PBG
  $ 954     $ (747 )   $ 845  
 
                 
See accompanying notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

47


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Tabular dollars in millions, except per share data
Note 1—BASIS OF PRESENTATION
     The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. is the world’s largest manufacturer, seller and distributor of Pepsi-Cola beverages. We have the exclusive right to manufacture, sell and distribute Pepsi-Cola beverages in all or a portion of the U.S., Mexico, Canada, Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey. When used in these Consolidated Financial Statements, “PBG,” “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” each refers to The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and, where appropriate, to Bottling Group, LLC (“Bottling LLC”), our principal operating subsidiary.
     At December 26, 2009, PepsiCo, Inc. (“PepsiCo”) owned 70,166,458 shares of our common stock, consisting of 70,066,458 shares of common stock and all 100,000 authorized shares of Class B common stock. This represents approximately 31.7 percent of our outstanding common stock and 100 percent of our outstanding Class B common stock, together representing 38.6 percent of the voting power of all classes of our voting stock. In addition, PepsiCo owns approximately 6.6 percent of the equity of Bottling LLC and 40 percent of PR Beverages Limited (“PR Beverages”), a consolidated venture for our Russian operations, which was formed on March 1, 2007.
     The common stock and Class B common stock both have a par value of $0.01 per share and are substantially identical, except for voting rights. Holders of our common stock are entitled to one vote per share and holders of our Class B common stock are entitled to 250 votes per share. Each share of Class B common stock is convertible into one share of common stock. Holders of our common stock and holders of our Class B common stock share equally on a per-share basis in any dividend distributions.
     Our Board of Directors has the authority to provide for the issuance of up to 20,000,000 shares of preferred stock, and to determine the price and terms, including, but not limited to, preferences and voting rights of those shares without stockholder approval. At December 26, 2009, there was no preferred stock outstanding.
     On August 3, 2009, PBG and PepsiCo entered into a definitive merger agreement, under which PepsiCo will acquire all outstanding shares of PBG common stock it does not already own for the price of $36.50 in cash or 0.6432 shares of PepsiCo common stock, subject to proration such that the aggregate consideration to be paid to PBG shareholders shall be 50 percent in cash and 50 percent in PepsiCo common stock. At a special meeting of our shareholders held on February 17, 2010, our shareholders adopted the merger agreement. The transaction is subject to certain regulatory approvals and is expected to be finalized by the end of the first quarter of 2010.
Note 2—SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
     The preparation of our Consolidated Financial Statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“GAAP”) often requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts included in our Consolidated Financial Statements and related disclosures. We evaluate our estimates on an on-going basis using our historical experience as well as other factors we believe appropriate under the circumstances, such as current economic conditions, and adjust or revise our estimates as circumstances change. As future events and their effect cannot be determined with precision, actual results may differ from these estimates. In preparation of these financial statements, we have evaluated and assessed all events occurring subsequent to December 26, 2009 and through February 22, 2010, which is the date our financial statements were issued.
     Basis of Consolidation – We consolidate in our financial statements entities in which we have a controlling financial interest, as well as variable interest entities where we are the primary beneficiary. Noncontrolling interests in earnings and ownership has been recorded for the percentage of these entities not owned by PBG. In addition, we use the equity method of accounting to recognize investments in and income from entities where we have significant influence, but do not have a controlling financial interest. We have eliminated all intercompany accounts and transactions in consolidation.

48


Table of Contents

     Fiscal Year – Our U.S. and Canadian operations report using a fiscal year that consists of 52 weeks, ending on the last Saturday in December. Every five or six years a 53rd week is added. Fiscal years 2009, 2008 and 2007 consisted of 52 weeks. Our remaining countries report on a calendar-year basis. Accordingly, we recognize our quarterly business results as outlined below:
         
Quarter   U.S. & Canada   Mexico & Europe
First Quarter   12 weeks   January and February
Second Quarter   12 weeks   March, April and May
Third Quarter   12 weeks   June, July and August
Fourth Quarter   16 weeks   September, October, November and December
     Revenue Recognition – Revenue, net of sales returns, is recognized when our products are delivered to customers in accordance with the written sales terms. We offer certain sales incentives on a local and national level through various customer trade agreements designed to enhance the growth of our revenue, market share and consumer brand awareness. Customer trade agreements are accounted for as a reduction to our revenues.
     Customer trade agreements with our customers include payments for in-store displays, volume rebates, equipment placements, featured advertising and other growth incentives. A number of our customer trade agreements are based on quarterly and annual targets that generally do not exceed one year. Amounts recognized in our financial statements are based on amounts estimated to be paid to our customers depending upon current performance, historical experience, actual and forecasted volume and other performance criteria.
     Advertising and Marketing Costs – We are involved in a variety of programs to promote our products. We include advertising and marketing costs in selling, delivery and administrative expenses (“SD&A”). Advertising and marketing costs were $360 million, $437 million and $424 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively, before bottler incentives received from PepsiCo and other brand owners.
     Bottler Incentives – PepsiCo and other brand owners, at their discretion, provide us with various forms of bottler incentives. These incentives cover a variety of initiatives, including direct marketplace support and advertising support. We classify bottler incentives as follows:
    Direct marketplace support represents PepsiCo’s and other brand owners’ agreed-upon funding to assist us in offering sales and promotional discounts to retailers and is generally recorded as an adjustment to cost of sales. If the direct marketplace support is a reimbursement for a specific, incremental and identifiable program, the funding is recorded as an offset to the cost of the program either in net revenues or SD&A.
 
    Advertising support represents agreed-upon funding to assist us with the cost of media time and promotional materials and is generally recorded as an adjustment to cost of sales. Advertising support that represents reimbursement for a specific, incremental and identifiable media cost, is recorded as a reduction to advertising and marketing expenses within SD&A.
     Total bottler incentives recognized as adjustments to net revenues, cost of sales and SD&A in our Consolidated Statements of Operations were as follows:
                         
    Fiscal Year Ended  
    2009     2008     2007  
Net revenues
  $ 100     $ 93     $ 66  
Cost of sales
    539       586       626  
Selling, delivery and administrative expenses
    47       57       67  
 
                 
Total bottler incentives
  $ 686     $ 736     $ 759  
 
                 
     Share-Based Compensation – The Company grants a combination of stock option awards and restricted stock units to our middle and senior management and our Board of Directors. See Note 4 Share-based Compensation for further discussion on our share-based compensation.
     Shipping and Handling Costs – Our shipping and handling costs reported in the Consolidated Statements of Operations are recorded primarily within SD&A. Such costs recorded within SD&A totaled $1.7 billion in 2009, 2008 and 2007.

49


Table of Contents

     Foreign Currency Gains and Losses and Currency Translation – We translate the balance sheets of our foreign subsidiaries at the exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date, while we translate the statements of operations at the average rates of exchange during the year. The resulting translation adjustments of our foreign subsidiaries are included in accumulated other comprehensive loss (“AOCL”), net of noncontrolling interests on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Transactional gains and losses on our financial assets and liabilities arising from the impact of currency exchange rate fluctuations on transactions in foreign currency that is different from the local functional currency are included in other non-operating (income) expenses, net in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.
     Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans – We sponsor pension and other postretirement medical benefit plans in various forms in the U.S. and other similar plans in our international locations, covering employees who meet specified eligibility requirements.
     Based on new pension accounting rules, we began to recognize the overfunded or underfunded status of each of the pension and other postretirement plans beginning on December 30, 2006. In addition, on December 30, 2007, we changed our measurement date to the year-end balance sheet date for our plan assets, liabilities and expenses. For fiscal years ended 2007 and prior, the majority of the pension and other postretirement plans used a September 30 measurement date and all plan assets and obligations were generally reported as of that date. As part of measuring the plan assets and benefit obligations on December 30, 2007, we adjusted our opening balances of retained earnings and AOCL for the change in net periodic benefit cost and fair value, respectively, from the previously used September 30 measurement date. The adoption of the measurement date provisions resulted in a net decrease in the pension and other postretirement medical benefit plans liability of $9 million, a net decrease in retained earnings of $16 million, net of noncontrolling interests of $2 million and taxes of $9 million and a net decrease in AOCL of $19 million, net of noncontrolling interests of $2 million and taxes of $14 million. There was no impact on our results of operations.
     The determination of pension and postretirement medical benefit plan obligations and related expenses requires the use of assumptions to estimate the amount of benefits that employees earn while working, as well as the present value of those benefit obligations. Significant assumptions include discount rate; expected rate of return on plan assets; certain employee-related factors such as retirement age, mortality, and turnover; rate of salary increases for plans where benefits are based on earnings; and for retiree medical plans, health care cost trend rates. We evaluate these assumptions on an annual basis at each measurement date based upon historical experience of the plans and management’s best judgment regarding future expectations.
     Differences between the assumed rate of return and actual return on plan assets are deferred in AOCL in equity and amortized to earnings utilizing the market-related value method. Under this method, differences between the assumed rate of return and actual rate of return from any one year will be recognized over a five-year period in the market-related value.
     Differences between assumed and actual returns on plan assets and other gains and losses resulting from changes in actuarial assumptions are determined at each measurement date and deferred in AOCL in equity. To the extent the amount of all unrecognized gains and losses exceeds 10 percent of the larger of the benefit obligation or the market-related value of plan assets, such amount is amortized to earnings over the average remaining service period of active participants.
     The cost or benefit from benefit plan changes is also deferred in AOCL in equity and amortized to earnings on a straight-line basis over the average remaining service period of the employees expected to receive benefits.
     See Note 11 Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans for further discussion on our pension and postretirement medical benefit plans.
     Income Taxes – Our effective tax rate is based on pre-tax income, statutory tax rates, tax laws and regulations and tax planning strategies available to us in the various jurisdictions in which we operate.
     Our deferred tax assets and liabilities reflect our best estimate of the tax benefits and costs we expect to realize in the future. We establish valuation allowances to reduce our deferred tax assets to an amount that will more likely than not be realized.
     Effective fiscal year 2007, we adopted the new income tax standard and began to recognize the impact of our tax positions in our financial statements if those positions will more likely than not be sustained on audit, based on the technical merit of the position. The impact of adopting this standard was recorded by adjusting opening retained earnings.

50


Table of Contents

     Significant management judgment is required in evaluating our tax positions and in determining our effective tax rate.
     See Note 12 Income Taxes for further discussion on our income taxes.
     Earnings Per Share – We compute basic earnings per share by dividing net income attributable to PBG by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted earnings per share reflect the potential dilution that could occur if stock options or other equity awards from stock compensation plans were exercised and converted into common stock that would then participate in net income.
     Cash and Cash Equivalents – Cash and cash equivalents include all highly liquid investments with original maturities not exceeding three months at the time of purchase. The fair value of our cash and cash equivalents approximates the amounts shown on our Consolidated Balance Sheets due to their short-term nature.
     Allowance for Doubtful Accounts – A portion of our accounts receivable will not be collected due to non-payment, bankruptcies and sales returns. We reserve an amount based on the evaluation of the aging of accounts receivable, sales return trend analysis, detailed analysis of high-risk customers’ accounts, and the overall market and economic conditions of our customers.
     Inventories – We value our inventories at the lower of cost or net realizable value. The cost of our inventory is generally computed using the average cost method.
     Property, Plant and Equipment – We record property, plant and equipment (“PP&E”) at cost, except for PP&E that has been impaired, for which we write down the carrying amount to estimated fair market value, which then becomes the new cost basis.
     We depreciate PP&E on a straight-line basis over the estimated lives as follows:
     
Buildings and improvements
  20-33 years
Manufacturing and distribution equipment
  2-15 years
Marketing equipment
  2-7 years
     Other Intangible Assets, net and Goodwill – Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives and goodwill are not amortized; however, they are evaluated for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if facts and circumstances indicate that the assets may be impaired.
     Intangible assets that are determined to have a finite life are amortized on a straight-line basis over the period in which we expect to receive economic benefit, which generally ranges from five to twenty years, and are evaluated for impairment only if facts and circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the asset may not be recoverable.
     The determination of the expected life depends upon the use and the underlying characteristics of the intangible asset. In our evaluation of the expected life of these intangible assets, we consider the nature and terms of the underlying agreements; our intent and ability to use the specific asset; the age and market position of the products within the territories in which we are entitled to sell; the historical and projected growth of those products; and costs, if any, to renew the related agreement.
     See Note 6 Other Intangible Assets, net and Goodwill for further discussion on our goodwill and other intangible assets.
     Casualty Insurance Costs – In the United States, we use a combination of insurance and self-insurance mechanisms, including a wholly owned captive insurance entity. This captive entity participates in a reinsurance pool for a portion of our workers’ compensation risk. We provide self-insurance for the workers’ compensation risk retained by the Company and automobile risks up to $10 million per occurrence, and product and general liability risks up to $5 million per occurrence. For losses exceeding these self-insurance thresholds, we purchase casualty insurance from a third-party provider. Our liability for casualty costs is estimated using individual case-based valuations and statistical analyses and is based upon historical experience, actuarial assumptions and professional judgment. We do not discount our loss expense reserves.
     At December 26, 2009, our net liability for casualty costs was $240 million, of which $70 million was considered short-term in nature. At December 27, 2008, our net liability for casualty costs was $235 million, of which $70 million was considered short-term in nature.

51


Table of Contents

     Noncontrolling Interests – Noncontrolling interests are recorded for the entities that we consolidate but are not wholly owned by PBG. Noncontrolling interests recorded in our Consolidated Financial Statements is primarily comprised of PepsiCo’s share of Bottling LLC and PR Beverages. At December 26, 2009, PepsiCo owned 6.6 percent of Bottling LLC and 40 percent of PR Beverages venture.
     Treasury Stock – We record the repurchase of shares of our common stock at cost and classify these shares as treasury stock within PBG shareholders’ equity. Repurchased shares are included in our authorized and issued shares but not included in our shares outstanding. We record shares reissued using an average cost. At December 26, 2009, we had 175 million shares authorized under our share repurchase program. Since the inception of our share repurchase program in October 1999, we have repurchased approximately 146 million shares and have reissued approximately 57 million for stock option exercises.
     Financial Instruments and Risk Management –All derivative instruments are recorded at fair value as either assets or liabilities in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Derivative instruments are generally designated and accounted for as either a hedge of a recognized asset or liability (“fair value hedge”) or a hedge of a forecasted transaction (“cash flow hedge”). Certain of these derivatives are not designated as hedging instruments and are used as “economic hedges” to manage certain risks in our business.
     For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as a cash flow hedge, the effective portion of the change in the fair value of a derivative instrument is deferred in AOCL until the underlying hedged item is recognized in earnings. The derivative gain or loss recognized in earnings is recorded consistent with the expense classification of the underlying hedged item. The ineffective portion of a fair value change on a qualifying cash flow hedge is recognized in earnings immediately. For derivatives that receive fair value hedge treatment, we recognize the change in fair value for both the derivative and hedged item currently in earnings.
     Derivative instruments that are not designated as hedging instruments, but are used as economic hedges to manage certain risks in our business, are marked-to-market on a periodic basis and recognized currently in earnings consistent with the expense classification of the underlying hedged item.
     Commitments and Contingencies – We are subject to various claims and contingencies related to lawsuits, environmental and other matters arising out of the normal course of business. Liabilities related to commitments and contingencies are recognized when a loss is probable and reasonably estimable.
New Accounting Standards
     Accounting Codification
     In June 2009, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Codification Update No. 2009-01 (“ASU No. 2009-1”), “Topic 105 – Generally Accepted Accounting Principles,” which establishes the FASB Accounting Standards CodificationTM (“Codification”) as the source of authoritative accounting principles recognized by the FASB to be applied in the preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. The guidance also explicitly recognizes rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) under federal securities laws as authoritative GAAP for SEC registrants. This standard became effective in the fourth quarter of 2009 and required the Company to update all GAAP references to refer to the new Codification topics, where applicable.
     Variable Interest Entity
     In June 2009, the FASB issued an accounting standard on variable interest entities, which was incorporated into the Consolidation topic of the Codification, to address the elimination of the concept of a qualifying special purpose entity. This standard also replaces the quantitative-based risks and rewards calculation for determining which enterprise has a controlling financial interest in a variable interest entity with an approach focused on identifying which enterprise has the power to direct the activities of a variable interest entity and the obligation to absorb losses of the entity or the right to receive benefits from the entity. Additionally, it provides more timely and useful information about an enterprise’s involvement with a variable interest entity. The standard will become effective in the first quarter of 2010. We do not expect that this standard will have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Postretirement Benefit Plan Disclosure
     In December 2008, the FASB issued an accounting standard enhancing employer’s disclosures about postretirement benefit plan assets, which was incorporated into the Codification topic Compensation – Retirement Benefits. This new standard requires companies to disclose information about the fair value measurement of plan

52


Table of Contents

assets. The standard became effective in the fourth quarter of 2009. See Note 11 Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans for further information.
     Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activity
     In March 2008, the FASB issued an accounting standard, which was incorporated into the Derivatives and Hedging topic of the Codification, requiring enhanced disclosure for derivative and hedging activities. The standard became effective in the first quarter of 2009. See Note 10 Financial Instruments and Risk Management for the required disclosures.
     Business Combinations
     In December 2007, the FASB issued an accounting standard which addresses the accounting and disclosure for identifiable assets acquired, liabilities assumed, and noncontrolling interests in a business combination. The standard, which was incorporated into the Business Combinations topic of the Codification, became effective in 2009 and did not have a material impact on our Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Noncontrolling Interests
     In December 2007, the FASB issued an accounting standard on noncontrolling interests which addresses the accounting and reporting framework for noncontrolling interests by a parent company. The standard, which was incorporated into the Consolidation topic of the Codification, also addresses disclosure requirements to distinguish between interests of the parent and interests of the noncontrolling owners of a subsidiary. The standard became effective in the first quarter of 2009 and required that minority interest be renamed noncontrolling interests and that a company present a consolidated net income measure that includes the amount attributable to such noncontrolling interests for all periods presented. In addition, it requires reporting noncontrolling interests as a component of equity in our Consolidated Balance Sheets and below income tax expense in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. We have retrospectively applied the presentation to our prior year balances in our Consolidated Financial Statements.
Note 3—EARNINGS PER SHARE
     The following table reconciles the shares outstanding and net income attributable to PBG used in the computations of both basic and diluted earnings per share attributable to PBG’s common shareholders:
                         
Shares in millions   Fiscal Year Ended  
    2009     2008     2007  
Net income attributable to PBG
  $ 612     $ 162     $ 532  
Weighted-average shares outstanding during period on which basic earnings per share is calculated
    216       216       226  
Effect of dilutive shares
                       
Incremental shares under stock compensation plans
    5       4       7  
 
                 
Weighted-average shares outstanding during period on which diluted earnings per share is calculated
    221       220       233  
 
                 
 
                       
Earnings per share attributable to PBG’s common shareholders
                       
Basic earnings per share
  $ 2.84     $ 0.75     $ 2.35  
 
                 
Diluted earnings per share
  $ 2.77     $ 0.74     $ 2.29  
 
                 
     Basic earnings per share are calculated by dividing the net income attributable to PBG by the weighted-average number of shares outstanding during each period. Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if stock options or other equity awards from our stock compensation plans were exercised and converted into common stock that would then participate in net income.
     Diluted earnings per share for the fiscal years ended 2009 and 2008 exclude the dilutive effect of 8.4 million and 11.6 million stock options, respectively. These shares were excluded from the diluted earnings per share computation because for the years noted, the exercise price of the stock options was greater than the average market price of the Company’s common shares during the related periods and the effect of including the stock options in the computation would be anti-dilutive. For the fiscal year ended 2007, there were no stock options excluded from the diluted earnings per share calculation.

53


Table of Contents

Note 4—SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION
Accounting for Share-Based Compensation
     Effective January 1, 2006, the Company began recognizing compensation expense for equity awards over the vesting period based on their grant-date fair value. The Company uses the modified prospective approach. Under this transition method, the measurement and our method of amortization of costs for share-based payments granted prior to, but not vested as of January 1, 2006, would be based on the same estimate of the grant-date fair value and the same amortization method that was previously used in our pro forma disclosure. Results for prior periods have not been restated as provided for under the modified prospective approach. For equity awards granted after the date of adoption, we amortize share-based compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the vesting term.
     Compensation expense is recognized only for share-based payments expected to vest. We estimate forfeitures, both at the date of grant as well as throughout the vesting period, based on the Company’s historical experience and future expectations.
     Total share-based compensation expense recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Operations is as follows:
                         
    Fiscal Year Ended  
    2009     2008     2007  
Total share-based compensation expense
  $ 58     $ 56     $ 62  
Income tax benefit
    (17 )     (16 )     (17 )
Noncontrolling interests
    (5 )     (3 )     (5 )
 
                 
Net income attributable to PBG impact
  $ 36     $ 37     $ 40  
 
                 
Share-Based Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plans
     We grant a mix of stock options and restricted stock units to middle and senior management employees and our Board of Directors under our incentive plans.
     Shares available for future issuance to employees and our Board of Directors under existing plans were 9.5 million at December 26, 2009.
     The fair value of PBG stock options was estimated at the date of grant using the Black-Scholes-Merton option-valuation model. The table below outlines the weighted-average assumptions for options granted during years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007:
                         
    2009   2008   2007
Risk-free interest rate
    2.2 %     2.8 %     4.5 %
Expected term (in years)
    5.3       5.3       5.6  
Expected volatility
    30 %     24 %     25 %
Expected dividend yield
    2.8 %     2.0 %     1.8 %
     The risk-free interest rate is based on the implied yield available on U.S. Treasury zero-coupon issues with an equivalent remaining expected term. The expected term of the options represents the estimated period of time employees will retain their vested stocks until exercise. Due to the lack of historical experience in stock option exercises, we estimate expected term utilizing a combination of the simplified method and historical experience of similar awards, giving consideration to the contractual terms, vesting schedules and expectations of future employee behavior. Expected stock price volatility is based on a combination of historical volatility of the Company’s stock and the implied volatility of its traded options. The expected dividend yield is management’s long-term estimate of annual dividends to be paid as a percentage of share price.
     The fair value of restricted stock units is based on the fair value of PBG stock on the date of grant.
     We receive a tax deduction for certain stock option exercises when the options are exercised, generally for the excess of the stock price over the exercise price of the options. Additionally, we receive a tax deduction for certain restricted stock units equal to the fair market value of PBG’s stock at the date the restricted stock units are converted to PBG stock. GAAP requires that benefits received from tax deductions up to the grant-date fair value of equity awards be reported as operating cash inflows in our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. Benefits from tax deductions in excess of the grant-date fair value from equity awards are treated as financing cash inflows in our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. For the year ended December 26, 2009, we recognized $36 million in tax

54


Table of Contents

benefits from equity awards in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, of which $10 million was recorded in the financing section with the remaining being recorded in cash from operations.
     As of December 26, 2009, there was approximately $71 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested share-based compensation arrangements granted under the incentive plans. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.8 years.
Stock Options
     Stock options expire after 10 years and generally vest ratably over three years. Stock options granted to our Board of Directors are typically fully vested on the grant date.
     The following table summarizes option activity during the year ended December 26, 2009:
                                 
            Weighted-   Weighted-    
            Average   Average    
            Exercise   Remaining    
    Shares   Price   Contractual   Aggregate
    (in millions)   per Share   Term (years)   Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at December 27, 2008
    28.0     $ 26.50       5.5     $ 35  
Granted
    5.8     $ 18.93                  
Exercised
    (9.1 )   $ 22.23                  
Forfeited
    (0.8 )   $ 25.32                  
 
                               
Outstanding at December 26, 2009
    23.9     $ 26.33       6.2     $ 268  
 
Vested or expected to vest at December 26, 2009
    23.2     $ 26.46       6.1     $ 258  
 
Exercisable at December 26, 2009
    14.8     $ 27.57       4.7     $ 148  
 
     The aggregate intrinsic value in the table above is before income taxes, based on the Company’s closing stock price of $37.56 and $22.00 as of the last business day of the years ended December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
     For the years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007, the weighted-average grant-date fair value of stock options granted was $4.55, $7.10 and $8.19, respectively. The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised during the years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007 was $98 million, $21 million and $100 million, respectively.
Restricted Stock Units
     Restricted stock units granted to employees generally vest over three years. In addition, restricted stock unit awards to certain senior executives contain vesting provisions that are contingent upon the achievement of pre-established performance targets. The initial restricted stock unit award to our Board of Directors remains restricted while the individual serves on the Board. The annual grants to our Board of Directors vest immediately, but receipt of the shares may be deferred. All restricted stock unit awards are settled in shares of PBG common stock.
     The following table summarizes restricted stock unit activity during the year ended December 26, 2009:
                                 
                    Weighted-    
            Weighted-   Average    
    Shares   Average   Remaining   Aggregate
    (in   Grant-Date   Contractual   Intrinsic
    thousands)   Fair Value   Term (years)   Value
Outstanding at December 27, 2008
    3,353     $ 31.97       1.3     $ 74  
Granted
    1,887     $ 18.82                  
Converted
    (930 )   $ 29.39                  
Forfeited
    (208 )   $ 29.15                  
 
                               
Outstanding at December 26, 2009
    4,102     $ 26.65       1.4     $ 154  
 
Vested or expected to vest at December 26, 2009
    3,593     $ 26.69       1.4     $ 135  
 
Convertible at December 26, 2009
    60     $ 27.05           $ 2  
 

55


Table of Contents

     For the years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007, the weighted-average grant-date fair value of restricted stock units granted was $18.82, $35.38 and $31.02, respectively. The total intrinsic value of restricted stock units converted during the years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007 was approximately $19 million, $4 million and $575 thousand, respectively.
Note 5—BALANCE SHEET DETAILS
                 
    2009     2008  
Accounts Receivable, net
               
Trade accounts receivable
  $ 1,278     $ 1,208  
Allowance for doubtful accounts
    (69 )     (71 )
Accounts receivable from PepsiCo
    210       154  
Other receivables
    72       80  
 
           
 
  $ 1,491     $ 1,371  
 
           
 
               
Inventories
               
Raw materials and supplies
  $ 220     $ 185  
Finished goods
    380       343  
 
           
 
  $ 600     $ 528  
 
           
 
               
Prepaid Expenses and Other Current Assets
               
Prepaid expenses
  $ 317     $ 244  
Other current assets
    97       32  
 
           
 
  $ 414     $ 276  
 
           
 
               
Property, Plant and Equipment, net(1)
               
Land
  $ 306     $ 300  
Buildings and improvements
    1,704       1,542  
Manufacturing and distribution equipment
    4,192       3,999  
Marketing equipment
    2,192       2,246  
Capital leases(2)
    46       23  
Other
    153       154  
 
           
 
    8,593       8,264  
Accumulated depreciation
    (4,694 )     (4,382 )
 
           
 
  $ 3,899     $ 3,882  
 
           
 
(1)   Pursuant to the terms of an industrial revenue bond, we transferred title of certain fixed assets with a net book value of $70 million to a state governmental authority in the U.S. to receive a property tax abatement. The title to these assets will revert back to PBG upon retirement or cancellation of the bond. These fixed assets are still recognized in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets as all risks and rewards remain with the Company.
 
(2)   Capital leases primarily represent manufacturing and office equipment.
                 
    2009     2008  
Other Assets
               
Note receivable from noncontrolled affiliate
  $ 73     $  
Other assets
    112       155  
 
           
 
  $ 185     $ 155  
 
           
                 
    2009     2008  
Accounts Payable and Other Current Liabilities
               
Accounts payable
  $ 497     $ 444  
Accounts payable to PepsiCo
    204       217  
Trade incentives
    232       189  
Accrued compensation and benefits
    256       240  
Other accrued taxes
    121       128  
Accrued interest
    86       85  
Other current liabilities
    366       372  
 
           
 
  $ 1,762     $ 1,675  
 
           

56


Table of Contents

Note 6—OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS, NET AND GOODWILL
     The components of other intangible assets are as follows:
                 
    2009     2008  
Intangibles subject to amortization:
               
Gross carrying amount:
               
Customer relationships and lists
  $ 47     $ 45  
Franchise and distribution rights
    79       41  
Other identified intangibles
    26       34  
 
           
 
    152       120  
 
           
Accumulated amortization:
               
Customer relationships and lists
    (18 )     (15 )
Franchise and distribution rights
    (36 )     (31 )
Other identified intangibles
    (7 )     (21 )
 
           
 
    (61 )     (67 )
 
           
Intangibles subject to amortization, net
    91       53  
 
           
 
               
Intangibles not subject to amortization:
               
Carrying amount:
               
Franchise rights
    3,390       3,244  
Licensing rights
    315       315  
Distribution rights
    52       49  
Brands
    40       39  
Other identified intangibles
    53       51  
 
           
Intangibles not subject to amortization
    3,850       3,698  
 
           
Total other intangible assets, net
  $ 3,941     $ 3,751  
 
           
     During the second quarter of 2009, we acquired a Pepsi-Cola and Dr Pepper franchise bottler serving portions of central Texas. As a result of this acquisition we recorded approximately $56 million of non-amortizable franchise rights and $8 million of non-compete agreements, with a weighted-average amortization period of 5 years.
     During the third quarter of 2009, we acquired a Pepsi-Cola franchise bottler serving northeastern Massachusetts. As a result of this acquisition we recorded approximately $24 million of non-amortizable franchise rights and $1 million of non-compete agreements, with a weighted-average amortization period of 5 years.
     During 2009, we acquired distribution rights for certain energy drinks in the United States, Canada and Mexico, and protein-enhanced functional beverages in the United States. As a result of these acquisitions we recorded approximately $36 million of amortizable distribution rights, with a weighted-average amortization period of 10 years.
     During 2009, we acquired rights to manufacture and distribute Crush brands in portions of the United States and recorded approximately $4 million of non-amortizable franchise rights.
     During the first quarter of 2008, we acquired a Pepsi-Cola franchise bottler serving certain New York counties in whole or in part. As a result of the acquisition we recorded approximately $18 million of non-amortizable franchise rights and $4 million of non-compete agreements, with a weighted-average amortization period of 10 years.
     During the first quarter of 2008, we acquired distribution rights for SoBe brands in portions of Arizona and Texas and recorded approximately $6 million of non-amortizable distribution rights.
     During the fourth quarter of 2008, we acquired a Pepsi-Cola franchise bottler serving portions of Colorado, Arizona and New Mexico. As a result of the acquisition we recorded approximately $176 million of non-amortizable franchise rights.
     The total cost of acquisitions and distribution and franchise rights during 2009 and 2008 was approximately $132 million and $279 million, respectively.
Intangible Asset Amortization
     Intangible asset amortization expense was $10 million, $9 million and $10 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Amortization expense for each of the next five years is estimated to be approximately $12 million or less.

57


Table of Contents

Goodwill
     The changes in the carrying value of goodwill by reportable segment for the years ended December 27, 2008 and December 26, 2009 are as follows:
                                 
            U.S. &              
    Total     Canada     Europe     Mexico  
Balance at December 29, 2007
  $ 1,533     $ 1,290     $ 17     $ 226  
Purchase price allocations
    27       20       13       (6 )
Impact of foreign currency translation and other
    (126 )     (75 )     (4 )     (47 )
 
                       
Balance at December 27, 2008
    1,434       1,235       26       173  
Purchase price allocations
    13       11       2        
Impact of foreign currency translation and other
    59       49             10  
 
                       
Balance at December 26, 2009
  $ 1,506     $ 1,295     $ 28     $ 183  
 
                       
     During 2009, the purchase price allocations in the U.S. & Canada segment primarily relate to goodwill allocations resulting from changes in taxes associated with our previous acquisitions.
     During 2008, the purchase price allocations in the U.S. & Canada segment primarily relate to goodwill allocations resulting from the acquisitions discussed above. In the Europe segment, the purchase price allocations primarily relate to Russia’s purchase of a company that will manufacture various Pepsi products in Siberia and Eastern Russia. The purchase price allocations in the Mexico segment primarily relate to goodwill allocations resulting from changes in taxes associated with our previous acquisitions.
Annual Impairment Testing
     The Company completed its impairment test of goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets during the third quarter of 2009 and recorded no impairment charge. In the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company recorded $412 million in non-cash impairment charges ($277 million net of tax and noncontrolling interests), relating primarily to distribution rights and brands for the Electropura water business in Mexico. The impairment charge relating to these intangible assets was determined based upon the findings of an extensive strategic review and the finalization of certain restructuring plans for our Mexican business. The fair value of our distribution rights was estimated using a multi-period excess earnings method that is based upon estimated discounted future cash flows. The fair value of our brands was estimated using a multi-period royalty savings method, which reflects the savings realized by owning the brand and, therefore, not having to pay a royalty fee to a third party.
Note 7—FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
     During 2008, the Company began disclosing the fair value of all financial instruments valued on a recurring basis, at least annually. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. It also establishes a three level fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs used to measure fair value. The three levels of the hierarchy are defined as follows:
Level 1 — Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
Level 2 — Observable inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1, such as quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in non-active markets, quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets and inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.
Level 3 — Unobservable inputs reflecting management’s own assumptions about the input used in pricing the asset or liability.
     If the inputs used to measure the financial instruments fall within different levels of the hierarchy, the categorization is based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement of the instrument.

58


Table of Contents

     The following table summarizes the financial assets and liabilities we measure at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008:
                 
    Level 2  
    2009     2008  
Financial Assets:
               
Commodity contracts(1)
  $ 81     $  
Foreign currency contracts (1)
          13  
Prepaid forward contracts (2)
    15       13  
Interest rate swaps (3)
          8  
 
           
 
  $ 96     $ 34  
 
           
 
               
Financial Liabilities:
               
Commodity contracts (1)
  $ 3     $ 57  
Foreign currency contracts (1)
    6       6  
Interest rate swaps (3)
    64       1  
 
           
 
  $ 73     $ 64  
 
           
 
(1)   Based primarily on the forward rates of the specific indices upon which contract settlement is based.
 
(2)   Based primarily on the value of our stock price.
 
(3)   Based primarily on the London Inter-Bank Offer Rate (“LIBOR”) index.
Other Financial Assets and Liabilities
     Financial assets with carrying values approximating fair value include cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable. Financial liabilities with carrying values approximating fair value include accounts payable and other accrued liabilities and short-term debt. The carrying values of these financial assets and liabilities approximates fair value due to their short maturities and since interest rates approximate current market rates for short-term debt.
     Long-term debt, which includes the current maturities of long-term debt, at December 26, 2009, had a carrying value and fair value of $5.5 billion and $6.1 billion, respectively and at December 27, 2008, had a carrying value and fair value of $6.1 billion and $6.4 billion, respectively. The fair value is based on interest rates that are currently available to us for issuance of debt with similar terms and remaining maturities.

59


Table of Contents

Note 8—SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS AND LONG-TERM DEBT
                 
    2009     2008  
Short-term borrowings
               
Current maturities of long-term debt
  $ 15     $ 1,305  
Other short-term borrowings
    188       103  
 
           
 
  $ 203     $ 1,408  
 
           
 
               
Long-term debt
               
5.63% (5.0% effective rate) (2) (3) senior notes due 2009
  $     $ 1,300  
4.63% (4.6% effective rate) (3) senior notes due 2012
    1,000       1,000  
5.00% (5.2% effective rate) senior notes due 2013
    400       400  
6.95% (7.4% effective rate) (3) senior notes due 2014
    1,300       1,300  
4.13% (4.4% effective rate) senior notes due 2015
    250       250  
5.50% (5.3% effective rate) (2) senior notes due 2016
    800       800  
5.125% (4.9% effective rate) (2) senior notes due 2019
    750        
7.00% (7.1% effective rate) senior notes due 2029
    1,000       1,000  
Capital lease obligations (Note 9)
    25       8  
Other (average rate 3.8%)
    16       37  
 
           
 
    5,541       6,095  
 
               
Fair value hedge adjustment (1)
    (64 )     6  
Unamortized discount, net
    (13 )     (12 )
Current maturities of long-term debt
    (15 )     (1,305 )
 
           
 
  $ 5,449     $ 4,784  
 
           
 
(1)   The portion of our fixed-rate debt obligations that is hedged is reflected in our Consolidated Balance Sheets as an amount equal to the sum of the debt’s carrying value plus a fair value adjustment, representing changes recorded in the fair value of the hedged debt obligations attributable to movements in market interest rates.
 
(2)   Effective interest rates include the impact of the gain/loss realized on swap instruments and represent the rates that were achieved in 2009.
 
(3)   These notes are guaranteed by PepsiCo.
Aggregate Maturities — Long-Term Debt
     Aggregate maturities of long-term debt as of December 26, 2009 are as follows: 2010: $8 million, 2011: $8 million, 2012: $1,000 million, 2013: $400 million, 2014: $1,300 million, 2015 and thereafter: $2,800 million. The maturities of long-term debt do not include the capital lease obligations, the non-cash impact of the fair value hedge adjustment and the interest effect of the unamortized discount.
     On January 14, 2009, we issued $750 million in senior notes, with a coupon rate of 5.125 percent, maturing in 2019. The net proceeds of the offering, together with a portion of the proceeds from the offering of our senior notes issued in the fourth quarter of 2008, were used to repay our senior notes due in 2009, at their scheduled maturity on February 17, 2009. Any excess proceeds of this offering were used for general corporate purposes. The next significant scheduled debt maturity is not until 2012.
     On October 24, 2008, we issued $1.3 billion of 6.95 percent senior notes due 2014 (the “Notes”). The Notes were guaranteed by PepsiCo on February 17, 2009. A portion of the proceeds of this debt was used to finance acquisitions and repay short-term commercial paper debt.
2009 Short-Term Debt Activities
     We have a committed credit facility of $1.2 billion and an uncommitted credit facility of $500 million. Both of these credit facilities are guaranteed by Bottling LLC and are used to support our $1.2 billion commercial paper program and working capital requirements.
     We had no commercial paper outstanding at December 26, 2009 or December 27, 2008.
     In addition to the credit facilities discussed above, we had available short-term bank credit lines of approximately $892 million at year-end 2009, of which the majority was uncommitted. These lines were primarily used to support the general operating needs of our international locations. As of December 26, 2009, we had $188

60


Table of Contents

million outstanding under these lines of credit at a weighted-average interest rate of 3.1 percent. As of December 27, 2008, we had available short-term bank credit lines of approximately $772 million with $103 million outstanding at a weighted-average interest rate of 10.0 percent.
Debt Covenants
     Certain of our senior notes have redemption features and non-financial covenants that will, among other things, limit our ability to create or assume liens, enter into sale and lease-back transactions, engage in mergers or consolidations and transfer or lease all or substantially all of our assets. Additionally, certain of our credit facilities and senior notes have financial covenants consisting of the following:
    Our debt to capitalization ratio should not be greater than 0.75 on the last day of a fiscal quarter when PepsiCo’s ratings are A- by S&P and A3 by Moody’s or higher. Debt is defined as total long-term and short-term debt plus accrued interest plus total standby letters of credit and other guarantees less cash and cash equivalents not in excess of $500 million. Capitalization is defined as debt plus PBG shareholders’ equity plus noncontrolling interests, excluding the impact of the cumulative translation adjustment.
 
    Our debt to EBITDA ratio should not be greater than five on the last day of a fiscal quarter when PepsiCo’s ratings are less than A- by S&P or A3 by Moody’s. EBITDA is defined as the last four quarters of earnings before depreciation, amortization, net interest expense, income taxes, net income attributable to noncontrolling interests, net other non-operating expenses and extraordinary items.
 
    New secured debt should not be greater than 15 percent of our net tangible assets. Net tangible assets are defined as total assets less current liabilities and net intangible assets.
Interest Payments and Expense
     Amounts paid to third parties for interest, net of settlements from our interest rate swaps, were $323 million, $293 million and $305 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Total interest expense incurred during 2009, 2008 and 2007 was $324 million, $316 million and $305 million, respectively.
Letters of Credit, Bank Guarantees and Surety Bonds
     At December 26, 2009, we had outstanding letters of credit, bank guarantees and surety bonds valued at $314 million from financial institutions primarily to provide collateral for estimated self-insurance claims and other insurance requirements.
Note 9—LEASES
     We have non-cancelable commitments under both capital and long-term operating leases, principally for real estate and manufacturing and office equipment. Certain of our operating leases for real estate contain escalation clauses, holiday rent allowances and other rent incentives. We recognize rent expense on our operating leases, including these allowances and incentives, on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Capital and operating lease commitments expire at various dates through 2072. Most leases require payment of related executory costs, which include property taxes, maintenance and insurance.
     The cost of manufacturing and office equipment under capital leases is included in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as PP&E. Amortization of assets under capital leases is included in depreciation expense.
     Capital lease additions totaled $25 million, $4 million and $7 million for 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

61


Table of Contents

     The future minimum lease payments by year and in the aggregate, under capital leases and non-cancelable operating leases consisted of the following at December 26, 2009:
                 
    Leases  
    Capital     Operating  
2010
  $ 8     $ 56  
2011
    7       34  
2012
    6       27  
2013
    5       18  
2014
          13  
Thereafter
    2       101  
 
           
 
  $ 28     $ 249  
 
           
 
               
Less: amount representing interest
    3          
 
             
Present value of net minimum lease payments
    25          
Less: current portion of net minimum lease payments
    7          
 
             
Long-term portion of net minimum lease payments
  $ 18          
 
             
     The total minimum rentals to be received in the future from our non-cancelable subleases were $3 million at December 26, 2009.
Components of Net Rental Expense Under Operating Leases
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Minimum rentals
  $ 107     $ 120     $ 114  
Sublease rental income
    (2 )     (1 )     (2 )
 
                 
Net rental expense
  $ 105     $ 119     $ 112  
 
                 
Note 10—FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK MANAGEMENT
     We are subject to the risk of loss arising from adverse changes in commodity prices, foreign currency exchange rates, interest rates and our stock price. In the normal course of business, we manage these risks through a variety of strategies, including the use of derivatives. Our corporate policy prohibits the use of derivative instruments for trading or speculative purposes, and we have procedures in place to monitor and control their use.
     We are exposed to counterparty credit risk on all of our derivative financial instruments. We have established and maintain counterparty credit guidelines and only enter into transactions with financial institutions of investment grade or better. We monitor our counterparty credit risk and utilize numerous counterparties to minimize our exposure to potential defaults. We do not require collateral under these transactions.
     Commodity — We use forward and option contracts to hedge the risk of adverse movements in commodity prices related primarily to anticipated purchases of raw materials and energy used in our operations. These contracts generally range from one to 24 months in duration. Our open commodity derivative contracts that qualify for cash flow hedge accounting have a notional value, based on the contract price, of $347 million as of December 26, 2009. Our open commodity derivative contracts that act as economic hedges but do not qualify for hedge accounting have a notional value, based on the contract price, of $50 million as of December 26, 2009.
     Foreign Currency — We are subject to foreign currency transactional risks in certain of our international territories primarily for the purchase of commodities that are denominated in currencies that are different from their functional currency. We enter into forward contract agreements to hedge a portion of this foreign currency risk. These contracts generally range from one to 24 months in duration. Our open foreign currency derivative contracts that qualify for cash flow hedge accounting have a notional value, based on the contract price, of $150 million as of December 26, 2009.
     We have foreign currency derivative contracts to economically hedge the foreign currency risk associated with certain assets on our balance sheet, which have a notional value, based on the contract price, of $40 million as of December 26, 2009. Additionally, we fair value certain vendor and customer contracts that have embedded foreign currency derivative components. These contracts generally range from one year to three years and as of December 26, 2009 have a notional value, based on the contract price, of $10 million.
     Interest — We have entered into treasury rate lock agreements to hedge against adverse interest rate changes relating to the issuance of certain fixed rate debt financing arrangements. The settled gains and losses from these treasury rate lock agreements that were considered effective were deferred in AOCL and are being amortized to

62


Table of Contents

interest expense over the duration of the debt term. The Company has a $3 million net deferred gain in AOCL related to these instruments, which will be amortized over the next six years. For the year ended December 26, 2009, we recognized in interest expense a loss of $0.4 million.
     We effectively converted $1.25 billion of our fixed-rate debt to floating-rate debt through the use of interest rate swaps with the objective of reducing our overall borrowing costs. These interest rate swaps meet the criteria for fair value hedge accounting and are assumed to be 100 percent effective in eliminating the market-rate risk inherent in our long-term debt. Accordingly, any gain or loss associated with these swaps is fully offset by the opposite market impact on the related debt and recognized currently in earnings.
     Unfunded Deferred Compensation Liability — Our unfunded deferred compensation liability is subject to changes in our stock price as well as price changes in other equity and fixed-income investments. We use prepaid forward contracts to hedge the portion of our deferred compensation liability that is based on our stock price. At December 26, 2009, we had a prepaid forward contract for 410,000 shares.
Balance Sheet Classification
     The following summarizes the fair values and location in our Consolidated Balance Sheet of all derivatives held by the Company as of December 26, 2009:
             
Derivatives Designated as Hedging          
Instruments   Balance Sheet Classification   Fair Value  
Assets
           
Commodity contracts
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets   $ 61  
Commodity contracts
  Other assets     14  
 
         
 
      $ 75  
 
         
 
           
Liabilities
           
Foreign currency contracts
  Accounts payable and other current liabilities   $ 1  
Commodity contracts
  Accounts payable and other current liabilities     3  
Interest rate swaps
  Other liabilities     64  
 
         
 
      $ 68  
 
         
             
Derivatives Not Designated as          
Hedging Instruments   Balance Sheet Classification   Fair Value  
Assets
           
Commodity contracts
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets   $ 4  
Prepaid forward contracts
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets     15  
Commodity contracts
  Other assets     2  
 
         
 
      $ 21  
 
         
 
           
Liabilities
           
Foreign currency contracts
  Accounts payable and other current liabilities   $ 4  
Foreign currency contracts
  Other liabilities     1  
 
         
 
      $ 5  
 
         

63


Table of Contents

Cash Flow Hedge Gains (Losses) Recognition
     The following summarizes the gains (losses), recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Operations and AOCL, of derivatives designated and qualifying as cash flow hedges for the year ended December 26, 2009:
                     
    Amount of Gain       Amount of Gain  
Derivatives in Cash   (Loss)     Location of Gain (Loss)   (Loss) Reclassified  
Flow Hedging   Recognized in     Reclassified from AOCL into   from AOCL into  
Relationships   AOCL     Income   Income  
Foreign currency contracts
  $ (19 )   Cost of sales   $ (10 )
Commodity contracts
    77     Cost of sales     5  
Commodity contracts
    8     Selling, delivery and administrative expenses     (42 )
 
               
 
  $ 66         $ (47 )
 
               
     Assuming no change in the commodity prices and foreign currency rates as measured on December 26, 2009, $50 million of unrealized gains will be recognized in earnings over the next 12 months. During 2009, we recognized $7 million of ineffectiveness relating to our commodity cash flow hedges. During 2008, we recognized $8 million of ineffectiveness for the treasury rate locks that were settled in the fourth quarter.
Other Derivatives Gains (Losses) Recognition
     The following summarizes the gains (losses) and the location in the Consolidated Statement of Operations of derivatives designated and qualifying as fair value hedges and derivatives not designated as hedging instruments for the year ended December 26, 2009:
             
    Location of Gain (Loss)   Amount of Gain (Loss)  
    Recognized in Income on   Recognized in Income on  
    Derivative   Derivative  
Derivatives in Fair Value Hedging Relationship
           
Interest rate swaps
  Interest expense, net   $ 27  
 
         
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
           
Prepaid forward contracts
  Selling, delivery and administrative expenses   $ 9  
Foreign currency contracts
  Other non-operating (income) expenses, net     (4 )
Commodity contracts
  Cost of sales     6  
 
         
 
      $ 11  
 
         
     The Company has recorded $4 million of net foreign currency transactional gains in other non-operating (income) expenses, net in the Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 26, 2009.
Note 11—PENSION AND POSTRETIREMENT MEDICAL BENEFIT PLANS
Employee Benefit Plans
     We sponsor both pension and other postretirement medical benefit plans in various forms in the United States and other similar pension plans in our international locations, covering employees who meet specified eligibility requirements. The assets, liabilities and expense associated with our international plans were not significant to our results of operations and are not included in the tables and discussion presented below.
Defined Benefit Pension Plans
     In the U.S., we sponsor non-contributory defined benefit pension plans for certain full-time salaried and hourly employees. Benefits are generally based on years of service and compensation, or stated amounts for each year of service. Effective January 1, 2007, newly hired salaried and non-union hourly employees are not eligible to

64


Table of Contents

participate in these plans. Additionally, effective April 1, 2009, benefits from these plans are no longer accrued for certain salaried and non-union employees that did not meet specified age and service requirements.
Postretirement Medical Plans
     Our postretirement medical plans provide medical and life insurance benefits principally to U.S. retirees and their dependents. Employees are eligible for benefits if they meet age and service requirements. The plans are not funded and since 1993 have included retiree cost sharing.
Defined Contribution Benefits
     Nearly all of our U.S. employees are eligible to participate in our defined contribution plans, which are voluntary defined contribution savings plans. We make matching contributions to the defined contribution savings plans on behalf of participants eligible to receive such contributions. Additionally, employees not eligible to participate in the defined benefit pension plans and employees whose benefits have been frozen as of April 1, 2009, are currently receiving additional retirement contributions under the defined contribution plans. Defined contribution expense was $42 million, $29 million and $27 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
     Components of Net Pension Expense and Other Amounts Recognized in Other Comprehensive (Income) Loss
                         
    Pension  
Net pension expense   2009     2008     2007  
Service cost
  $ 45     $ 51     $ 55  
Interest cost
    104       100       90  
Expected return on plan assets — (income)
    (120 )     (116 )     (102 )
Amortization of net loss
    35       15       38  
Amortization of prior service amendments
    6       7       7  
Settlement / curtailment charges
    1       20        
Special termination benefits
          7       4  
 
                 
Net pension expense for the defined benefit plans
    71       84       92  
 
                 
Other comprehensive (income) loss
                       
Prior service cost arising during the year
    7       14       8  
Net (gain) loss arising during the year
    (147 )     619       (114 )
Amortization of net loss
    (36 )     (15 )     (38 )
Amortization of prior service amendments (1)
    (6 )     (27 )     (7 )
 
                 
Total recognized in other comprehensive (income) loss (2)
    (182 )     591       (151 )
 
                 
 
                       
Total recognized in net pension expense and other comprehensive (income) loss
  $ (111 )   $ 675     $ (59 )
 
                 
 
(1)   2008 includes curtailment charge of $20 million.
 
(2)   Prior to taxes and noncontrolling interests.

65


Table of Contents

     Components of Postretirement Medical Expense and Other Amounts Recognized in Other Comprehensive (Income) Loss
                         
    Postretirement  
Net postretirement expense   2009     2008     2007  
Service cost
  $ 5     $ 5     $ 5  
Interest cost
    21       21       20  
Amortization of net loss
    1       3       4  
Special termination benefits
          1        
 
                 
Net postretirement expense
    27       30       29  
 
                 
Other comprehensive (income) loss
                       
Net gain arising during the year
    (22 )     (30 )     (4 )
Amortization of net loss
    (1 )     (3 )     (4 )
 
                 
Total recognized in other comprehensive (income) loss (1)
    (23 )     (33 )     (8 )
 
                 
Total recognized in net postretirement expense and other comprehensive (income) loss
  $ 4     $ (3 )   $ 21  
 
                 
 
(1)   Prior to taxes and noncontrolling interests.
     Changes in Benefit Obligations
                                 
    Pension     Postretirement  
    2009     2008     2009     2008  
Obligation at beginning of year
  $ 1,724     $ 1,585     $ 327     $ 353  
Adjustment for measurement date change
          (53 )           (5 )
Service cost
    45       51       5       5  
Interest cost
    104       100       21       21  
Plan amendments
    7       14              
Plan curtailment
          (50 )            
Actuarial loss (gain)
    17       141       (22 )     (30 )
Benefit payments
    (75 )     (69 )     (20 )     (19 )
Special termination benefits
          7             1  
Adjustment for Medicare subsidy
                      1  
Transfers
    (2 )     (2 )            
 
                       
Obligation at end of year
  $ 1,820     $ 1,724     $ 311     $ 327  
 
                       
     Changes in the Fair Value of Plan Assets
                                 
    Pension     Postretirement  
    2009     2008     2009     2008  
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
  $ 1,045     $ 1,455     $     $  
Adjustment for measurement date change
          (17 )            
Actual return on plan assets
    284       (412 )            
Transfers
    (2 )     (2 )            
Employer contributions
    239       90       20       18  
Adjustment for Medicare subsidy
                      1  
Benefit payments
    (75 )     (69 )     (20 )     (19 )
 
                       
Fair value of plan assets at end of year
  $ 1,491     $ 1,045     $     $  
 
                       

66


Table of Contents

     Amounts Included in AOCL (1)
                                 
    Pension     Postretirement  
    2009     2008     2009     2008  
Prior service cost
  $ 38     $ 38     $ 3     $ 3  
Net loss
    696       879       26       49  
 
                       
Total
  $ 734     $ 917     $ 29     $ 52  
 
                       
 
(1)   Prior to taxes and noncontrolling interests.
     Estimated Gross Amounts in AOCL to be Amortized in 2010
                 
    Pension   Postretirement
Prior service cost
  $ 6     $  
Net loss
  $ 40     $  
     Selected Information for Plans with Liabilities in Excess of Plan Assets
                                 
    Pension   Postretirement
    2009   2008   2009   2008
Projected benefit obligation
  $ 1,820     $ 1,724     $ 311     $ 327  
Accumulated benefit obligation
  $ 1,772     $ 1,636     $ 311     $ 327  
Fair value of plan assets
  $ 1,491     $ 1,045     $     $  
     Fair Market Value of Pension Plan Assets
                                 
            Fair Value Measurements at  
            December 26, 2009  
Asset Category   Total     Level 1     Level 2     Level 3  
Cash equivalent funds(1)
  $ 35     $     $ 35     $  
Equity funds(1):
                               
Large-cap
    386             386        
Mid-cap
    87             87        
Small-cap
    47             47        
International companies
    461             461        
Fixed income(1)
    454             454        
Group annuity contracts (“GAC”)(2)
    21                   21  
 
                       
Total fair value
  $ 1,491     $     $ 1,470     $ 21  
 
                       
 
(1)   Fair value is based primarily on the commingled fund indices upon which settlement is based.
 
(2)   Fair value reflects the current market value of the transferable funds, assuming long-term assets were sold prior to maturity.
     The following table sets forth a summary of changes in the fair value of the GAC:
         
    Level 3  
    Asset  
Balance at December 27, 2008
  $ 17  
Realized capital gains
     
Unrealized gains
    3  
Interest and dividends
    1  
Purchases, sales, issuances and settlements, net
     
 
     
Balance at December 26, 2009
  $ 21  
 
     

67


Table of Contents

     Reconciliation of Funded Status
                                 
    Pension     Postretirement  
    2009     2008     2009     2008  
Funded status at measurement date
  $ (329 )   $ (679 )   $ (311 )   $ (327 )
 
                       
Amounts recognized
                               
Accounts payable and other current liabilities
  $ (3 )   $ (10 )   $ (23 )   $ (24 )
Other liabilities
    (326 )     (669 )     (288 )     (303 )
 
                       
Total net liabilities
    (329 )     (679 )     (311 )     (327 )
Accumulated other comprehensive loss (1)
    734       917       29       52  
 
                       
Net amount recognized
  $ 405     $ 238     $ (282 )   $ (275 )
 
                       
 
(1)   Prior to taxes and noncontrolling interests.
     Weighted Average Assumptions
                                                 
    Pension   Postretirement
    2009   2008   2007   2009   2008   2007
         
Expense discount rate
    6.20 %     6.70 %     6.00 %     6.50 %     6.35 %     5.80 %
Liability discount rate
    6.25 %     6.20 %     6.35 %     5.75 %     6.50 %     6.20 %
Expected rate of return on plan
assets (1)
    8.00 %     8.50 %     8.50 %     N/A       N/A       N/A  
Expense rate of compensation increase
    3.53 %     3.56 %     3.55 %     3.53 %     3.56 %     3.55 %
Liability rate of compensation increase
    3.04 %     3.53 %     3.56 %     3.43 %     3.53 %     3.56 %
 
(1)   Expected rate of return on plan assets is presented after administration expenses.
     The expected rate of return on plan assets for a given fiscal year is based upon actual historical returns and the long-term outlook on asset classes in the pension plans’ investment portfolio.
     Funding and Plan Assets
                         
    Allocation Percentage
    Target   Actual   Actual
Asset Category   2010   2009   2008
Equity securities
    65 %     65 %     60 %
Debt securities
    35 %     35 %     40 %
     The table above shows the target allocation for 2010 and the actual allocation as of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008. Target allocations of PBG sponsored pension plans’ assets reflect the long-term nature of our pension liabilities. None of the current assets are invested directly in equity or debt instruments issued by PBG, PepsiCo or any bottling affiliates of PepsiCo, although it is possible that insignificant indirect investments exist through our broad market indices. PBG sponsored pension plans’ equity investments are currently diversified across all areas of the equity market (i.e., large, mid and small capitalization stocks as well as international equities). PBG sponsored pension plans’ fixed income investments consist primarily of corporate bonds. The pension plans currently do not invest directly in any derivative investments. The pension plans’ assets are held in a pension trust account at our trustee’s bank.
     PBG’s pension investment policy and strategy are mandated by PBG’s Pension Investment Committee (“PIC”) and are overseen by the PBG Board of Directors’ Compensation and Management Development Committee. The plan assets are invested using a combination of enhanced and passive indexing strategies. The performance of the plan assets is benchmarked against market indices and reviewed by the PIC. Changes in investment strategies, asset allocations and specific investments are approved by the PIC prior to execution.
Health Care Cost Trend Rates
     We have assumed an average increase of 8.00 percent in 2010 in the cost of postretirement medical benefits for employees who retired before cost sharing was introduced. This average increase is then projected to decline gradually to five percent in 2015 and thereafter.

68


Table of Contents

     Assumed health care cost trend rates have an impact on the amounts reported for postretirement medical plans. A one-percentage point change in assumed health care costs would have the following impact:
                 
    1% Increase   1% Decrease
Effect on total fiscal year 2009 service and interest cost components
  $     $  
Effect on total fiscal year 2009 postretirement benefit obligation
  $ 5     $ (4 )
Pension and Postretirement Cash Flow
     We do not fund our pension plan and postretirement medical plans when our contributions would not be tax deductible or when benefits would be taxable to the employee before receipt. Of the total U.S. pension liabilities at December 26, 2009, $66 million relates to pension plans not funded due to these unfavorable tax consequences.
                 
Employer Contributions   Pension   Postretirement
2008
  $ 90     $ 18  
2009
  $ 239     $ 20  
2010 (expected)
  $ 135     $ 23  
Expected Benefits
     The expected benefit payments to be made from PBG sponsored pension and postretirement medical plans (with and without the prescription drug subsidy provided by the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003) to our participants over the next ten years are as follows:
                         
            Postretirement
            Including   Excluding
            Medicare   Medicare
Expected Benefit Payments   Pension   Subsidy   Subsidy
2010
  $ 66     $ 23     $ 24  
2011
  $ 72     $ 24     $ 25  
2012
  $ 79     $ 24     $ 25  
2013
  $ 88     $ 25     $ 26  
2014
  $ 94     $ 26     $ 26  
2015 to 2019
  $ 589     $ 135     $ 137  
Note 12—INCOME TAXES
     The details of our income tax provision are set forth below:
                         
Expense\(Benefit)   2009     2008     2007  
Current:
                       
Federal
  $ (24 )   $ 93     $ 168  
Foreign
    (26 )     46       25  
State
    5       20       26  
 
                 
 
    (45 )     159       219  
 
                 
Deferred:
                       
Federal
    77       56       (41 )
Foreign
    3       (96 )     5  
State
    8       (7 )     (6 )
 
                 
 
    88       (47 )     (42 )
 
                 
 
                       
 
  $ 43     $ 112     $ 177  
 
                 
     In 2009, our tax provision includes the following significant items:
    Tax audit resolutions – We finalized various audits in the United States and in our international jurisdictions which resulted in a net tax provision benefit of $85 million and $73 million, respectively.
 
    Valuation allowances – We reversed valuation allowances on some of our deferred tax assets, as we anticipate receiving future benefit from these tax assets, which resulted in a benefit to the tax provision of $39 million.

69


Table of Contents

    Tax law changes – Mexico and Canada enacted tax law changes in the fourth quarter of 2009 which required us to re-measure our deferred tax assets and liabilities resulting in a net provision expense of $65 million.
     In 2008, our tax provision included the following significant items:
    Tax impact from impairment charge – During 2008, we recorded a deferred tax benefit of $115 million associated with impairment charges primarily related to our business in Mexico.
 
    Tax impact from restructuring – We incurred restructuring charges in the fourth quarter of 2008 which resulted in a tax benefit of $21 million.
     In 2007, our tax provision included higher taxes on higher international earnings, as well as the following significant items:
    Valuation allowances – During 2007, we reversed valuation allowances on some of our deferred tax assets resulting in an $11 million tax benefit.
 
    Tax audit settlement – The statute of limitations for the IRS audit of our 2001-2002 tax returns closed on June 30, 2007, and we reversed approximately $46 million in tax reserves relating to such audit.
 
    Tax law changes – During 2007, changes to the income tax laws in Canada, Mexico and certain state jurisdictions in the U.S. were enacted. These law changes required us to re-measure our net deferred tax assets and liabilities which resulted in a net decrease to our income tax expense of approximately $13 million before the impact of noncontrolling interests.
     Our U.S. and foreign income before income taxes is set forth below:
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
U.S.
  $ 441     $ 466     $ 543  
Foreign
    308       (132 )     260  
 
                 
 
  $ 749     $ 334     $ 803  
 
                 
     Below is the reconciliation of our income tax rate from the U.S. federal statutory rate to our effective tax rate:
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Income taxes computed at the U.S. federal statutory rate
    35.0 %     35.0 %     35.0 %
State income tax, net of federal tax benefit
    1.5       (0.4 )     1.9  
Impact of foreign results
    (10.2 )     (16.9 )     (5.1 )
Change in valuation allowances, net
    (8.9 )     3.5       (3.1 )
Nondeductible expenses
    4.7       9.8       2.3  
Other, net
    (4.0 )     (6.9 )     (1.6 )
Impairment charges
          8.7        
Reversal of tax reserves from audit settlements
    (21.1 )           (5.7 )
Tax law changes
    8.7       0.6       (1.6 )
 
                 
Total effective income tax rate
    5.7 %     33.4 %     22.1 %
 
                 

70


Table of Contents

     The details of our 2009 and 2008 deferred tax liabilities (assets) are set forth below:
                 
    2009     2008  
Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment
  $ 1,489     $ 1,464  
Investments
    326       305  
Recapture liability
    109        
Other
    106       26  
 
           
Gross deferred tax liabilities
    2,030       1,795  
 
           
 
               
Net operating loss carryforwards
    (454 )     (445 )
Employee benefit obligations
    (325 )     (441 )
Recapture recovery benefit
    (109 )      
Various liabilities and other
    (173 )     (279 )
 
           
Gross deferred tax assets
    (1,061 )     (1,165 )
Deferred tax asset valuation allowance
    185       227  
 
           
Net deferred tax assets
    (876 )     (938 )
 
           
Net deferred tax liabilities
  $ 1,154     $ 857  
 
           
 
               
Classification within the Consolidated Balance Sheets
               
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
  $ (122 )   $ (86 )
Other assets
    (10 )     (26 )
Accounts payable and other current liabilities
    1       3  
Deferred income taxes
    1,285       966  
 
           
Net amount recognized
  $ 1,154     $ 857  
 
           
     We have net operating loss carryforwards (“NOLs”) totaling $1,716 million at December 26, 2009, which resulted in deferred tax assets of $454 million and which may be available to reduce future taxes in the U.S., Spain, Greece, Turkey, Russia and Mexico. Of these NOLs, $20 million expire in 2010; $619 million expire at various times between 2011 and 2028; and $1,077 million have an indefinite life. At December 26, 2009, we have tax credit carryforwards in the U.S. of $3 million with an indefinite carryforward period and in Mexico of $29 million, which expire at various times between 2010 and 2017.
     We establish valuation allowances on our deferred tax assets, including NOLs and tax credits, when the amount of expected future taxable income is not likely to support the use of the deduction or credit. Our valuation allowances, which reduce our deferred tax assets to an amount that will more likely than not be realized, were $185 million at December 26, 2009. Our valuation allowance decreased $42 million in 2009, and decreased $17 million in 2008.
     Deferred taxes have not been recognized on the excess of the amount for financial reporting purposes over the tax basis of investments in foreign subsidiaries that are expected to be permanent in duration. This amount becomes taxable upon a repatriation of assets from the subsidiary or a sale or liquidation of the subsidiary. The amount of such temporary difference totaled approximately $1,426 million at December 26, 2009 and $1,048 million at December 27, 2008. Determination of the amount of unrecognized deferred income taxes related to this temporary difference is not practicable.
     Income taxes receivable from taxing authorities were $40 million and $25 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively. Such amounts are recorded within prepaid expenses and other current assets in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Income taxes payable to taxing authorities were $19 million and $20 million at December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively. Such amounts are recorded within accounts payable and other current liabilities in our Consolidated Balance Sheets.
     Amounts paid to taxing authorities and PepsiCo for income taxes were $93 million, $142 million and $195 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
     We file annual income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction, various U.S. state and local jurisdictions, and in various foreign jurisdictions. Our tax filings are subject to review by various tax authorities who may disagree with our positions.
     A number of years may elapse before an uncertain tax position, for which we have established tax reserves, is audited and finally resolved. While it is often difficult to predict the final outcome or the timing of the resolution of an audit, we believe that our reserves for uncertain tax benefits reflect the outcome of tax positions that is more likely than not to occur. We adjust these reserves, as well as the related interest and penalties, in light of changing

71


Table of Contents

facts and circumstances. The resolution of a matter could be recognized as an adjustment to our provision for income taxes and our deferred taxes in the period of resolution, and may also require a use of cash.
     Our major taxing jurisdictions include the U.S., Mexico, Canada and Russia. The following table summarizes the years that remain subject to examination and the years currently under audit by major tax jurisdictions:
         
    Years subject to    
Jurisdiction   examination   Years under audit
U.S. Federal
  2006-2008   2006-2007
         
Canada   2006-2008   2006-2007
         
Mexico   2004-2008   N/A
         
Russia   2008   N/A
     We also have a tax separation agreement with PepsiCo, which among other provisions, specifies that PepsiCo maintain full control and absolute discretion for any combined or consolidated tax filings for tax periods ended on or before our initial public offering that occurred in March 1999. In accordance with the tax separation agreement, we will bear our allocable share of any cost or benefit resulting from the settlement of tax matters affecting us for these tax periods. The IRS has issued a Revenue Agent’s Report (“RAR”) related to PBG and PepsiCo’s joint tax returns for 1998 through March 1999. We have agreed with the IRS conclusion, except for one matter which continues to be in dispute.
     We currently have on-going income tax audits in our major tax jurisdictions, where issues such as deductibility of certain expenses have been raised. We believe that it is reasonably possible that our worldwide reserves for uncertain tax benefits could decrease by up to $16 million within the next twelve months as a result of the completion of audits in our U.S. and international jurisdictions and the expiration of statute of limitations. The reductions in our tax reserves could result in a combination of additional tax payments, the adjustment of certain deferred taxes or the recognition of tax benefits in our income statement. In the event that we cannot reach settlement of some of these audits, our tax reserves may increase, although we cannot estimate such potential increases at this time.
     Below is a reconciliation of the beginning and ending amounts of our reserves for income taxes which are recorded in our Consolidated Balance Sheets.
                 
    2009     2008  
Reserves (excluding interest and penalties)
               
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 212     $ 220  
Increases due to tax positions related to prior years
    4       18  
Increases due to tax positions related to the current year
    10       13  
Decreases due to tax positions related to prior years
    (2 )     (11 )
Decreases due to settlements with taxing authorities
    (125 )     (2 )
Decreases due to lapse of statute of limitations
    (45 )     (7 )
Currency translation adjustment
    1       (19 )
 
           
Balance at end of year
  $ 55     $ 212  
 
           
 
               
Classification within the Consolidated Balance Sheets
               
Other liabilities
  $ 52     $ 209  
Deferred income taxes
    3       3  
 
           
Total amount of reserves recognized
  $ 55     $ 212  
 
           
     Of the $55 million of 2009 income tax reserves above, approximately $48 million would impact our effective tax rate over time, if recognized.
                 
    2009     2008  
Interest and penalties accrued
  $ 30     $ 95  
 
           

72


Table of Contents

     We recognized $58 million of benefit and $23 million of expense, net of reversals, during the fiscal years 2009 and 2008, respectively, for interest and penalties related to income tax reserves in the income tax expense line of our Consolidated Statements of Operations.
Note 13—SEGMENT INFORMATION
     We operate in one industry, carbonated soft drinks and other ready-to-drink beverages, and all of our segments derive revenue from these products. PBG has three reportable segments — U.S. & Canada, Europe (which includes Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey) and Mexico.
     Operationally, the Company is organized along geographic lines with specific regional management teams having responsibility for the financial results in each reportable segment. We evaluate the performance of these segments based on operating income or loss. Operating income or loss is exclusive of net interest expense, noncontrolling interests, other non-operating (income) expenses, net and income taxes.
     The Company’s corporate headquarters centrally manages commodity derivatives on behalf of our segments. During 2009, we expanded our hedging program to mitigate price changes associated with certain commodities utilized in our production process. These derivatives hedge the underlying price risk associated with the commodity and are not entered into for speculative purposes. Certain commodity derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment. Others receive hedge accounting treatment but may have some element of ineffectiveness based on the accounting standard. These commodity derivatives are marked-to-market each period until settlement, resulting in gains and losses being reflected in corporate headquarters’ results. The gains and losses are subsequently reflected in the segment results when the underlying commodity’s cost is recognized. Therefore, segment results reflect the contract purchase price of these commodities. The Company did not have any comparable mark-to-market commodity derivative activity in prior years.
     The following tables summarize select financial information related to our reportable segments:
                         
    Net Revenues  
    2009     2008     2007  
U.S. & Canada
  $ 10,315     $ 10,300     $ 10,336  
Europe
    1,755       2,115       1,872  
Mexico
    1,149       1,381       1,383  
 
                 
Worldwide net revenues
  $ 13,219     $ 13,796     $ 13,591  
 
                 
     Net revenues in the U.S. were $9,201 million, $9,097 million and $9,202 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. In 2009, sales to Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. and its affiliated companies were 11 percent of our revenues, primarily as a result of transactions in the U.S. & Canada segment. In 2008 and 2007, the Company did not have one individual customer that represented 10 percent of total revenues.
                         
    Operating Income (Loss)  
    2009     2008     2007  
U.S. & Canada
  $ 868     $ 886     $ 893  
Europe
    112       101       106  
Mexico
    56       (338 )     72  
 
                 
Total segments
    1,036       649       1,071  
Corporate — net impact of mark-to-market on commodity hedges
    12              
 
                 
Worldwide operating income
    1,048       649       1,071  
Interest expense, net
    303       290       274  
Other non-operating (income) expenses, net
    (4 )     25       (6 )
 
                 
Income before income taxes
  $ 749     $ 334     $ 803  
 
                 

73


Table of Contents

                                                 
    Total Assets     Long-Lived Assets(1)  
    2009     2008     2007     2009     2008     2007  
U.S. & Canada
  $ 10,175     $ 9,815     $ 9,737     $ 7,648     $ 7,466     $ 7,572  
Europe(2)
    2,395       2,222       1,671       1,753       1,630       1,014  
Mexico
    988       945       1,707       754       745       1,443  
 
                                   
Total segments
    13,558       12,982       13,115       10,155       9,841       10,029  
Corporate
    12                   3              
 
                                   
Worldwide total
  $ 13,570     $ 12,982     $ 13,115     $ 10,158     $ 9,841     $ 10,029  
 
                                   
 
(1)   Long-lived assets represent PP&E, other intangible assets, net, goodwill, investments in noncontrolled affiliates and other assets.
 
(2)   Long-lived assets include an equity method investment in Russia with a net book value of $619 million and $617 million as of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, respectively.
     Long-lived assets in the U.S. were $6,515 million, $6,468 million and $6,319 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Long-lived assets in Russia were $1,406 million, $1,290 million and $626 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
                                                 
    Capital Expenditures     Depreciation and Amortization  
    2009     2008     2007     2009     2008     2007  
U.S. & Canada
  $ 398     $ 528     $ 626     $ 483     $ 499     $ 510  
Europe
    110       147       146       81       86       72  
Mexico
    48       85       82       73       88       87  
 
                                   
Worldwide total
  $ 556     $ 760     $ 854     $ 637     $ 673     $ 669  
 
                                   
Note 14—RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
     PepsiCo is a related party due to the nature of our franchise relationship and its ownership interest in our Company. The most significant agreements that govern our relationship with PepsiCo consist of:
  (1)   Master Bottling Agreement for cola beverages bearing the Pepsi-Cola and Pepsi trademarks in the U.S.; bottling agreements and distribution agreements for non-cola beverages; and a master fountain syrup agreement in the U.S.;
 
  (2)   Agreements similar to the Master Bottling Agreement and the non-cola agreement for each country in which we operate, as well as a fountain syrup agreement for Canada;
 
  (3)   A shared services agreement where we obtain various services from PepsiCo and provide services to PepsiCo;
 
  (4)   Russia Venture Agreement related to the formation of PR Beverages; and
 
  (5)   Russia Snack Food Distribution Agreement pursuant to which our PR Beverages venture purchases snack food products from Frito-Lay, Inc. (“Frito”), a subsidiary of PepsiCo, for sale and distribution in the Russian Federation.
     The Master Bottling Agreement provides that we will purchase our entire requirements of concentrates for the cola beverages from PepsiCo at prices and on terms and conditions determined from time to time by PepsiCo. Additionally, we review our annual marketing, advertising, management and financial plans each year with PepsiCo for its approval. If we fail to submit these plans, or if we fail to carry them out in all material respects, PepsiCo can terminate our beverage agreements. If our beverage agreements with PepsiCo are terminated for this or for any other reason, it would have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results.
     On March 1, 2007, together with PepsiCo, we formed PR Beverages, a venture that enables us to strategically invest in Russia to accelerate our growth. PBG contributed its business in Russia to PR Beverages, and PepsiCo entered into bottling agreements with PR Beverages for PepsiCo beverage products sold in Russia on the same terms as in effect for PBG immediately prior to the venture. PR Beverages has an exclusive license to manufacture and sell PepsiCo concentrate for such products. PR Beverages has contracted with a PepsiCo subsidiary to manufacture such concentrate.

74


Table of Contents

     The following income (expense) amounts are considered related party transactions as a result of our relationship with PepsiCo and its affiliates:
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Net revenues:
                       
Bottler incentives and other arrangements (1)
  $ 100     $ 93     $ 66  
 
                 
Cost of sales:
                       
Purchases of concentrate and finished products, and royalty fees (2)
  $ (3,225 )   $ (3,451 )   $ (3,406 )
Bottler incentives and other arrangements (1)
    476       542       582  
 
                 
Total cost of sales
  $ (2,749 )   $ (2,909 )   $ (2,824 )
 
                 
 
                       
Selling, delivery and administrative expenses:
                       
Bottler incentives and other arrangements (1)
  $ 47     $ 56     $ 66  
Fountain service fee (3)
    205       187       188  
Frito-Lay purchases (4)
    (350 )     (355 )     (270 )
Shared services: (5)
                       
Shared services expense
    (52 )     (52 )     (57 )
Shared services revenue
    7       7       8  
 
                 
Net shared services
    (45 )     (45 )     (49 )
 
                 
 
Total selling, delivery and administrative expenses
  $ (143 )   $ (157 )   $ (65 )
 
                 
 
                       
Income tax benefit: (6)
  $ 1     $ 1     $ 7  
 
                 
 
(1)   Bottler Incentives and Other Arrangements — In order to promote PepsiCo beverages, PepsiCo, at its discretion, provides us with various forms of bottler incentives. These incentives cover a variety of initiatives, including direct marketplace support and advertising support. We record most of these incentives as an adjustment to cost of sales unless the incentive is for reimbursement of a specific, incremental and identifiable cost. Under these conditions, the incentive would be recorded as an offset against the related costs, either in net revenues or SD&A. Changes in our bottler incentives and funding levels could materially affect our business and financial results.
 
(2)   Purchases of Concentrate and Finished Product — As part of our franchise relationship, we purchase concentrate from PepsiCo, pay royalties and produce or distribute other products through various arrangements with PepsiCo or PepsiCo joint ventures. The prices we pay for concentrate, finished goods and royalties are generally determined by PepsiCo at its sole discretion. Concentrate prices are typically determined annually. Significant changes in the amount we pay PepsiCo for concentrate, finished goods and royalties could materially affect our business and financial results. These amounts are reflected in cost of sales in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 
(3)   Fountain Service Fee — We manufacture and distribute fountain products and provide fountain equipment service to PepsiCo customers in some territories in accordance with the Pepsi beverage agreements. Fees received from PepsiCo for these transactions offset the cost to provide these services. The fees and costs for these services are recorded in SD&A in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 
(4)   Frito-Lay Purchases — We purchase snack food products from Frito for sale and distribution in Russia primarily to accommodate PepsiCo with the infrastructure of our distribution network. Frito would otherwise be required to source third-party distribution services to reach their customers in Russia. We make payments to PepsiCo for the cost of these snack products and retain a minimal net fee based on the gross sales price of the products. Payments for the purchase of snack products are reflected in SD&A in our Consolidated Statements of Operations. Net fees associated with the sale of the Frito product after selling, delivery and administrative costs were $14 million, $34 million and $22 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
 
(5)   Shared Services — We provide to and receive various services from PepsiCo and PepsiCo affiliates pursuant to a shared services agreement and other arrangements. In the absence of these agreements, we would have to obtain such services on our own. We might not be able to obtain these services on terms, including cost, which are as favorable as those we receive from PepsiCo. Total expenses incurred and income generated is reflected in SD&A in our Consolidated Statements of Operations.

75


Table of Contents

(6)   Income Tax Benefit — Includes settlements under the tax separation agreement with PepsiCo.
Other Related Party Transactions
     Bottling LLC will distribute pro rata to PepsiCo and PBG, based upon membership interest, sufficient cash such that the aggregate cash distributed to PBG will enable PBG to pay its taxes, share repurchases, dividends and make interest payments for its internal and external debt. PepsiCo’s pro rata cash distribution during 2009, 2008 and 2007 from Bottling LLC was $30 million, $73 million and $17 million, respectively.
     There are certain manufacturing cooperatives whose assets, liabilities and results of operations are consolidated in our financial statements. Concentrate purchases from PepsiCo by these cooperatives, not included in the table above, for the years ended 2009, 2008 and 2007 were $144 million, $140 million and $143 million, respectively. We also have equity investments in certain other manufacturing cooperatives. Total purchases by the Company of finished goods from these cooperatives, not included in the table above, for the years ended 2009, 2008 and 2007 were $58 million, $61 million and $66 million, respectively. These manufacturing cooperatives purchase concentrate from PepsiCo for certain of its finished goods sold to the Company.
     As of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, the receivables from PepsiCo and its affiliates were $210 million and $154 million, respectively. Our receivables from PepsiCo are shown as part of accounts receivable in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. As of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, the payables to PepsiCo and its affiliates were $204 million and $217 million, respectively. Our payables to PepsiCo are shown as part of accounts payable and other current liabilities in our Consolidated Balance Sheets.
     As a result of the formation of PR Beverages, PepsiCo agreed to contribute a note payable of $83 million plus accrued interest to the venture to be settled in the form of PP&E. PepsiCo has contributed $73 million in regards to this note. The remaining balance to be contributed to the venture is $17 million as of December 26, 2009.
     During 2008, together with PepsiCo, we completed a joint acquisition of JSC Lebedyansky (“Lebedyansky”) for approximately $1.8 billion. The acquisition did not include the company’s baby food and mineral water businesses, which were spun off to shareholders in a separate transaction prior to our acquisition. Lebedyansky was acquired 58.3 percent by PepsiCo and 41.7 percent by PR Beverages, our Russian venture with PepsiCo. We and PepsiCo have an ownership interest in PR Beverages of 60 percent and 40 percent, respectively. As a result, PepsiCo and PBG have acquired a 75 percent and 25 percent economic stake in Lebedyansky, respectively.
     During the first quarter of 2009, we issued a ruble-denominated three-year note with an interest rate of 10.0 percent to Lebedyansky valued at $73 million at year-end 2009. This funding was contemplated as part of the initial capitalization of the purchase of Lebedyansky between PepsiCo and us. This note receivable is recorded in other assets in our Consolidated Balance Sheets.
     Two of our board members have been designated by PepsiCo. These board members do not serve on our Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee, Compensation and Management Development Committee or Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. In addition, one of the managing directors of Bottling LLC is an officer of PepsiCo.
Note 15RESTRUCTURING CHARGES
     On November 18, 2008, we announced a restructuring program to enhance the Company’s operating capabilities in each of our reporting segments with the objective to strengthen customer service and selling effectiveness; simplify decision making and streamline the organization; drive greater cost productivity to adapt to current macroeconomic challenges; and rationalize the Company’s supply chain infrastructure. As part of the restructuring program, we eliminated approximately 4,000 positions across all reporting segments, we closed four facilities in the United States and three plants and 17 distribution centers in Mexico and we eliminated 534 routes in Mexico. In addition, the Company modified its U.S. defined benefit pension plans, which will generate long-term savings and significantly reduce future financial obligations. The program was substantially complete in December of 2009 and certain restructuring actions previously planned for 2010 have been cancelled as a result of the pending merger with PepsiCo.
     The Company recorded pre-tax charges of $107 million over the course of the restructuring program which were primarily for severance and related benefits, pension and other employee-related costs and other charges including employee relocation and asset disposal costs. These charges were recorded in SD&A.

76


Table of Contents

     The Company expects about $80 million in pre-tax cash expenditures from these restructuring actions, of which $75 million has been paid since the inception of the program, with the balance expected to occur in 2010. This includes $8 million of employee benefit payments made through 2009, pursuant to existing unfunded termination indemnity plans. These benefit payments have been accrued for in previous periods, and therefore, are not included in our cost for this program and are not included in the tables below.
     The following tables summarize the pre-tax costs associated with the restructuring program:
By Reportable Segment
                                 
            U.S. &              
    Worldwide     Canada     Mexico     Europe  
Costs incurred through December 27, 2008
  $ 83     $ 53     $ 3     $ 27  
Costs incurred during the year ended December 26, 2009
    24       10       14        
 
                       
Total costs incurred
  $ 107     $ 63     $ 17     $ 27  
 
                       
By Activity:
                                 
                            Asset  
                    Pension &     Disposal,  
            Severance     Other     Employee  
            & Related     Related     Relocation  
    Total     Benefits     Costs     & Other  
Costs incurred through December 27, 2008
  $ 83     $ 47     $ 29     $ 7  
Cash payments
    (11 )     (10 )           (1 )
Non-cash settlements
    (30 )     (1 )     (23 )     (6 )
 
                       
Remaining costs accrued at December 27, 2008
    42       36       6        
Costs incurred during the year ended December 26, 2009
    24       8       3       13  
Cash payments
    (56 )     (40 )     (7 )     (9 )
Non-cash settlements
    (5 )           (1 )     (4 )
 
                       
Remaining costs accrued at December 26, 2009
  $ 5     $ 4     $ 1     $  
 
                       
Note 16—ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
     The year-end balances related to each component of AOCL were as follows:
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Net currency translation adjustment
  $ (195 )   $ (355 )   $ 199  
Cash flow hedge adjustment (1)
    40       (23 )     10  
Pension and postretirement medical benefit plans adjustment (2)
    (441 )     (560 )     (257 )
 
                 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
  $ (596 )   $ (938 )   $ (48 )
 
                 
 
(1)   Net of noncontrolling interests and taxes of $(30) million in 2009, $20 million in 2008 and $(8) million in 2007.
 
(2)   Net of noncontrolling interests and taxes of $329 million in 2009, $421 million in 2008 and $195 million in 2007.
Note 17—SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW INFORMATION
     The table below presents the Company’s supplemental cash flow information:
                         
    2009     2008     2007  
Non-cash investing and financing activities:
                       
Increase (Decrease) in accounts payable related to capital expenditures
  $ 14     $ (67 )   $ 15  
Acquisition of intangible asset
  $     $     $ 315  
Liabilities assumed in conjunction with acquisition of bottlers
  $ 34     $ 22     $ 1  
Capital-in-kind contributions
  $ 24     $ 34     $ 15  
Share-based compensation
  $ 19     $ 4     $  

77


Table of Contents

Note 18—CONTINGENCIES
     We are subject to various claims and contingencies related to lawsuits, environmental and other matters arising out of the normal course of business. We believe that the ultimate liability arising from such claims or contingencies, if any, in excess of amounts already recognized is not likely to have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial position or liquidity.
     On April 19, 2009, PBG received an unsolicited proposal from PepsiCo to acquire all of the outstanding shares of the Company’s common stock not already owned by PepsiCo for $29.50 per share. The proposal consisted of $14.75 in cash plus 0.283 shares of PepsiCo common stock for each share of PBG common stock. Immediately following receipt of the proposal, PBG’s Board of Directors formed a special committee to review the adequacy of the proposal. On May 4, 2009, our Board of Directors rejected the proposal.
     On August 3, 2009, PBG and PepsiCo entered into a definitive merger agreement, under which PepsiCo will acquire all outstanding shares of PBG common stock it does not already own for the price of $36.50 in cash or 0.6432 shares of PepsiCo common stock, subject to proration such that the aggregate consideration to be paid to PBG shareholders shall be 50 percent in cash and 50 percent in PepsiCo common stock. At a special meeting of our shareholders held on February 17, 2010, our shareholders adopted the merger agreement. The transaction is subject to certain regulatory approvals and is expected to be finalized by the end of the first quarter of 2010.
     As discussed below, we and members of our Board of Directors have been named in a number of lawsuits relating to the PepsiCo proposal.
     Delaware Actions
     Beginning on April 22, 2009, seven putative stockholder class action complaints challenging the April 19 proposal were filed against the Company and the individual members of the Board of Directors of the Company in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (the “Delaware Lawsuits”). The complaints alleged, among other things, that the defendants had breached or would breach their fiduciary duties owed to the public stockholders of the Company in connection with the April 19 proposal. The Delaware Lawsuits were consolidated on June 5, 2009, and an amended complaint was filed on June 19, 2009. The amended complaint seeks, among other things, damages and declaratory, injunctive, and other equitable relief alleging, among other things, that the defendants have breached or will breach their fiduciary duties owed to the public stockholders of the Company, that the April 19 proposal and the transactions contemplated thereunder were not entirely fair to the public stockholders, that PepsiCo had retaliated or would retaliate against the Company for rejecting the April 19 proposal, and that certain provisions of the Company’s certificate of incorporation are invalid and/or inapplicable to the April 19 proposal and the pending merger.
     On July 23, 2009, motions for partial summary judgment were filed concerning the plaintiffs’ allegations relating to the Company’s certificate of incorporation. On August 31, 2009, the Court of Chancery entered a Stipulation and Order Governing the Protection and Exchange of Confidential Information in each of the Delaware Lawsuits. Shortly thereafter, defendants began producing documents to co-lead plaintiffs in these actions. On November 20, 2009, the parties to the Delaware Lawsuits entered into the Stipulation and Agreement of Compromise, Settlement, and Release described below (the “Settlement Stipulation”).
     Westchester County Actions
     Beginning on April 29, 2009, two putative stockholder class action complaints were filed against the Company and members of the Company’s Board of Directors in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of Westchester. The complaints seek, among other things, damages and declaratory, injunctive, and other equitable relief and allege, among other things, that the defendants have breached or will breach their fiduciary duties owed to the public stockholders of the Company, that the April 19 proposal and the transactions contemplated thereunder were not entirely fair to the public stockholders of the Company, and that the defensive measures implemented by the Company were not being used to maximize stockholder value. On June 8, 2009, we filed Motions to Dismiss (or, in the alternative, to Stay), the actions in favor of the previously filed actions pending in the Delaware Court of Chancery. As of June 26, 2009, our Motions were fully briefed and submitted to the Court.
     On October 19, 2009, the parties to the two Westchester County actions entered into a stipulation staying the Westchester County actions in favor of the Delaware Lawsuits. On October 21, 2009, the court entered an order staying the two Westchester County actions pending resolution of the Delaware Lawsuits. On November 20, 2009, the parties to the two Westchester County actions entered into the Settlement Stipulation described below.

78


Table of Contents

     New York County Actions
     On May 8, 2009, a putative stockholder class action complaint was filed against the Company and the members of the Board of Directors of the Company other than John C. Compton and Cynthia M. Trudell in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of New York. The complaint alleged that the defendants had breached their fiduciary duties owed to the public stockholders of the Company by depriving those stockholders of the full and fair value of their shares by failing to accept PepsiCo’s April 19 proposal to acquire the Company or to negotiate with PepsiCo after that proposal was made and by adopting certain defensive measures. On June 8, 2009, we filed Motions to Dismiss (or, in the alternative, to Stay) this action in favor of the previously filed actions pending in the Delaware Court of Chancery. The plaintiff failed to file a timely opposition to the Motion. On August 10, 2009, the plaintiff filed an amended class action complaint, adding as defendants PepsiCo, Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell. The amended complaint seeks, among other things, damages and declaratory, injunctive, and other equitable relief and alleges, among other things, that the defendants have breached or will breach their fiduciary duties owed to the public stockholders of the Company and that the pending merger is not entirely fair to the public stockholders of the Company. On August 27, 2009, we again filed Motions to Dismiss (or, in the alternative, to Stay) this action in favor of the previously filed actions pending in the Delaware Court of Chancery.
     On October 2, 2009, the parties to the New York County action entered into a stipulation providing that this action should be voluntarily stayed for 45 days while plaintiff’s counsel conferred with co-lead counsel in the Delaware Lawsuits and that the defendants’ motion to dismiss or stay should be adjourned during the voluntary stay. Also on October 2, 2009, the court entered an order staying the New York County action for 45 days while plaintiff’s counsel conferred with co-lead counsel in the Delaware Lawsuit. On November 13, 2009, the parties to the New York County action entered into a stipulation providing that the action should be voluntarily stayed pending resolution of the Delaware Lawsuits. On November 20, 2009, the parties to the New York County action entered into the Settlement Stipulation described below. On December 2, 2009, the court entered an order staying the New York County action pending resolution of the Delaware Lawsuits.
     Settlement of Shareholder Litigation
     On November 20, 2009, the parties to the Delaware Lawsuits, as well as the parties to the three actions pending in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, entered into a Settlement Stipulation to resolve all of these actions.
     Pursuant to the Settlement Stipulation, and in exchange for the releases described below, defendants have taken or will take the following actions, among others: (1) PepsiCo and PBG have included and will continue to include co-lead counsel in the disclosure process (including providing them with the opportunities to review and comment on drafts of the preliminary and final proxy statements/prospectuses before they were or are filed with the SEC); (2) PepsiCo agreed to reduce the termination fee set forth in the merger agreement from $165.3 million to $115 million; and (3) PepsiCo agreed to shorten the termination fee period set forth in the merger agreement from 12 months to 6 months. The settlement is conditioned on satisfaction by co-lead counsel that the disclosures made in connection with the pending merger are not materially omissive or misleading.
     Pursuant to the Settlement Stipulation, the Delaware Lawsuits will be dismissed with prejudice on the merits, the plaintiffs in the New York actions will voluntarily dismiss those actions with prejudice, and all defendants will be released from any and all claims relating to, among other things, the pending merger, the merger agreement, and any disclosures made in connection therewith. The Settlement Stipulation is subject to customary conditions, including consummation of the merger, completion of certain confirmatory discovery, class certification, and final approval by the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware following notice to our shareholders. On December 2, 2009, the Court of Chancery entered an order setting forth the schedule and procedures for notice to our shareholders and the court’s review of the settlement. The Court of Chancery scheduled a hearing for April 12, 2010, at which the court will consider the fairness, reasonableness, and adequacy of the settlement.
     The settlement will not affect the form or amount of the consideration to be received by our shareholders in the pending merger. The defendants have denied and continue to deny any wrongdoing or liability with respect to all claims, events, and transactions complained of in the aforementioned litigations or that they have engaged in any wrongdoing. The defendants have entered into the Settlement Stipulation to eliminate the uncertainty, burden, risk, expense, and distraction of further litigation.
Note 19— STOCKHOLDERS’ RIGHTS AGREEMENT
     During the second quarter of 2009, the Company declared a dividend payable to stockholders of record on May 28, 2009, of one right (a “Right”) per each share of outstanding Common Stock and Class B Common Stock to purchase 1/1,000th of a share of Series A Preferred Stock of the Company (the “Preferred Stock”), at a price of $100 per share (the “Purchase Price”). In connection with the declaration of the dividend, the Company entered into a

79


Table of Contents

Rights Agreement, dated May 18, 2009 (the “Rights Agreement”), with Mellon Shareholder Services LLC, as the Rights Agent (“Mellon”).
     On August 3, 2009, the Company and PepsiCo entered into a Merger Agreement, under which PepsiCo will acquire all of the outstanding shares of Company Common Stock that it does not already own (the “Pending Merger”). On the same date, the Company and Mellon entered into Amendment 1 to the Rights Agreement (the “Rights Amendment”), which provides that none of the actions taken by PepsiCo in connection with the Pending Merger shall trigger the exercisability of the Rights. Additionally, the Rights Amendment provides that the Rights will expire if and when the Pending Merger is finalized.
     Under the Rights Agreement, as amended, the Rights will become exercisable upon the earliest of (i) the date that a person or group other than PepsiCo has obtained beneficial ownership of more than 15 percent of the outstanding shares of Common Stock, or (ii) a date determined by the PBG Board of Directors after a person or group commences (or publicly discloses an intent to commence) a tender or exchange offer that would result in such person or group becoming the beneficial owner of more than 15 percent of the outstanding shares of Common Stock. Except as provided under the Rights Amendment, the Rights will expire on May 18, 2010, unless earlier redeemed or canceled by the Company.
     Each right, if and when it becomes exercisable, will entitle the holder (other than the person or group whose action triggered the exercisability of the Rights (the “Acquiring Person”)) to receive, upon exercise of the Right and the payment of the Purchase Price, that number of 1/1,000ths of a share of Preferred Stock equal to the number of shares of Common Stock which at the time of the applicable triggering transaction would have a market value of twice the Purchase Price.
     In the event the Company is acquired in a merger or other business combination that triggers the exercisability of the Rights, or 50 percent or more of the Company’s assets are sold in a transaction that triggers the exercisability of the Rights, each Right will entitle its holder (other than an Acquiring Person) to purchase common shares in the surviving entity at 50 percent of market price.
Note 20—SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (unaudited)
     Quarter to quarter comparisons of our financial results are impacted by our fiscal year cycle and the seasonality of our business. The seasonality of our operating results arises from higher sales in the second and third quarters versus the first and fourth quarters of the year, combined with the impact of fixed costs, such as depreciation and interest, which are not significantly impacted by business seasonality.
                                         
    First   Second   Third   Fourth    
2009(1)   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Full Year
Net revenues
  $ 2,507     $ 3,274     $ 3,633     $ 3,805     $ 13,219  
Gross profit
  $ 1,104     $ 1,444     $ 1,621     $ 1,671     $ 5,840  
Operating income
  $ 117     $ 309     $ 436     $ 186     $ 1,048  
Net income
  $ 58     $ 238     $ 310     $ 100     $ 706  
Net income attributable to PBG
  $ 57     $ 211     $ 254     $ 90     $ 612  
Diluted earnings per share (2)
  $ 0.27     $ 0.96     $ 1.14     $ 0.40     $ 2.77  

80


Table of Contents

                                         
    First   Second   Third   Fourth    
2008(1)   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Quarter   Full Year
Net revenues
  $ 2,651     $ 3,522     $ 3,814     $ 3,809     $ 13,796  
Gross profit
  $ 1,169     $ 1,606     $ 1,737     $ 1,698     $ 6,210  
Operating income (loss)
  $ 108     $ 350     $ 455     $ (264 )   $ 649  
Net income (loss)
  $ 31     $ 204     $ 274     $ (287 )   $ 222  
Net income (loss) attributable to PBG
  $ 28     $ 174     $ 231     $ (271 )   $ 162  
Diluted earnings (loss) per share (2)
  $ 0.12     $ 0.78     $ 1.06     $ (1.28 )   $ 0.74  
 
(1)     For additional unaudited information see “Items affecting comparability of our financial results” in Management’s Financial Review in Item 7.
 
(2)   Diluted earnings per share are computed independently for each of the periods presented.
Note 21—SUBSEQUENT EVENT
     On February 12, 2010, the Company purchased Ab-Tex Beverage, Ltd. With nearly 450 employees, Ab-Tex bottles, packages and distributes several leading beverage brands, including Pepsi-Cola, Dr Pepper, Mountain Dew, 7UP, and Sunkist throughout central Texas.

81


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Shareholders of
The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Somers, New York
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity, comprehensive income (loss), and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 26, 2009. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15. These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 26, 2009, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also, in our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.
As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the accompanying consolidated financial statements have been retrospectively adjusted for the adoption of new accounting guidance for the presentation and disclosure of noncontrolling interests.
As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, effective December 30, 2007, the Company adopted the new accounting guidance for defined benefit pension and other postretirement plans, related to the measurement date provision.
As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, effective December 31, 2006, the Company adopted new accounting guidance on the accounting for uncertain tax positions.
As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, on February 17, 2010, the Company’s shareholders adopted the merger agreement with PepsiCo, Inc.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 26, 2009, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 22, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP
New York, New York
February 22, 2010

82


Table of Contents

ITEM 7A.   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
          Included in Item 7, Management’s Financial Review — Market Risks and Cautionary Statements.
ITEM 8.   FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
          Included in Item 7, Management’s Financial Review — Financial Statements.
ITEM 9.   CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
          None.
ITEM 9A.   CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
          PBG’s management carried out an evaluation, as required by Rule 13a-15(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of our last fiscal quarter. Based upon this evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective, as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, such that the information relating to PBG and its consolidated subsidiaries required to be disclosed in our Exchange Act reports filed with the SEC (i) is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms, and (ii) is accumulated and communicated to PBG’s management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
          PBG’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for PBG. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of PBG’s assets, (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that PBG’s receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of PBG’s management and directors, and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of PBG’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
          As required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the related rule of the SEC, management assessed the effectiveness of PBG’s internal control over financial reporting using the Internal Control-Integrated Framework developed by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
          Based on this assessment, management concluded that PBG’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 26, 2009. Management has not identified any material weaknesses in PBG’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 26, 2009.
          Our independent registered public accounting firm, Deloitte & Touche LLP (“D&T”), who has audited and reported on our financial statements, issued an attestation report on PBG’s internal control over financial reporting. D&T’s reports are included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

83


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Shareholders of
The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
Somers, New York
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 26, 2009, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company’s board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 26, 2009, based on the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule as of and for the year ended December 26, 2009 of the Company and our report dated February 22, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements and financial statement schedule and includes explanatory paragraphs for the retrospective adjustment to the accompanying consolidated financial statements resulting from the adoption of new accounting guidance for the presentation and disclosure of noncontrolling interests and the Company’s shareholders adoption of the merger agreement with PepsiCo, Inc.
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP
New York, New York
February 22, 2010
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
          PBG’s management also carried out an evaluation, as required by Rule 13a-15(d) of the Exchange Act, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, of changes in PBG’s internal control over financial reporting. Based on this evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer concluded that there were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during our last fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
ITEM 9B.   OTHER INFORMATION
          None.

84


Table of Contents

PART III
          In light of the pending merger between the Company and PepsiCo which is expected to be finalized by the end of the first quarter of 2010, we do not anticipate filing a definitive proxy statement pursuant to Regulation 14A or holding a 2010 annual meeting of shareholders. Therefore, we have set out in this document the information required by Part III of Form 10-K under Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14, in accordance with the rules of the SEC as in effect on the date hereof.
ITEM 10.   DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
PBG Executive Officers
          Executive officers are elected by our Board of Directors, and their terms of office continue until the next annual meeting of the Board or until their successors are elected and have been qualified. There are no family relationships among our executive officers. Set forth below is information pertaining to our executive officers who held office as of February 5, 2010:
          John L. Berisford, 46, was appointed Senior Vice President of Human Resources in March 2005. Mr. Berisford previously served as Vice President, Field Human Resources and Group Vice President of Human Resources from 2001 to 2004. From 1998 to 2001, Mr. Berisford served as Vice President of Organization Capability. Mr. Berisford joined Pepsi in 1988 and held a series of staffing, labor relations and organizational capability positions.
          Victor L. Crawford, 48, was appointed Senior Vice President of Global Operations and System Transformation in November 2008. Mr. Crawford previously served as Senior Vice President, Worldwide Operations from December 2006 to November 2008. From December 2005 to December 2006, Mr. Crawford served as Senior Vice President and General Manager of PBG’s Mid-Atlantic Business Unit. Prior to that, Mr. Crawford was with Marriott International where he served as Senior Vice President of Marriott Distribution Services, Executive Vice President and General Manager and Senior Vice President and Chief Operations Officer for the Eastern Region of Marriott International from September 2000 until joining PBG in December 2005.
          Alfred H. Drewes, 54, was appointed Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer in June 2001. Mr. Drewes previously served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Pepsi-Cola International (“PCI”). Mr. Drewes joined PepsiCo in 1982 as a financial analyst in New Jersey. During the next nine years, he rose through increasingly responsible finance positions within Pepsi-Cola North America in field operations and headquarters. In 1991, Mr. Drewes joined PCI as Vice President of Manufacturing Operations, with responsibility for the global concentrate supply organization. In 1994, he was appointed Vice President of Business Planning and New Business Development and, in 1996, relocated to London as the Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Europe and Sub-Saharan Africa Business Unit of PCI. Mr. Drewes is also a director of the Meredith Corporation.
          Eric J. Foss, 51, was appointed Chairman of our Board in October 2008 and has been our Chief Executive Officer and a member of our Board since July 2006. Mr. Foss served as our President and Chief Executive Officer from July 2006 to October 2008. Previously, Mr. Foss served as our Chief Operating Officer from September 2005 to July 2006 and President of PBG North America from September 2001 to September 2005. Prior to that, Mr. Foss was the Executive Vice President and General Manager of PBG North America from August 2000 to September 2001. From October 1999 until August 2000, he served as our Senior Vice President, U.S. Sales and Field Operations, and prior to that, he was our Senior Vice President, Sales and Field Marketing, since March 1999. Mr. Foss joined the Pepsi-Cola Company in 1982 where he held a variety of field and headquarters-based sales, marketing and general management positions. From 1994 to 1996, Mr. Foss was General Manager of Pepsi-Cola North America’s Great West Business Unit. In 1996, Mr. Foss was named General Manager for the Central Europe Region for Pepsi-Cola International, a position he held until joining PBG in March 1999. Mr. Foss is also a director of UDR, Inc. and serves on the Industry Affairs Council of the Grocery Manufacturers of America.
          Robert C. King, 51, was appointed Executive Vice President and President of North America in November 2008. Previously, Mr. King served as President of PBG’s North American business from December 2006 to November 2008 and served as President of PBG’s North American Field Operations from October 2005 to December 2006. Prior to that, Mr. King served as Senior Vice President and General Manager of PBG’s Mid-Atlantic Business Unit from October 2002 to October 2005. From 2001 to October 2002, he served as Senior Vice President, National Sales and Field Marketing. In 1999, he was appointed Vice President, National Sales and Field Marketing. Mr. King joined Pepsi-Cola North America in 1989 as a Business Development Manager and has held a variety of other field and headquarters-based sales and general management positions.
          Yiannis Petrides, 51, is the President of PBG Europe. He was appointed to this position in June 2000, with responsibilities for our operations in Spain, Greece, Turkey and Russia. Prior to that, Mr. Petrides served as Business Unit General Manager for PBG in Spain and Greece. Mr. Petrides joined PepsiCo in 1987 in the international beverage division. In 1993, he was named General

85


Table of Contents

Manager of Frito-Lay’s Greek operation with additional responsibility for the Balkan countries. In 1995, Mr. Petrides was appointed Business Unit General Manager for Pepsi Beverages International’s bottling operation in Spain. Mr. Petrides serves on the Board of Directors of Campofrio Food Group, S.A.
          Steven M. Rapp, 56, was appointed Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary in January 2005. Mr. Rapp previously served as Vice President, Deputy General Counsel and Assistant Secretary from 1999 through 2004. Mr. Rapp joined PepsiCo as a corporate attorney in 1986 and was appointed Division Counsel of Pepsi-Cola Company in 1994.
PBG Board of Directors
          The name, age and background of each of our directors is set forth below. Our directors are elected annually and serve until the next annual meeting of shareholders or until their successors are elected and qualified.
          Linda G. Alvarado, 58, was elected to our Board in March 1999. She is the President and Chief Executive Officer of Alvarado Construction, Inc., a general contracting firm specializing in commercial, industrial, environmental and heavy engineering projects, a position she assumed in 1976. Ms. Alvarado is also a director of Pitney Bowes Inc., Qwest Communications International Inc., Lennox International Inc. and 3M Company.
          Barry H. Beracha, 67, was elected to our Board in March 1999. Mr. Beracha served as our Non-Executive Chairman from April 2007 to October 2008. Mr. Beracha served as an Executive Vice President of Sara Lee Corporation and Chief Executive Officer of Sara Lee Bakery Group from August 2001 until his retirement in June 2003. Mr. Beracha was the Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of The Earthgrains Company from 1993 to August 2001. Earthgrains was formerly part of Anheuser-Busch Companies, where Mr. Beracha served from 1967 to 1996. From 1979 to 1993, he held the position of Chairman of the Board of Anheuser-Busch Recycling Corporation. From 1976 to 1995, Mr. Beracha was also Chairman of the Board of Metal Container Corporation. Mr. Beracha is also a director of Hertz Global Holdings, Inc. and Chairman of the Board of Trustees of St. Louis University.
          John C. Compton, 48, was elected to our Board in March 2008. Mr. Compton is Chief Executive Officer of PepsiCo Americas Foods, an operating unit of PepsiCo, a position he assumed in November 2007. Mr. Compton began his career at PepsiCo in 1983 as a Frito-Lay Production Supervisor and since that time has held various sales, marketing, operations and general management positions. From September 2006 until November 2007, Mr. Compton was Chief Executive Officer of PepsiCo North America and from March 2005 until September 2006, he was President and Chief Executive Officer of Quaker, Tropicana, Gatorade. Mr. Compton served as Vice Chairman and President of the North American Salty Snacks Division of Frito-Lay from March 2003 until March 2005. Prior to that, he served as Chief Marketing Officer of Frito-Lay’s North American Salty Snacks Division from August 2001 until March 2003.
          Eric J. Foss, 51, was appointed Chairman of our Board in October 2008 and has been our Chief Executive Officer and a member of our Board since July 2006. Mr. Foss served as our President and Chief Executive Officer from July 2006 to October 2008. Previously, Mr. Foss served as our Chief Operating Officer from September 2005 to July 2006 and President of PBG North America from September 2001 to September 2005. Prior to that, Mr. Foss was the Executive Vice President and General Manager of PBG North America from August 2000 to September 2001. From October 1999 until August 2000, he served as our Senior Vice President, U.S. Sales and Field Operations, and prior to that, he was our Senior Vice President, Sales and Field Marketing, since March 1999. Mr. Foss joined the Pepsi-Cola Company in 1982 where he held a variety of field and headquarters-based sales, marketing and general management positions. From 1994 to 1996, Mr. Foss was General Manager of Pepsi-Cola North America’s Great West Business Unit. In 1996, Mr. Foss was named General Manager for the Central Europe Region for Pepsi-Cola International, a position he held until joining PBG in March 1999. Mr. Foss is also a director of UDR, Inc. and serves on the Industry Affairs Council of the Grocery Manufacturers of America.
          Ira D. Hall, 65, was elected to our Board in March 2003. From 2002 until his retirement in late 2004, Mr. Hall was President and Chief Executive Officer of Utendahl Capital Management, LP. From 1999 to 2001, Mr. Hall was Treasurer of Texaco Inc. and General Manager, Alliance Management for Texaco Inc. from 1998 to 1999. From 1985 to 1998, Mr. Hall held various positions with International Business Machines Corporation. Mr. Hall is also a director of Praxair, Inc.
          Susan D. Kronick, 58, was elected to our Board in March 1999. Ms. Kronick became Vice Chair of Macy’s, Inc. (formerly known as Federated Department Stores, Inc.) in February 2003. Previously, she had been Group President of Federated Department Stores since April 2001. From 1997 to 2001, Ms. Kronick was the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Burdines, a division of Federated Department Stores. From 1993 to 1997, Ms. Kronick served as President of Federated’s Rich’s/Lazarus/Goldsmith’s division. She spent the previous 20 years at Bloomingdale’s, where her last position was Senior Executive Vice President and Director of Stores. Ms. Kronick is also a director of Hyatt Hotels Corporation.

86


Table of Contents

          Blythe J. McGarvie, 53, was elected to our Board in March 2002. Ms. McGarvie is Chief Executive Officer of Leadership for International Finance, a private consulting firm providing leadership seminars for corporate and academic groups. From 1999 to December 2002, Ms. McGarvie was Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of BIC Group. From 1994 to 1999, Ms. McGarvie served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Hannaford Bros. Co. Ms. McGarvie is a Certified Public Accountant and has also held senior financial positions at Sara Lee Corporation, Kraft General Foods, Inc. and Pizza Hut, Inc. Ms. McGarvie is also a director of Accenture Ltd, The Travelers Companies, Inc. and Viacom Inc.
          John A. Quelch, 58, was elected to our Board in January 2005. Mr. Quelch has been Senior Associate Dean and Lincoln Filene Professor of Business Administration at Harvard Business School since 2001. From 1998 to 2001, Mr. Quelch was Dean of the London Business School. Prior to that he was an Assistant Professor, an Associate Professor and a full Professor of Business Administration at Harvard Business School from 1979 to 1998. Mr. Quelch is also a director of WPP plc and Inverness Medical Innovations, Inc.
          Javier G. Teruel, 59, was elected to our Board in May 2007. Mr. Teruel has served as a partner at Spectron Desarrollo, S.C., a management and consulting firm in Mexico, since May 2007. Previously, he served as Vice Chairman of Colgate-Palmolive Company until his retirement in April 2007. While serving as Vice Chairman, a position he assumed in 2004, Mr. Teruel was responsible for the operations of the Hill’s Pet Nutrition Division, Global R&D, Global Supply Chain, and Global Information Technology. Additionally, he led Colgate’s evolving worldwide strategy, which included overseeing Colgate’s business building and restructuring initiative. From 2002 to 2004, Mr. Teruel served as Executive Vice President, with responsibility for Colgate’s Asia and South Pacific, Central Europe/Russia, and Africa/Middle East Divisions, as well as Hill’s Pet Nutrition. Mr. Teruel joined Colgate-Palmolive in 1971 in Mexico where he held a variety of marketing, sales and management positions. Mr. Teruel is also a director of Starbucks Corporation and J.C. Penney Company, Inc.
          Cynthia M. Trudell, 56, was elected to our Board in May 2008. Ms. Trudell is Senior Vice President, Chief Personnel Officer of PepsiCo, a position she assumed in February 2007. Ms. Trudell served as a director of PepsiCo from January 2000 until her appointment to her current position. Prior to joining PepsiCo, Ms. Trudell served as Vice President of Brunswick Corporation and President of Sea Ray Group from 2001 until 2006. From 1999 until 2001, Ms. Trudell served as General Motors’ Vice President, and Chairman and President of Saturn Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of GM. From 1995 to 1999, she served as President of IBC Vehicles in Luton, England, a joint venture between General Motors and Isuzu. Ms. Trudell began her career with the Ford Motor Co. as a chemical process engineer. In 1981, she joined GM and held various engineering and manufacturing supervisory positions.
Corporate Governance
          Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance. Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 requires our directors, certain officers and persons who own more than ten percent of our outstanding common stock to file with the SEC reports of ownership and changes in ownership of our common stock held by such persons. Officers, directors and greater than ten percent shareholders are also required to furnish us with copies of all forms they file under this regulation. To our knowledge, based solely on a review of the copies of such reports furnished to us, all Section 16(a) filing requirements applicable to all of our reporting persons were complied with during fiscal year 2009 except in July 2009, John A. Quelch made a late filing on Form 4 with respect to the acquisition of 697 phantom stock units.
          Worldwide Code of Conduct. We initially adopted a Worldwide Code of Conduct in 2000 and have revised it periodically, most recently in 2007. The Worldwide Code of Conduct applies to all of our directors and employees, including our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Controller. The Worldwide Code of Conduct, which we believe complies with all NYSE corporate governance rules, is posted on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance. A copy of our Worldwide Code of Conduct is available upon request without charge by writing to The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc., One Pepsi Way, Somers, New York 10589, Attention: Investor Relations. We intend to post on our website any material amendments to our Worldwide Code of Conduct and the description of any waiver from a provision of the Code of Conduct granted by our Board to any director or executive officer within four business days of such amendment or waiver.
          The Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee. The Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee assists our Board of Directors in its oversight of the quality and integrity of the Company’s financial statements, independent and internal auditors and compliance with legal and regulatory requirements. The Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee acts under a written charter that has been approved by our Board of Directors and complies with the NYSE corporate governance rules and applicable SEC rules and regulations. The charter is posted on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance and is available in print without charge to any shareholder upon request. The members of our Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee are Barry H. Beracha, Ira D. Hall, Blythe J. McGarvie and John A. Quelch. Our Board has determined that each member is financially literate and that Ms. McGarvie is qualified to serve as the Committee’s “financial expert” (as such term is defined by SEC regulations). A brief description of Ms. McGarvie’s work experience is included above under the section entitled “PBG Board of Directors.”

87


Table of Contents

          The Compensation and Management Development Committee. The Compensation and Management Development Committee (the “Committee”) has direct responsibility for annual and long-term incentive compensation and oversees our employee benefit programs. The Compensation and Management Development Committee acts under a written charter that has been approved by our Board of Directors and complies with the NYSE corporate governance rules. The charter is posted on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance and is available in print without charge to any PBG shareholder upon request. The members of our Compensation and Management Development Committee are Barry H. Beracha, Ira D. Hall, Susan D. Kronick and John A. Quelch, all of whom are independent Directors as more fully discussed in Item 12 under “Director Independence.”
          The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee. The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee identifies and recommends to our Board of Directors qualified candidates for election to our Board of Directors and its committees and oversees the evaluation of our Board and corporate governance practices. The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee acts under a written charter that has been approved by our Board of Directors and complies with NYSE corporate governance rules. The charter is posted on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance and is available in print without charge to any PBG shareholder upon request. The members of our Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee are Linda G. Alvarado, Susan D. Kronick and Javier G. Teruel, all of whom are independent Directors as more fully discussed in Item 12 under “Director Independence.”
ITEM 11.   EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
Compensation Discussion and Analysis (CD&A)
What are the highlights of our 2009 executive compensation program as described in this CD&A?
    The primary objectives of our compensation program are to attract, retain, and motivate talented and diverse domestic and international executives
 
    We provide our executive officers with the following types of compensation: base salary, short-term performance-based cash incentives, and long-term performance-based equity incentive awards
 
    We believe that to appropriately motivate our senior executives to achieve and sustain the long-term growth of the Company, a majority of their compensation should be tied to the performance of the Company and each executive’s contribution to that performance so that, since 2008, our annual performance based cash incentive program for senior executives contains both an individual, non-financial performance component and a financial component
 
    In 2009, in response to the challenging worldwide economic conditions, the Committee determined to freeze salaries and make no changes to the bonus or equity award levels for the Named Executive Officers
 
    In 2009, the Committee approved changes to the financial component for our executives to further align their financial targets with their responsibilities
 
    We use equity-based compensation as a means to align the interests of our executives with those of our shareholders
 
    We believe the design of our executive compensation program drives performance in a financially responsible way that is sensitive to the dilutive impact on shareholders
 
    We generally target total compensation within the third quartile of companies within our peer group of companies which was unchanged in 2009
 
    Despite the challenging worldwide economic environment in 2009 our management nevertheless delivered solid year-over-year financial results. Based on these results, the Committee certified above-target performance for each of the Named Executive Officers
 
    We have never backdated or re-priced equity awards and we do not time our equity award grants relative to the release of material non-public information
 
    We do not ordinarily provide our executive officers with employment, severance or change-in-control agreements. However, in response to the unsolicited proposal from PepsiCo to acquire all of the outstanding shares of PBG’s common stock not owned by PepsiCo, the Committee determined it advisable to enter into retention agreements with each of the Named

88


Table of Contents

      Executive Officers in order to diminish the distraction created by the proposal and to insure the stability of management and the continued success of the Company
 
    We do not provide any gross-ups for potential excise taxes that may be incurred in connection with a change-in-control of the Company
 
    We have a long-standing policy in place to recoup compensation from an executive who has engaged in misconduct
 
    Our executives participate in the same group benefit programs, at the same levels, as all employees
Who oversees our executive compensation program?
          Our executive compensation program is overseen by our Compensation and Management Development Committee, which is comprised solely of independent, non-employee directors. For a description of the Committee’s composition and responsibilities, see the section entitled “Corporate Governance — The Compensation and Management Development Committee.”
What are the objectives of our executive compensation program?
The objectives of our executive compensation program are to:
    Provide a total compensation program that is appropriately competitive within our industry and reinforces our short-term and long-term business objectives by:
      n motivating and rewarding key executives for achieving and exceeding our business objectives;
 
      n providing financial consequences to key executives for failing to achieve our business objectives; and
 
      n attracting and retaining key executives through meaningful wealth-creation opportunities;
    Align the interests of shareholders, the Company and executives by placing particular emphasis on performance-based and equity-based compensation;
 
    Maintain a financially responsible program that is appropriate within our financial structure and sensitive to the dilutive impact on shareholders; and
 
    Establish and maintain our program in accordance with all applicable laws and regulations, as well as with corporate governance best practices.
How do we achieve our objectives?
          We achieve our objectives through the use of various executive compensation elements that drive both short-term and long-term Company performance, deliver to our executives fixed pay as well as variable, performance-based pay, and provide significant personal exposure to PBG common stock. In 2009, the principal elements of executive compensation were base salary, an annual performance-based cash incentive (variable, short-term pay), and long-term incentive awards in the form of stock options and restricted stock units (“RSUs”) (variable, long-term pay). These three elements of executive compensation are referred to as “total compensation.”
                         
                Objective
                    Alignment with    
Element of Total   Form of       Motivation   Shareholder    
Compensation   Compensation   Attraction   Short-Term   Long-Term   Interests   Retention
Base Salary
  Cash   ü   ü           ü
                         
Annual Performance-Based Cash Incentive   Cash   ü   ü       ü   ü
                         
Long-Term Performance-Based Equity Incentive   Stock Options RSUs   ü       ü   ü   ü

89


Table of Contents

Why do we choose to pay a mix of cash and equity-based compensation?
          We view the combination of cash and equity-based compensation as an important tool to assist us in achieving the objectives of our program. The Committee periodically reviews the mix of cash and equity-based compensation provided under the program to ensure that the mix is appropriate in light of market trends and the Company’s primary business objectives.
          We pay base salary in cash so that our executives have a steady, liquid source of compensation.
          We pay our annual incentive in cash because our annual incentive is tied to the achievement of our short-term (i.e., annual) business objectives, and we believe a cash bonus is the strongest way to motivate and reward the achievement of these objectives.
          Finally, we pay our long-term incentive in the form of PBG equity because our long-term incentive is tied to our long-term business objectives, and we believe the market value of PBG equity is a strong indicator of whether PBG is achieving its long-term business objectives.
          For 2009, our Named Executive Officers’ percentage of cash (based on base salary and target payout of the short-term cash incentive) versus equity-based pay (based on the grant date fair value of the annual 2009 equity awards and the annualized grant date fair value (one-fourth) of the one-time Strategic Leadership Award), was approximately as follows:
     
Chairman and CEO   Other Named Executive Officers (Average)
     
(PIE CHART)   (PIE CHART)
Why is the compensation of our Named Executive Officers largely performance-based compensation rather than fixed?
          Consistent with the objectives of our program, we utilize the performance-based elements of our program to reinforce our short-term and long-term business objectives and to align shareholder and executive interests. We believe that to appropriately motivate our senior executives to achieve our business objectives, a majority of their compensation should be tied to the performance of the Company. Thus, we link the level of compensation to the achievement of our business objectives. As a result of this link, for years when the Company achieves above-target performance, executives will be paid above-target compensation, and for years when the Company achieves below-target performance, executives will be paid below-target compensation.
          We also believe that the more influence an executive has over Company performance, the more the executive’s compensation should be tied to our performance results. Thus, the more senior the executive, the greater the percentage of his or her total compensation that is performance-based.
          When looking at the three elements of total compensation, we view base salary as fixed pay (i.e., once established, it is not performance-based) and the annual incentive and long-term incentive as performance-based pay. With respect to our cash-based, annual incentive, our intent is to emphasize the Company’s performance in a given year. As a result of a design change approved by the Committee in 2008, we link eighty percent of the annual incentive to the achievement of annual performance measures (such as year-over-year profit, net revenue and volume growth) and twenty percent of the incentive to the achievement of individual non-financial performance measures (such as employee and customer satisfaction survey scores). With respect to our equity-based, long-term incentive, we view the market value of PBG common stock as the primary performance measure. This is especially true in the case of stock options, which have no value to the executive unless the market value of PBG common stock goes up after the grant date. In the case of other equity-based awards to the Named Executive Officers, such as RSUs, that have value to the executive even if the market value of PBG common stock goes down after the grant date, we typically include a second performance component — such as a specific earnings per share performance target — that must be satisfied in order for the executive to vest in the award. In addition, we may grant supplemental, performance-based equity awards to executives in order to link long-term compensation with the Company’s strategic imperatives and to reinforce continuity within the senior leadership team, as we did with the 2008 Strategic Leadership Awards.

90


Table of Contents

          The percentage of our Named Executive Officers’ 2009 total target compensation that was performance-based (based on base salary, target payout of the short-term cash incentive, the grant date fair value of the annual 2009 equity awards and the annualized grant date fair value (one-fourth) of the one-time Strategic Leadership Awards granted in 2008) was approximately as follows:
     
Chairman and CEO   Other Named Executive Officers (Average)
     
(PIE CHART)   (PIE CHART)
Why do we use earnings per share, volume, net revenue and cash flow as the financial criteria for our performance-based compensation?
          In selecting the criteria on which to base the performance targets underlying our short-term and long-term incentive pay, we choose criteria that are leading indicators of our success, important to our shareholders and external market professionals, and relevant to our executives whose performance we strive to motivate towards the achievement of the particular targets.
          For our business and industry, we believe the most relevant financial criteria on which to evaluate our success are comparable (or operational) earnings per share (“EPS”), profit, net revenue, volume of product sold and operating free cash flow (as defined in our earnings releases). We view EPS as the best composite indicator of PBG’s operational performance. The Committee, therefore, emphasizes comparable EPS in establishing performance targets for the Named Executive Officers. In evaluating our performance against such EPS targets, the Committee considers the impact of unusual events on our reported EPS results (e.g., acquisitions, changes in accounting practices, share repurchases, etc.) and adjusts the reported results for purposes of determining the extent to which the comparable EPS targets were or were not achieved. The comparable EPS performance targets and results utilized by the Committee under our compensation program are generally consistent with the Company’s publicly disclosed EPS guidance and results.
          Short-Term Incentive. Under our short-term incentive program, we establish performance targets that are designed to motivate executives to achieve our short-term business targets. Therefore, for the executives leading our geographic business units, the Committee links the payment of 80% of the executives’ annual bonus to the achievement of year-over-year profit and net revenue or volume growth targets as well as a cash flow target, which are set at levels specifically chosen for each geographic territory. The Committee believes tying a substantial portion of these executives’ annual bonuses to local performance is the best way to motivate such executives to achieve business success within the regions they manage. Beginning in 2008, 20% of each senior executive’s annual bonus is tied to individual non-financial goals which are qualitative and specific to the executive’s area of responsibility. The Committee implemented these goals to reinforce the importance of certain non-financial business objectives.
          For our Named Executive Officers, the Committee establishes a table of comparable EPS targets that, depending on the level of EPS achieved during the year, establishes the maximum bonus payable to each executive for that year. No bonus is payable if comparable EPS is below a certain level. The Committee then uses its discretion to determine the actual bonus paid to each executive, which is never greater, and is typically much less, than the maximum bonus payable. In exercising this discretion, the Committee refers to a separately established comparable EPS or net operating profit before taxes (“NOPBT”) target, as well as volume, net revenue and operating free cash flow targets, and individual non-financial targets, all of which the Committee approves at the beginning of the year. For Named Executive Officers with worldwide responsibilities, the financial targets are typically consistent with the Company’s EPS, net revenue and operating free cash flow guidance provided to external market professionals at the beginning of the year. For Named Executive Officers with responsibility over one of our operating segments outside the United States, these targets are typically consistent with the Company’s internal operating plans for the particular segment.
          With the introduction of individual, non-financial targets, the Committee’s discretion is also guided by the Chairman and CEO’s evaluation of each of the other Named Executive Officer’s performance against these targets. In addition, consistent with past practice, the Committee separately considers the performance of the Chairman and CEO and is guided by reference to certain pre-established, non-financial targets specific to the Chairman and CEO (often related to strategic planning, organizational capabilities and/or executive development).

91


Table of Contents

          Notably, in establishing the actual bonus paid for each Named Executive Officer (within the limit of the maximum bonus payable), the Committee refers to the above financial and non-financial targets, but reserves the right to pay a bonus at the level it deems appropriate based on the performance of the Company and each executive. The performance targets established by the Committee with respect to the 2009 bonus are more fully described at page 97.
          Long-Term Incentive. The Committee provides our long-term incentive in the form of an equity-based award because it believes the price of PBG common stock is a strong indicator of whether PBG is meeting its long-term objectives. The Committee, therefore, believes it important that each executive, in particular our senior executives, have personal financial exposure to the performance of PBG common stock. Such exposure results in a link between shareholder and executive interests and motivates our executives to achieve and sustain the long-term growth of PBG. Consequently, we are committed to paying a significant portion of executive compensation in the form of PBG equity. We are deliberate, however, in our use of equity compensation to avoid an inappropriate dilution of PBG’s current shareholders.
          As a way of ensuring our executives remain motivated and to bolster the retention of our executives, the Committee does not provide for immediate vesting of our long-term incentive awards. Instead, consistent with the three-year time frame with respect to which we establish our strategic plans, the Committee typically provides for a three-year vesting period for equity-based awards. Executives must remain an employee of the Company through the vesting date to vest in the award. For equity-based awards that have no intrinsic value to the executive on the grant date, such as stock options, the Committee typically provides for staged vesting of such awards over the three-year vesting period (e.g., one-third vesting each year). For equity-based awards that have value to the executive on the grant date, such as RSUs, the Committee typically provides for vesting of the award only at the end of the three-year period.
          Typically, for awards to our Named Executive Officers that have actual value on the grant date (such as RSUs), the Committee also establishes a comparable EPS performance target for the year in which the award is granted. The achievement of this EPS target is a prerequisite to vesting in the award at the end of the three-year vesting period. The Committee believes such an additional performance element is appropriate to ensure that the executives do not obtain significant compensation if the performance of the Company in the year of grant is significantly below our EPS target. As our long-term incentive is designed to reinforce our long-term business objectives, however, the Committee typically establishes this one-year EPS performance target at a lower level than the Company’s external guidance. The Committee does so to ensure that executives only lose the RSUs granted in that year if the Company misses its EPS target to such an extent as to indicate that a performance issue exists that is unlikely to be resolved in the near term. The implementation of this additional EPS performance target also ensures that the compensation paid through our long-term incentive is deductible to the Company (see the section entitled “Deductibility of Compensation Expenses” below).
Why do we provide perquisites as an element of compensation?
          Certain perquisites provided to our senior executives are services or benefits designed to ensure that executives are fully focused on their responsibilities to the Company. For example, we make annual physicals available to our senior executives so that they can efficiently address this important personal issue and, therefore, maximize their productivity at work. Other perquisites, such as our Company car program, simply represent a Company choice on how to deliver fixed pay to our executives.
          We also provide certain specific perquisites to senior executives who move to and work in international locations. Such perquisites are provided based on local and competitive practices. Perquisites such as housing allowances are typical in the international arena.
          For certain limited perquisites, the Company reimburses (or grosses-up) the executive for the tax liability resulting from the income imputed to the executive in connection with the perquisite. We do so because we do not want our provision of such perquisites to result in a financial penalty to the executive or potentially discourage the executive from taking advantage of the perquisite. For example, we gross-up an executive with respect to his or her annual physical and benefits provided under the Company car program. We do not, however, gross-up perquisites with respect to which the Company does not have an interest in encouraging, such as our executives’ limited personal use of corporate transportation.
          In 2009, limited perquisites were provided to our Named Executive Officers, consistent with the Company practice described above. These perquisites are described in more detail in the footnotes to the Summary Compensation Table.
What other forms of compensation do we provide to our employees, including the Named Executive Officers, and why do we provide them?
          The Company provides a number of other employee benefits to its employees, including the Named Executive Officers, that are generally comparable to those benefits provided at similarly sized companies. Such benefits enhance the Company’s reputation as an employer of choice and thereby serve the objectives of our compensation program to attract, retain and motivate our executives.

92


Table of Contents

          Pension. The Company maintains a qualified defined benefit pension plan for a limited number of eligible employees as well as a non-qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “Excess Plan”) for such eligible employees with annual compensation or pension benefits in excess of limits imposed by the IRS.
          Effective April 1, 2009, the Company amended its qualified and non-qualified defined benefit pension plans to cease all future accruals for salaried and non-union U.S. hourly employees with the exception of employees who, on March 31, 2009 (i) met a Rule of 65 (combined age and years of service equal to or greater than 65) or (ii) were at least age 50 with five years of service. The Named Executive Officers, with the exception of Mr. Crawford, satisfy the Rule of 65 and continue to accrue defined benefit pension benefits. Mr. Crawford ceased to accrue pension benefits and is eligible to receive the Company Retirement Contribution described below.
          Mr. Petrides participates in a separate international non-qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “PepsiCo International Retirement Plan”), which is designed to provide a pension benefit to senior executives who live and work outside of the U.S. or their home country. The pension benefit provided under this plan is essentially the same as that provided to U.S. employees under the above-referenced qualified pension plan and Excess Plan and is offset by all amounts paid to or on behalf of the executive by the Company pursuant to any Company sponsored plan or government mandated programs.
          The Company does not provide any specially enhanced pension plan formulas or provisions that are limited to our Named Executive Officers.
          401(k) Savings Plan. Our U.S.-based Named Executive Officers participate in the same 401(k) savings program as provided to other U.S. employees. This program includes a Company match. The Company does not provide any special 401(k) benefits to our Named Executive Officers.
          In addition, salaried and non-union U.S. hourly employees hired on or after January 1, 2007 and employees hired prior to such date who do not meet the criteria for eligibility under the frozen defined benefit pension plan, including Mr. Crawford, are eligible to receive a Company Retirement Contribution (“CRC”) under the 401(k) plan equal to 2% of eligible compensation (annual pay and bonus) for employees with less than ten years of service and 3% of eligible compensation for employees with ten or more years of service. The Company also maintains a non-qualified plan for employees who are eligible for a CRC benefit in excess of the limits imposed by the IRS.
          Deferred Income Program. The Company also maintains an Executive Income Deferral Program (the “Deferral Program”), through which all Company executives, including the Named Executive Officers, paid in U.S. dollars, may elect to defer their base salary and/or their annual cash bonus. The Company makes the Deferral Program available to executives so they have the opportunity to defer their cash compensation without regard to the limit imposed by the IRS for amounts that may be deferred under the 401(k) plan. The material terms of the Deferral Program are described in the Narrative to the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table.
          Health and Welfare Benefits. The Company also provides other benefits such as medical, dental, life insurance, and long-term disability coverage, on the same terms and conditions, to all employees, including the Named Executive Officers.
What policies and practices do we utilize in designing our executive compensation program and setting target levels of total compensation?
          The Committee has established several policies and practices that govern the design and structure of PBG’s executive compensation program.
          Process of Designing the Executive Compensation Program. Each year, the Committee reviews the PBG executive compensation program and establishes the target compensation level for our Chairman and CEO and the other Named Executive Officers who appear in the tables in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
          Target Compensation — Use of Peer Group Data. In establishing the target total compensation for the Named Executive Officers, the Committee considers the competitive labor market, as determined by looking at PBG’s peer group of companies and other compensation survey data. The Committee believes that the total compensation paid to our executive officers generally should be targeted within the third quartile (which for 2009 we defined as the average of the 50th and 75th percentile) of the total compensation opportunities of executive officers at comparable companies. The Committee believes that this target is appropriately competitive and provides a total compensation opportunity that will be effective in attracting, retaining and motivating the leaders we need to be successful.

93


Table of Contents

          For positions with respect to which there is widespread, publicly available compensation data (e.g. CEO), we establish the third quartile based on compensation data of our peer group companies. PBG’s peer group is made up of comparably sized companies, each of which is a PBG competitor, customer or peer from the consumer goods or services industry. Our peer group companies are generally world-class, industry leading companies with superior brands and/or products. The Committee, with the assistance of senior management and the Committee’s independent compensation consultant, periodically reviews PBG’s peer group to ensure the peer group is an appropriate measure of the competitive labor market for the Company’s senior executives. In 2009, the Committee used the following peer group for purposes of determining each of the Named Executive Officer’s target total compensation:
     
Campbell Soup Company   H.J. Heinz Company
Clorox Company, Inc.   Hershey Foods Corporation
Coca-Cola Enterprises Inc.   Kellogg Company
ConAgra Foods, Inc.   Newell Rubbermaid Inc.
Dean Foods Company   PepsiAmericas, Inc.
FedEx Corporation   Sara Lee Corporation
General Mills, Inc.   Supervalu Inc.
    Sysco Corporation
          Comparative financial measures and number of employees for the 2009 peer group are shown below:
                                   
    Peer Group*     PBG
        75th     PBG   Percent
    Median   Percentile     Data   Rank
Revenue
  $ 12,455     $ 17,730       $ 13,796       72 %
Net Income Attributable to the Company
  $ 519     $ 976       $ 162       21 %
Market Capitalization
  $ 7,707     $ 12,806       $ 4,753       26 %
Number of Employees
    29,500       47,000         66,800       84 %
 
*   Dollars are in millions. Based on information as of December 31, 2008.
          For senior executive positions for which peer group data is not consistently publicly available (e.g., a general manager with specific geographic responsibilities), we establish the third quartile based on available peer group data and other compensation survey data from nationally-recognized human resources consulting firms.
          Based on the peer group and other survey data, the Committee establishes the third quartile for target total compensation for each executive, as well as for various elements of total compensation, including base pay, total annual cash (base pay and target annual incentive) and total compensation (total annual cash and long-term incentive). The Committee then establishes the midpoint of the third quartile as its “market target.” The market target for each element of total compensation is determined by reference to compensation payable in U.S. dollars. To the extent a Named Executive Officer’s salary or annual performance-based cash incentive is paid in a currency other than U.S. dollars, the value in U.S. dollars will fluctuate based on changes in the exchange rate. For example, Mr. Petrides’ compensation is paid in Euros. Consequently, as the value of the Euro changes relative to the value of the U.S. dollar, the value of Mr. Petrides’ salary stated in U.S. dollars changes accordingly (even though the salary he actually receives in Euros stays the same).
          Establishing Target Compensation; Role of the Chairman and CEO. The Committee does not formulaically set the target total compensation for our Named Executive Officers at the market target. In determining the appropriate target total compensation for each executive, the Committee reviews each individual separately and considers a variety of factors in establishing his or her target compensation. These factors may include the executive’s time in position, unique contribution or value to PBG, recent performance, and whether there is a particular need to strengthen the retention aspects of the executive’s compensation. For a senior executive recently promoted into a new position, his or her total compensation will often fall below the targeted third quartile. In such cases, the Committee may establish a multi-year plan to raise the executive’s total compensation to the market target and, during such time, the executive’s compensation increases will often be greater than those of other senior executives.
          In establishing the target total compensation for the Chairman and CEO, the Committee, together with the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, formally advises the Board on the annual individual performance of the Chairman and CEO and the Committee considers recommendations from its independent compensation consultant regarding his compensation. The Chairman and CEO is not involved in determining his compensation level and he is not present during the executive session during which the Committee evaluates the performance of the Chairman and CEO against pre-established qualitative and quantitative targets. The Committee, however, does request that the Chairman and CEO provide it with a self-evaluation of his performance against the pre-established targets prior to such executive session.

94


Table of Contents

          In establishing the target total compensation for Named Executive Officers other than the Chairman and CEO, the Committee, with the assistance of the Chairman and CEO and its independent compensation consultant, evaluates each executive’s performance and considers other individual factors such as those referenced above.
     Use of Tally Sheets. The Committee annually reviews a tally sheet of each Named Executive Officer’s PBG compensation. This tally sheet includes detailed data for each of the following compensation elements and includes a narrative description of the material terms of any relevant plan, program or award:
    Annual direct compensation: Information regarding base salary, annual incentive, and long-term incentive for the past three years;
 
    Equity awards: Detailed chart of information regarding all PBG equity-based awards, whether vested, unvested, exercised or unexercised, including total pre-tax value to the executive and holdings relative to the executive’s Stock Ownership Guidelines (discussed below);
 
    Perquisites: Line item summary showing the value of each perquisite as well as the value of the tax gross-up, if any;
 
    Pension / Deferred Compensation: Value of pension plan benefits (qualified plan, non-qualified plan and total) and value of defined-contribution plan accounts (401(k) and deferred compensation), including the year-over-year change in value in those accounts;
 
    Life Insurance Benefits (expressed as multiple of cash compensation as well as actual dollar value);
 
    Description of all compensation and benefits payable upon a termination of employment.
     The Committee reviews the information presented in the tally sheet to ensure that it is fully informed of all the compensation and benefits the executive has received as an employee of the Company. The Committee does not, however, specifically use the tally sheet or wealth accumulation analysis in determining the executive’s target compensation for a given year.
          Form of Equity-Based Compensation. Under our program, each executive annually receives an equity-based, long-term incentive award. Our shareholder-approved Amended and Restated 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the “LTIP”) authorizes the Committee to grant equity-based awards in various forms, including stock options, restricted stock, and RSUs. The Committee selects the form of equity award based on its determination as to which form most effectively achieves the objectives of our program. While the amount of the award varies based on the level of executive, the form of the annual award has historically been the same for all PBG executives regardless of level.
          The Committee periodically considers various forms of equity-based awards based on an analysis of market trends as well as their respective tax, accounting and share usage characteristics. The Committee has determined that a mix of forms is appropriate and that the annual long-term incentive award shall be in the form of 50% stock options and 50% RSUs (based on grant date fair value).
          The Committee believes this mix of forms is the most appropriate approach for the Company because of the balanced impact this mix has when viewed in light of several of the objectives of our executive compensation program, including motivating and retaining a high-performing executive population, aligning the interests of shareholders and executives, and creating a program that is financially appropriate for PBG and sensitive to the dilutive impact on shareholders.
          Equity Award Grant Practices. We have a consistent practice with respect to the granting of stock options and other equity-based awards, which the Committee established early in the Company’s history and which belies any concern regarding the timing or pricing of such awards, in particular stock options.
          Timing of Grants. Executives receive equity-based awards under three scenarios. First, all executives annually receive an award, which has always been comprised, entirely or in part, of stock options. Under the Company’s long-established practice, the Committee approves this annual award at its first meeting of the calendar year (around February 1) and establishes the grant date of the award as March 1. March 1 was selected because it aligns with several other PBG human resources processes for employees generally, including the end of the annual performance review process and the effective date of base salary increases.
          Second, individuals who become an executive of PBG for the first time within six months after the March 1 date are eligible for an equity award equal to 50% of the annual award. This pro-rated award is granted to all new executives on the same, fixed date of September 1.

95


Table of Contents

          Finally, senior executives may, on rare occasion, receive an additional equity-based award when they are first hired by PBG, when they are promoted to a new position, or when there is a special consideration related to an executive that the Committee seeks to address. In all cases of these awards, the grant date occurs after the award is approved.
          Pricing of Stock Options. Throughout the Company’s history, the exercise price of stock options has been equal to the fair market value of PBG common stock on the grant date. The Company has never backdated or repriced stock options. We define “Fair Market Value” in the LTIP as the average of the high and low sales prices of PBG common stock as recorded on the NYSE on the grant date, rounded up to the nearest penny. We believe our stock option pricing methodology is an accurate representation of the fair market value of PBG common stock on the grant date even though our methodology is different from that selected by the SEC (i.e., the closing price on the grant date).
What are some other policies and practices that govern the design and structure of our compensation program?
          Stock Ownership Guidelines. To achieve our program objective of aligning shareholder and executive interests, the Committee believes that our business leaders must have significant personal financial exposure to PBG common stock. The Committee, therefore, has established stock ownership guidelines for the Company’s key senior executives and directors. These guidelines are described in the section entitled “Security Ownership.”
          Trading Windows / Trading Plans / Hedging. We restrict the ability of certain employees to freely trade in PBG common stock because of their periodic access to material non-public information regarding PBG. Under our Insider Trading Policy, our key executives are permitted to purchase and sell PBG common stock and exercise PBG stock options only during limited quarterly trading windows. Our senior executives are generally required to conduct all stock sales and stock option exercises pursuant to written trading plans that are intended to satisfy the requirements of Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act. In addition, under our Worldwide Code of Conduct, all employees, including our Named Executive Officers, are prohibited from hedging against or speculating in the potential changes in the value of PBG common stock.
          Compensation Recovery for Misconduct. While we believe our executives conduct PBG business with the highest integrity and in full compliance with the PBG Worldwide Code of Conduct, the Committee believes it appropriate to ensure that the Company’s compensation plans and agreements provide for financial penalties to an executive who engages in fraudulent or other inappropriate conduct. Therefore, the Committee has included as a term of our equity-based awards that in the event the Committee determines that an executive has engaged in “Misconduct” (which is defined in the LTIP to include, among other things, a violation of our Code of Conduct), then all of the executive’s then outstanding equity-based awards shall be immediately forfeited and the Committee, in its discretion, may require the executive to repay to the Company all gains realized by the executive in connection with any PBG equity-based award (e.g., through option exercises or the vesting of RSUs) during the twelve-month period preceding the date the Misconduct occurred. This latter concept of repayment is commonly referred to as a “claw back” provision.
          Similarly, in the event of termination of employment for cause, the Company may cancel all or a portion of an executive’s annual cash incentive or require reimbursement from the executive to the extent such amount has been paid.
          As a majority of the compensation paid to an executive at the vice president level or higher is performance-based, the Committee believes our approach to compensation recovery through the LTIP and annual incentive is the most direct and appropriate for PBG.
          Employment / Severance Agreements. As a matter of policy and practice, the Company has not generally entered into any individual agreements with executives. However, during 2009 in response to the unsolicited acquisition offer from PepsiCo, the Company determined it advisable to enter into retention agreements with the each of the Named Executive Officers (the “Retention Agreements”) in order to insure stability in management given the inherent uncertainty created by the PepsiCo offer. With respect to our Chairman and CEO and other Named Executive Officers, the value of benefits provided for under the Retention Agreements is summarized in the Narrative and accompanying tables entitled Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change In Control.
          Approved Transfers To / From PepsiCo. In the past, we have maintained a policy intended to facilitate the transfer of employees between PBG and PepsiCo. The two companies would, on a limited and mutually agreed basis, exchange employees who are considered necessary or useful to the other’s business (“Approved Transfers”). Certain of our benefit and compensation programs (as well as PepsiCo’s) were designed to prevent an Approved Transfer’s loss of compensation and benefits that would otherwise occur upon termination of his or her employment from the transferring company. For example, at the receiving company, Approved Transfers would receive pension plan service credit for all years of service with the transferring company. Also, upon transfer, Approved Transfers would generally vest in their transferring company equity awards rather than forfeit them as would otherwise be the case upon a termination of employment. The two companies have suspended this policy pending completion of the proposed merger.

96


Table of Contents

          One of our Named Executive Officers, Mr. Drewes was an Approved Transfer from PepsiCo. As discussed in the footnotes to the Pension Benefits Table, Mr. Drewes will be eligible for pension benefits attributable to his service both at PepsiCo prior to transfer and at the Company.
          Change in Control Protections. Until May 2009, the only change-in-control protection we provided to our senior executives through our executive compensation program was through the terms of our LTIP, which provides for accelerated vesting of all outstanding, unvested equity-based awards at the time of a change in control of PBG by any party other than PepsiCo. This was considered adequate given PepsiCo’s substantial voting power of PBG common stock and other contractual rights which effectively precluded an acquisition of PBG without PepsiCo’s consent.
          However, in response to the unsolicited PepsiCo offer to acquire all of the outstanding shares of the Company’s common stock not owned by PepsiCo (the “Proposal”), the Company determined that it was essential to the best interests of the Company and its shareholders to insure that the distraction for our Named Executive Officers inherent in the Proposal was minimized. Therefore, in May 2009, the Committee approved Retention Agreements for each of the Named Executive Officers. The change-in-control protections afforded each of the Named Executive Officers under the terms and conditions of the Retention Agreements were considered necessary in order to insure the stability of management and the continued success of the Company.
          With respect to our Chairman and CEO and other Named Executive Officers, the events that constitute a change in control and the value of change in control benefits provided under the Retention Agreements are summarized in the Narrative and accompanying table entitled Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change In Control. An overview of the terms and conditions of the Retention Agreements is provided below in the section describing the compensation actions taken in 2009. The Company does not gross-up any executive for potential excise taxes that may be incurred in connection with a change in control.
          Deductibility of Compensation Expenses. Pursuant to Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”) (“Section 162(m)”), certain compensation paid to the Chairman and CEO and other Named Executive Officers in excess of $1 million is not tax deductible, except to the extent such excess compensation is performance-based. The Committee has and will continue to carefully consider the impact of Section 162(m) when establishing the target compensation for executive officers. For 2009, we believe that substantially all of the compensation paid to our executive officers satisfies the requirements for deductibility under Section 162(m).
          As one of our primary program objectives, however, the Committee seeks to design our executive compensation program in a manner that furthers the best interests of the Company and its shareholders. In certain cases, the Committee may determine that the amount of tax deductions lost is insignificant when compared to the potential opportunity a compensation program provides for creating shareholder value. The Committee, therefore, retains the ability to pay appropriate compensation to our executive officers, even though such compensation is non-deductible.
What compensation actions were taken in 2009 and why were they taken?
          In February 2009, in response to the challenging worldwide economic conditions, the Committee determined that the total target compensation for each Named Executive Officer would not increase from 2008 levels. Specifically, the Committee determined to freeze salaries at 2008 levels and determined that there would be no change to the bonus target or the annual equity award value for any of the Named Executive Officers.
          The 2009 target total compensation for each of the Named Executive Officers did not exceed the market target based on the data considered by the Committee in February 2009 with the exception of the target total compensation for Messrs. Petrides and Crawford whose target total compensation exceeded market target, largely as a result of allocating one-fourth of the value of the Strategic Leadership Award to 2009 target total compensation. In addition, the target total compensation for Mr. Crawford exceeded the market target as a result of the importance placed by the Committee on Mr. Crawford’s operational contributions to PBG.
          Base Salary. As noted above, the Committee determined to freeze salaries at 2008 levels for each of the Named Executive Officers.
          Annual Cash Incentive Award. In February 2009, the Committee established the 2009 annual incentive targets for our executives at 2008 target levels with a potential payout range from 0 to 200% of the executive’s target.
          Actual Annual Cash Incentive Awards. In February 2010, the Committee determined that for purposes of the 2005 Executive Incentive Compensation Plan (“EICP”), the Company’s 2009 comparable EPS performance of $2.44, which was in excess of the $1.75 target, resulted in a maximum bonus of $5 million payable to each Named Executive Officer under Section 162(m). The Committee then reviewed the Company’s 2009 performance against the pre-established EPS/NOPBT, net revenue and operating free cash flow targets which the Committee uses to guide its negative discretion in determining the actual bonus payable to each senior executive.

97


Table of Contents

          Ø   Financial Performance Targets and Results. The overall achievement of financial targets is used to determine 80% of the actual bonus payout, with each measure separately weighted. In March 2009, the Committee approved a change to the financial targets of Messrs. Foss, Drewes and Crawford to include net revenue (expressed in local currency) instead of volume. Each financial measure for Messrs Foss, Drewes, and Crawford, was worldwide in scope and each target was consistent with the Company’s external guidance at the start of 2009.
                         
Worldwide Measure   Weighting   Target   Actual Result
EPS (for purposes of the EICP)
    40 %   $ 2.21     $ 2.44  
Net Revenue v. Prior Year (in local currency)
    20 %   3%   1%
Operating Free Cash Flow
    20 %   $450 million   $578 million
          In March 2009, the Committee also approved a change to the financial targets for our operating executives, Messrs. King and Petrides, in order to reinforce performance priorities and more accurately reflect each executive’s geographic scope of responsibility relative to profit performance. The worldwide operating free cash flow target for Messrs. King and Petrides remained consistent with the other Named Executive Officers.
          The Committee established net revenue and NOPBT targets and financial measures specific to Europe and North America for Messrs. Petrides and King, respectively. Each country under Mr. Petrides’ direction (Spain, Russia, Greece and Turkey) had separate targets for each measure with net revenue and NOPBT expressed in local currency and that were tied to designated financial objectives for the particular country. Mr. Petrides’ performance targets were established based on the weighted average of the targets for each of the four countries with weighting based on the volume of each country in proportion to overall volume for Europe.
                         
Europe Segment Measure   Weighting   Target   Actual Result
NOPBT Growth v. Prior Year (in local currency on a comparable basis)
    40 %     (13.8 %)     2.4 %
Net Revenue v. Prior Year (in local currency)
    20 %     7.1 %     (1.5 )%
Worldwide Operating Free Cash Flow
    20 %   $450 million   $578 million
          Each country under Mr. King’s’ direction (the United States, Canada and Mexico) had net revenue and NOPBT targets with net revenue and NOPBT expressed in local currency that were tied to designated financial objectives for the particular country. Mr. King’s performance targets were established based on the weighted average of the targets for each of the three countries with weighting based on the volume of each country in proportion to overall volume for North America.
                         
North America Segment Measure   Weighting   Target   Actual Result
NOPBT Growth v. Prior Year (in local currency on a comparable basis)
    40 %     (3.4 %)     (0.5 )%
Net Revenue v. Prior Year (in local currency)
    20 %     4.2 %     1.1 %
Worldwide Operating Free Cash Flow
    20 %   $450 million   $578 million
          At its meeting in February 2010, the Committee certified the Actual Results shown in the tables above. The Committee determined that the Company’s performance against the worldwide measures resulted in a financial target bonus score of 154% for Messrs. Foss, Drewes and Crawford. The Committee also determined that the Company’s performance against the Europe and North America segment measures resulted in a financial target bonus score of 163% for Mr. Petrides and 135% for Mr. King. Following this determination, the Committee reviewed and discussed the Company’s overall operating performance during 2009. The Committee noted the Company’s year-over-year performance, in particular comparable EPS and operating profit growth, which the Company achieved despite the economic downturn and adverse market conditions.
          Ø   Non-Financial Performance Targets and Results. The overall achievement of individual non-financial targets is used to determine 20% of the actual bonus payout. The Committee reviewed and concurred in the assessment of the Chairman and CEO with respect to the performance of the other Named Executive Officers against the non-financial goals. The goals varied by Named Executive Officer and were similar to the qualitative measures used by the Committee to evaluate the performance of the Chairman and CEO, including progress on the diversity front and performance of the Company in light of the PepsiCo acquisition proposal. The Committee determined that the performance of the other Named Executive Officers against the non-financial goals resulted in non-financial bonus scores ranging from 137% to 162%.
          The Committee then determined that Mr. Foss had performed well against his pre-established non-financial measures. In particular, the Committee noted that Mr. Foss had been successful in executing an effective global pricing strategy and achieving substantial cost and productivity savings. The Committee also noted that during 2009, Mr. Foss was once again successful in further strengthening organization capability through greater employee engagement and improved executive representation of minorities. Finally, the Committee noted Mr. Foss’ performance in response to the PepsiCo acquisition proposal. The Committee determined that a non-financial bonus score of 175% based on Mr. Foss’ performance against the non-financial measures was appropriate for Mr. Foss.

98


Table of Contents

          For 2009, the annual incentive targets and actual payout amounts for each of the Named Executive Officers were as follows:
                                 
    2009 Annual Cash Incentive Awards
    Target           2009 Award    
Named Executive Officer   (% of Salary)   Target ($)   (% of Target)   2009 Award ($)
Eric J. Foss
    150 %     1,500,000       158 %     2,370,000  
Alfred H. Drewes
    85 %     408,000       153 %     625,870  
Yiannis Petrides
    85 %     590,273       159 %     937,353  
Robert C. King
    100 %     525,000       135 %     708,750  
Victor L. Crawford
    85 %     361,250       155 %     561,390  
          The Committee believes the 2009 actual awards reflected the Company’s overall operating performance in 2009 and each individual’s contribution to such performance and were consistent with its policy to link pay to performance.
          Long-Term Incentive. As noted above, the Committee determined that there would be no change to the annual equity award value for any of the Named Executive Officers during 2009. In February 2009, the Committee also reviewed the design of the annual long-term incentive program, noting at that time that all outstanding stock options held by the Named Executive Officers were “out-of-the-money”. The Committee determined that the design remained consistent with the primary objectives of attracting, retaining and motivating a talented and diverse group of executives and concluded that no design change was appropriate at this time.
          All of the 2009 stock option and RSU awards to our Named Executive Officers are reflected in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table and their terms and conditions are set out in the Narrative to the Summary Compensation Table and Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table.
          2008 Strategic Leadership Awards. The Committee previously approved the Strategic Leadership Award, a special, one-time performance-based RSU award (the “SLA RSUs”) for each of the Named Executive Officers other than the Chairman and CEO. The Committee awarded Messrs. Drewes, King, Petrides and Crawford, the SLA RSUs in order to emphasize the linkage between long-term compensation and the Company’s strategic imperatives and to reinforce continuity within the Company’s senior leadership team over the next four years.
          The Committee established the target value of each executive’s SLA RSUs at either $1,000,000 or $1,500,000 based on the executive’s scope of responsibilities and contribution to the Company. The Committee made vesting of the SLA RSUs contingent upon the Company’s achievement of 2008 and 2009 comparable EPS performance targets of at least $0.75 in each year as well as the executive’s continued employment with the Company through the end of 2011. In February 2009, the Committee certified that the 2008 EPS performance target was met and in February 2010, the Committee certified that the 2009 EPS performance target was met. Under the terms of the award, each executive is eligible to receive RSUs with a value up to 150% of his target value, with the final value of the award determined by the Committee at the beginning of 2010. The threshold, target and maximum values for each Named Executive Officer are set forth in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table for Fiscal Year 2008 set forth in last year’s proxy.
          The performance criteria for 2008 and 2009 were: (i) increased distribution and market share of specified products within the Company’s brand portfolio; (ii) improved customer satisfaction, as measured by an external survey, and execution at point of sale; (iii) year-over-year improvement in the cost of making our products, including bottler consolidation (i.e., operational efficiency) and improved operational and strategic synergies with PepsiCo; and (iv) year-over-year improvement in the Company’s internal employee satisfaction survey, employee diversity and management retention. For Messrs. King and Petrides, the performance goals related to items (i) and (ii) were tailored to the geographic business segments they oversee, respectively.
          The specific target levels for each of the above referenced criteria have not been externally communicated and involve confidential, commercial information, disclosure of which could result in competitive harm to the Company. The targets for each criteria were set at levels intended to incent the achievement of both short-term and long-term growth in these key strategic areas. To achieve target performance, the executive team must drive broad-based effort and contribution from the geographical and functional teams throughout the Company. The targets, individually and together, are designed to be challenging to attain and achievement of the targets requires performance beyond our normal operating plan expectations for each year of the performance period.
          The final value was determined by the Committee in February 2010 based on its own evaluation as well as the Chairman and CEO’s assessment of the Company’s performance in 2008 and 2009 against the performance criteria established for each of 2008 and 2009. The Committee determined that SLA RSUs were payable at the individual target level for each of the executives as reported in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table for Fiscal Year 2008 set forth in last year’s proxy. The terms of the SLA RSUs provide an additional service vesting condition. However, notwithstanding the service vesting condition, the SLA RSUs will vest and become immediately payable in the event the Named Executive Officer is involuntarily terminated prior to the end of the vesting period within a two year period following a Change in Control, including the merger with PepsiCo.

99


Table of Contents

          Annual Equity Award. The Committee approved the 2009 long-term incentive awards, at 2008 levels, for each of our Named Executive Officers and reviewed comparative market data for total compensation, including data related to what portion of total compensation was paid in the form of long-term incentive. The Committee also considered each executive’s role and level of responsibility within the Company. Mr. Foss received a long-term equity incentive award with a present value of approximately $5,000,000. The Committee determined this award was appropriate in light of his position and responsibilities and as measured against the targeted third quartile of total compensation of CEOs within the peer group. Mr. King was granted a long-term equity incentive award with a present value of approximately $1,200,000 and Messrs. Drewes, Petrides and Crawford received a long-term equity incentive award with a present value of approximately $1,000,000. The value of the awards for Messrs. King and Crawford reflect promotional increases approved by the Committee in November 2008. These awards included the same terms and conditions as the awards to all other executives, except that consistent with its practice, the Committee made the vesting of the RSU award granted to our Named Executive Officers subject to the achievement of a 2009 comparable EPS performance target of $0.75. In February 2010, the Committee determined that the 2009 EPS target had been satisfied, such that each Named Executive Officer will vest in his annual 2009 RSU award if he remains employed by the Company through March 1, 2012, subject to the accelerated vesting provisions under the Retention Agreements, as described below.
          Retention Agreements. In May 2009, the Committee conducted an extensive review of the risk that the PepsiCo Proposal or a similar proposal might lead to the distraction and departure of the Company’s executive officers to the detriment of the Company and its shareholders. The Committee reviewed the existing, limited change in control protections for the Named Executive Officers as well as data and recommendations from its independent compensation consultant and management of the Company. The Committee determined that it was in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders to provide the Named Executive Officers with additional double-trigger change-in-control protections in order to insure the stability of management and the continued success of the business. Consequently, the Committee approved the form of Retention Agreement for each of the Named Executive Officers which was filed with the SEC on May 4, 2009. The overview of the terms and conditions of the Retention Agreements that follows is qualified in its entirety by the full text of the form of Retention Agreement filed with the SEC.
          Each Named Executive Officer will be entitled to certain severance payments and benefits if his employment is terminated under certain circumstances. The Named Executive Officer is entitled to those severance payments and benefits if, during the two-year period after a change in control, the executive is terminated without cause or resigns for good reason (which includes a material reduction in the executive’s authority, duties, titles or responsibilities, reduction in annual base salary, material reduction in target bonus, material reduction in employee benefits in the aggregate and a change in primary work location to a location 35 or more miles from the executive’s primary work location immediately prior to a change in control). If terminated or separated from the Company under those circumstances, the Named Executive Officer is entitled to the following severance payments and benefits under the Retention Agreement: (i) a lump-sum cash severance payment equal to two times the sum of (a) the executive’s base salary in effect on the date of termination and (b) the target annual bonus for the year of termination; (ii) a prorated target annual bonus for the year of termination; (iii) reimbursement for the cost of continued medical, dental and vision coverage for up to 24 months; (iv) the accelerated vesting or settlement, as applicable, of all outstanding equity-based, equity-related and other long-term incentive awards; (v) reimbursement up to $50,000 for the cost of outplacement services; and (vi) early retirement benefits (consisting of a lump-sum cash payment based on standard early retirement benefit formulas under the Company’s retirement plans, as well as retiree medical coverage and retiree life insurance coverage), provided that the executive has been credited with at least 10 years of service and has attained an age of at least 50 at the time of the executive’s termination of employment.
          In order to obtain severance benefits under a Retention Agreement, each Named Executive Officer must first execute a separation agreement with the Company that includes a waiver and release of any and all claims against the Company. The Retention Agreements also provide that, for two years following termination, the executive will not compete with the Company, solicit or hire any employee of the Company or its affiliates, solicit any customer or prospective customer of the Company and its affiliates or interfere with any relationship between the Company and its customers or prospective customers.
          The payments and benefits under the Retention Agreements are subject to reduction so that each Named Executive Officer will receive the greatest after-tax benefit after taking into account any taxes that may be imposed in connection with payments relating to the termination of such executive’s employment. The Retention Agreements do not, however, include any gross-up for such taxes.
          The events that constitute a change in control within the meaning of the Retention Agreements and the value of the change in control benefits are summarized in the Narrative and accompanying tables entitled Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.
What noteworthy executive compensation actions took place during the first quarter of 2010 and why were such actions taken?
          In February 2010, the Committee determined not to approve annual equity awards to executives, including the Named Executive Officers, given the pending closing of the merger with PepsiCo.

100


Table of Contents

2009 Summary Compensation Table
                                                                 
                                            Change in        
                                    Non-   Pension Value        
                                    Equity   and        
                                    Incentive   Nonqualified        
                                    Plan   Deferred        
                    Stock   Option   Compen-   Compensation   All Other    
Name and Principal           Salary   Awards   Awards   sation   Earnings   Compensation   Total
Position   Year   ($)   ($)(1)   ($)(1)   ($)   ($)(2)(3)   ($)(4)   ($)
Eric J. Foss
    2009       1,000,000       2,937,062       2,537,036       2,370,000       920,000       226,750 (5)     9,990,848  
Chairman of the Board
    2008       984,615       2,383,547       1,934,908       840,000       1,166,000       191,748       7,500,818  
and Chief Executive Officer
    2007       892,308       1,584,557       1,893,158       1,805,580       594,000       66,680       6,836,283  
 
                                                               
Alfred H. Drewes
    2009       480,000       872,064       357,652       625,870       343,000       57,250 (6)     2,735,836  
Senior Vice President
    2008       476,154       841,694       444,431       204,000       505,000       50,669       2,521,948  
and Chief Financial Officer
    2007       451,154       304,747       664,901       551,120       222,000       81,884       2,275,806  
 
                                                               
Yiannis Petrides(7)
    2009       717,943       1,270,749       357,652       937,353       465,000       96,807 (8)     3,845,504  
President, PBG Europe
    2008       754,990       1,240,379       453,576       582,176       613,000       90,188       3,734,309  
 
    2007       676,872       703,432       708,897       819,905       234,000       105,740       3,248,846  
 
                                                               
Robert C. King
    2009       525,000       893,781       372,211       708,750       293,000       65,586 (9)     2,858,328  
Executive Vice President
    2008       466,923       808,489       373,483       252,660       309,000       48,631       2,259,186  
and President, PBG
    2007       418,846       271,542       426,551       514,780       146,000       45,157       1,822,876  
North America
                                                               
 
                                                               
Victor L. Crawford
    2009       425,000       668,819       300,046       561,390       12,000       60,678 (10)     2,027,933  
Senior Vice President of
    2008       402,481       1,396,199       257,566       195,500       47,000       174,833       2,473,579  
Global Operations and
    2007                                            
System Transformation
                                                               
 
1.   The amount included in this column is the compensation cost recognized by the Company in fiscal year 2009 related to the executive’s outstanding equity awards that were unvested for all or any part of 2009, calculated in accordance with the Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123R, Share-Based Payment (revised) (“SFAS 123R”) without regard to forfeiture estimates. This amount encompasses equity awards that were granted in 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 and 2009 and was determined using the assumptions set forth in Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K (for 2009, 2008 and 2007 awards), Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 27, 2008 (for 2006 awards) and Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 29, 2007 (for 2005 awards).
 
2.   No executive earned above-market or preferential earnings on deferred compensation in 2009 and, therefore, no such earnings are reported in this column. Consequently, this amount reflects only the aggregate change in 2009 in the actuarial present value of the executive’s accumulated benefit under all Company-sponsored defined benefit pension plans in which the executive participates. The executive participates in such plans on the same terms as all other eligible employees.
 
3.   This amount was calculated based on the material assumptions set forth in Note 11, Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K and Note 12, Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans, to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 27, 2008, except for the generally applicable assumptions regarding retirement age and pre-retirement mortality.
 
4.   The amount in this column reflects the actual cost of perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to each of the Named Executive Officers, reimbursements paid by the Company to the executive for his tax liability related to certain of these Company provided benefits, the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of the executive and as applicable, a standard 401(k) Company matching contribution and Company retirement contribution, each on the same terms and conditions as all other eligible employees. The particular benefits provided to each Named Executive Officer are described below in footnotes 5, 6, 8, 9 and 10. In addition, the Company purchases club memberships, season tickets and passes to various sporting events and other venues for purposes of business entertainment. On limited occasions, employees (including one or more of the Named Executive Officers) may use such memberships, tickets or passes for personal use. There is no incremental cost to the Company in such circumstances. Therefore, no cost of such memberships, tickets and passes is reflected in the “All Other Compensation” column.

101


Table of Contents

5.   This amount includes $191,561, which equals the total cost of all perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to Mr. Foss, including an annual physical and travel expenses related to the annual physical, a car allowance, financial advisory services, personal use of corporate transportation and nominal recognition awards. The value of Mr. Foss’ personal use of the Company-leased aircraft is $142,036 and represents the aggregate incremental cost to the Company. For this purpose, the Company has calculated the aggregate incremental cost based on the actual variable operating costs that were incurred as a result of Mr. Foss’ use of the aircraft, which includes an hourly occupied rate, fuel rate and other flight specific fees. Mr. Foss is responsible for all taxes associated with any personal use of corporate transportation.
 
    The amount shown in the above table also includes: (i) $21,532, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Mr. Foss for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits, including his car allowance, financial advisory services and nominal recognition awards; (ii) a standard Company matching contribution of $9,577 to Mr. Foss’ 401(k) account; and (iii) $4,080, which represents the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of Mr. Foss.
 
6.   This amount includes: (i) $32,341, which equals the total cost of all perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to Mr. Drewes, including an annual physical and travel expenses related to the annual physical, a car allowance, and financial advisory services; (ii) $13,038, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Mr. Drewes for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits, including his annual physical, car allowance and financial advisory services; (iii) a standard Company matching contribution of $9,800 to Mr. Drewes’ 401(k) account; and (iv) $2,071, which represents the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of Mr. Drewes.
 
7.   Mr. Petrides’ salary, non-equity incentive plan compensation and compensation indicated in the “All Other Compensation” column are paid in Euros. The values stated are in U.S. dollars and are based on the average exchange rate of Euros to one U.S. dollar for the years shown. The average exchange rate of one U.S. dollar to Euros was 0.72 in 2009.
 
8.   This amount includes: (i) $74,841, which equals the total cost of all perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to Mr. Petrides, including a company car and related car expenses, housing allowances, tax advisory services and financial advisory services. The following perquisite and personal benefit provided by the Company to Mr. Petrides met or exceeded the threshold for individual quantification and is as follows: $41,091 which equals the cost of providing a company car to Mr. Petrides and related car expenses. The total amount shown in the table above also includes (i) $20,695, which equals all tax reimbursements payable to Mr. Petrides for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits, including his financial advisory services and a portion of his housing allowances; and (iii) $1,271, which represents the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of Mr. Petrides.
 
9.   This amount includes: (i) $36,025, which equals the total cost of all perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to Mr. King, including a car allowance, financial advisory services and a twenty year service anniversary gift; (ii) $17,801, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Mr. King for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits, including his car allowance, financial advisory services and a twenty year service anniversary gift; (iii) a standard Company matching contribution of $9,800 to Mr. King’s 401(k) account; and (iv) $1,960, which represents the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of Mr. King.
 
10.   This amount includes: (i) $26,025, which equals the total cost of all perquisites and personal benefits provided by the Company to Mr. Crawford, including a car allowance and financial advisory services; (ii) $13,412, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Mr. Crawford for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits, including his car allowance and financial advisory services; (iii) $1,633, which represents the dollar value of life insurance premiums paid by the Company for the benefit of Mr. Crawford; (iv) a standard Company matching contribution of $9,800 to Mr. Crawford’s 401(k) account; (v) a standard Company retirement contribution of $7,350 to Mr. Crawford’s 401(k) account; and (vi) a Company retirement contribution of $2,458 to Mr. Crawford’s Supplemental Savings Program account. The Company retirement contribution is available on the same terms and conditions to all employees who as of April 2009 are no longer eligible to accrue a benefit under the Company’s defined benefit pension plans.

102


Table of Contents

Grants of Plan-Based Awards In Fiscal Year 2009
                                                                                                   
                                                                      All Other                  
                                                                      Option                  
                                                                      Awards:                  
                                                                      Number                   Grant
                                              Estimated Future Payouts Under   of   Exercise   Closing   Date Fair
                    Estimated Possible Payouts Under     Equity Incentive Plan   Securities   or Base   Market   Value of
                    Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards(1)
 
  Awards(2)(3)   Under-   Price of   Price on   Stock and
            Date of   Thres-                     Thres-                   lying   Option   Grant   Option
    Grant   Board   hold   Target   Maximum     hold   Target   Maximum   Options   Awards   Date   Awards
Name   Date   Action   ($)   ($)   ($)     (#)   (#)   (#)   (#)   ($/Sh)   ($)(3)   ($)(4)
Eric J. Foss
                                                                                                 
Non-Equity
                0       1,500,000       3,000,000                                                            
RSUs
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                         133,548                                       2,500,019  
Options
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                                         400,642       18.72       18.50       1,786,863  
 
                                                                                                 
Alfred H. Drewes
   
                                                                                         
Non-Equity
                0       408,000       816,000                                                            
RSUs
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                         26,710                                       500,011  
Options
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                                         80,129       18.72       18.50       357,375  
 
                                                                                                 
Yiannis Petrides
   
                                                                                         
Non-Equity
                0       590,273       1,180,545                                                            
RSUs
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                         26,710                                       500,011  
Options
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                                         80,129       18.72       18.50       357,375  
 
                                                                                                 
Robert C. King
   
                                                                                           
Non-Equity
                0       525,000       1,050,000                                                            
RSUs
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                         32,052                                       600,013  
Options
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                                         96,154       18.72       18.50       428,847  
 
                                                                                                 
Victor L. Crawford
 
                                                                                         
Non-Equity
                0       361,250       722,500                                                            
RSUs
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                         26,710                                       500,011  
Options
    03/01/2009       02/06/2009                                                         80,129       18.72       18.50       357,375  
 
1.   Amounts shown reflect the threshold, target and maximum payout amounts under the Company’s annual incentive program which is administered under the shareholder-approved EICP. The target amount is equal to a percentage of each executive’s salary, which for 2009 ranged from 85% to 150%, depending on the executive’s role and level of responsibility. The maximum amount equals 200% of the target amount. The actual payout amount is contingent upon achievement of certain financial and non-financial performance goals. Please refer to the narrative below for more detail regarding each executive’s target amount, the specific performance criteria used to determine the actual payout and how such payout is typically the result of the Committee’s exercise of negative discretion with respect to separate maximum payout amounts established for purposes of Section 162(m).
 
2.   The 2009 stock option awards and RSU awards were made under the LTIP, which was approved by shareholders in 2008.
 
3.   The closing market price was the closing price on February 27, 2009, the last trading day immediately preceding the grant date of March 1, 2009.
 
4.   The assumptions used in calculating the SFAS 123R grant date fair value of the option awards and stock awards are set forth in Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Narrative to the Summary Compensation Table and Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
          Salary. The 2009 annual salary of each Named Executive Officer is set forth in the “Salary” column of the Summary Compensation Table. Compensation levels for each of the Named Executive Officers are at the discretion of the Committee. A salary increase or decrease for a Named Executive Officer may be approved by the Committee at any time in the Committee’s sole discretion. Typically, the Committee considers salary increases for each of the Named Executive Officers based on considerations such as the performance of the Company and the executive, any increase in the executive’s responsibilities and the executive’s salary level relative to similarly situated executives at peer group companies. The Committee did not approve any salary increases for Named Executive Officers in 2009.

103


Table of Contents

          Stock Awards. Awards of RSUs are made under the LTIP at the discretion of the Committee. The annual RSU awards were approved by the Committee in February 2009, with a grant date of March 1, 2009, to all executives of the Company, including the Named Executive Officers. The number of RSUs awarded was determined based on an award value established by the Committee for each executive. The actual number of RSUs awarded was calculated by dividing the respective award value by the “Fair Market Value” of a share of PBG common stock on the grant date, rounded up to the next whole share. The LTIP defines Fair Market Value as the average of the high and low sales price for PBG common stock as reported on the NYSE on the grant date.
          Vesting of the annual RSUs awarded to the Named Executive Officers in 2009 was made subject to the achievement of a pre-established 2009 EPS performance goal as well as continued employment for three years. In February 2010, the Committee determined that this EPS goal was met. Thus, the RSUs will fully vest after three years provided the Named Executive Officer remains continuously employed through the third anniversary of the grant date. Notwithstanding the terms of the 2009 RSU awards, under the terms of the Retention Agreements, the 2009 RSUs will become payable in the event the Named Executive Officer is involuntarily terminated within the meaning of the Retention Agreements within two years after a Change in Control, which includes the merger with PepsiCo, as more fully discussed in the Narrative and accompanying tables entitled Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change In Control.
          All RSUs are credited with dividend equivalents in the form of additional RSUs at the same time and in the same amount as dividends are paid to shareholders of the Company. If the underlying RSUs do not vest, no dividend equivalents are paid. RSUs are paid out in shares of PBG common stock upon vesting. Vesting of the RSUs in the event of death, disability, or retirement is the same as described below for stock options; provided, however, that accelerated vesting in the case of retirement is subject to satisfaction of any performance-based condition. RSUs and shares received upon certain prior payouts of RSUs are subject to forfeiture in the event an executive engages in Misconduct.
          Option Awards. Stock option awards are made under the LTIP at the discretion of the Committee. The annual stock option awards were approved by the Committee in February 2009, with a grant date of March 1, 2009, to all executives of the Company, including the Named Executive Officers. The exercise price was equal to the Fair Market Value of a share of PBG common stock on the grant date, rounded to the nearest penny. The stock options have a term of ten years and no dividends or dividend rights are payable with respect to the stock options. The 2009 stock option awards for all executives, including the Named Executive Officers, become exercisable in one-third increments, on the first, second and third anniversary of the grant date provided the executive is actively employed on each such date. Notwithstanding the terms of the 2009 stock option awards, the 2009 stock options will automatically vest under the terms of the Retention Agreements in the event the Named Executive Officer is involuntarily terminated within the meaning of the Retention Agreements within two years after a Change in Control, which includes the merger with PepsiCo, as more fully discussed in the Narrative and accompanying tables entitled Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change In Control.
          Vesting is also accelerated in the event of death, disability, or retirement. In the event of death, unvested stock options fully vest immediately. In the event of retirement or disability, unvested stock options immediately vest in proportion to the number of months of active employment during the vesting period over the total number of months in such period. In the event of death, disability, or retirement, the vested options remain exercisable for their original ten-year term. Stock option awards, including certain gains on previously exercised stock options, are subject to forfeiture in the event an executive engages in Misconduct.
          Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation. The 2009 annual, performance-based cash bonuses paid to the Named Executive Officers are shown in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table and the threshold, target and maximum bonus amounts payable to each Named Executive Officer are shown in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table. These award amounts were approved by the Compensation Committee and were paid under the EICP, which was approved by shareholders in 2005 in order to ensure that PBG may recognize a tax deduction with respect to such awards under Section 162(m) of the Code. The threshold, target and maximum payout amounts are shown in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table under the heading “Estimated Possible Payouts Under Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards.” The pre-established performance criteria, actual performance and each Named Executive Officer’s target and actual payout amounts are discussed in detail in the CD&A.
          Change in Pension Value and Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Earnings. The material terms of the pension plans governing the pension benefits provided to the Named Executive Officers are more fully discussed in the Narrative accompanying the Pension Benefits Table. The material terms of the non-qualified elective and non-elective deferred compensation plans are more fully discussed in the Narrative accompanying the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table.
          All Other Compensation. The perquisites, tax reimbursements and all other compensation paid to or on behalf of the Named Executive Officers during 2009 are described fully in the footnotes to the Summary Compensation Table.
          Proportion of Salary to Total Compensation. As noted in the CD&A, we believe that the total compensation of our business leaders should be closely tied to the performance of the Company. Therefore, the percentage of total compensation that is fixed

104


Table of Contents

generally decreases as the scope of the executive’s responsibilities increases. This is reflected in the ratio of salary in proportion to total compensation for each Named Executive Officer. In 2009, Mr. Foss’ ratio of salary in proportion to total compensation shown in the Summary Compensation Table was 10%, and the ratio for Messrs. Drewes, Petrides, King and Crawford was approximately: 18%, 19%, 18% and 21%, respectively.
Outstanding Equity Awards At 2009 Fiscal Year-End
                                                                                   
    Option Awards     Stock Awards
                                                                              Equity
                                                                              Incentive
                                                                      Equity   Plan
                                                                      Incentive   Awards:
                                                              Market   Plan   Market or
                                                              Value of   Awards:   Payout
                                                              Shares   Number of   Value of
                                                              or Units   Unearned   Unearned
            Number of   Number of                             Number of   of   Shares,   Shares,
            Securities   Securities                             Shares or   Stock   Units or   Units or
            Underlying   Underlying                             Units of   That   Other   Other
            Unexercised   Unexercised   Option                     Stock That   Have   Rights That   Rights That
    Stock   Options   Options   Exercise   Option             Have   Not   Have Not   Have Not
    Option   (#)   (#)   Price   Expiration     Stock Award   Not Vested   Vested   Vested   Vested
Name   Grant Date   Exercisable   Unexercisable   ($)   Date     Grant Date   (#)   ($)(25)   (#)   ($)(25)
Eric J. Foss
    03/01/2004 (1)     182,373       0       29.50       03/29/2014         10/07/2005 (9)     125,718       4,721,968                  
 
    03/01/2005 (2)     212,389       0       28.25       02/28/2015         03/01/2007 (10)     68,581 (14)     2,575,902                  
 
    03/01/2006 (3)     102,319       0       29.32       02/29/2016         03/01/2008 (11)     75,894 (15)     2,850,579                  
 
    07/24/2006 (4)     0       200,000       33.77       07/23/2016         03/01/2009 (12)     135,958 (16)     5,106,582                  
 
    03/01/2007 (5)     128,363       66,127       30.85       02/28/2017                                            
 
    03/01/2008 (6)     72,094       146,374       34.33       02/28/2018                                            
 
    10/02/2008 (7)     0       400,000       28.90       10/01/2018                                            
 
    03/01/2009 (8)     0       400,642       18.72       02/28/2019                                            
 
                                                                                 
Alfred H. Drewes
    03/01/2007 (5)     0       16,532       30.85       02/28/2017         03/01/2007 (10)     17,146 (17)     644,004                  
 
    03/01/2008 (6)     0       29,275       34.33       02/28/2018         01/01/2008 (13)                     39,358 (23)     1,478,286  
 
    03/01/2009 (8)     0       80,129       18.72       02/28/2019         03/01/2008 (11)     15,179 (18)     570,123                  
 
                                              03/01/2009 (12)     27,192 (19)     1,021,332                  
 
                                                                                 
Yiannis Petrides
    03/01/2005 (2)     518       0       28.25       02/28/2015         10/07/2005 (9)     71,839       2,698,273                  
 
    03/01/2006 (3)     51,160       0       29.32       02/29/2016         03/01/2007 (10)     17,146 (17)     644,004                  
 
    03/01/2007 (5)     32,091       16,532       30.85       02/28/2017         01/01/2008 (13)                     39,358 (23)     1,478,286  
 
    03/01/2008 (6)     14,419       29,275       34.33       02/28/2018         03/01/2008 (11)     15,179 (18)     570,123                  
 
    03/01/2009 (8)     0       80,129       18.72       02/28/2019         03/01/2009 (12)     27,192 (19)     1,021,332                  
 
                                                                                 
Robert C. King
    03/01/2007 (5)     0       16,532       30.85       02/28/2017         03/01/2007 (10)     17,146 (17)     644,004                  
 
    03/01/2008 (6)     0       29,275       34.33       02/28/2018         01/01/2008 (13)                     39,358 (23)     1,478,286  
 
    03/01/2009 (8)     0       96,154       18.72       02/28/2019         03/01/2008 (11)     15,179 (18)     570,123                  
 
                                              03/01/2009 (12)     32,630 (20)     1,225,583                  
 
                                                                                 
Victor L. Crawford
    03/01/2006 (3)     29,417       0       29.32       02/29/2016         03/01/2007 (10)     13,716 (21)     515,173                  
 
    03/01/2007 (5)     25,672       13,226       30.85       02/28/2017         01/01/2008 (13)                     26,239 (24)     985,537  
 
    03/01/2008 (6)     11,535       23,420       34.33       02/28/2018         03/01/2008 (11)     12,143 (22)     456,091                  
 
    03/01/2009 (8)     0       80,129       18.72       02/28/2019         03/01/2009 (12)     27,192 (19)     1,021,332                  
 
1.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2004 stock option award is as follows: 25% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2005; 25% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2006; and the remaining 50% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2007.
 
2.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2005 stock option award is as follows: 25% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2006; 25% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2007; and the remaining 50% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 30, 2008.
 
3.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2006 stock option award is as follows: 33% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2007; 33% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2008; and the remaining 34% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2009.
 
4.   This stock option award was granted to Mr. Foss in recognition of his role and responsibilities as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. The award fully vests and becomes exercisable on July 24, 2011, provided Mr. Foss remains employed through such date.

105


Table of Contents

5.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2007 stock option award is as follows: 33% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2008; 33% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2009; and the remaining 34% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2010, provided the executive remains employed through the applicable vesting dates.
 
6.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2008 stock option award is as follows: 33% of the options vested and became exercisable on March 1, 2009; 33% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2010; and the remaining 34% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2011, provided the executive remains employed through the applicable vesting dates.
 
7.   This stock option award was granted to Mr. Foss in recognition of his role and responsibilities as Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company. The award fully vests and becomes exercisable on October 2, 2013, provided Mr. Foss remains employed through October 2, 2013.
 
8.   The vesting schedule with respect to this 2009 stock option award is as follows: 33% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2010; 33% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2011; and the remaining 34% of the options vest and become exercisable on March 1, 2012, provided the executive remains employed through the applicable vesting dates.
 
9.   Since the pre-established earnings per share performance target was met, these RSUs fully vest on October 7, 2010, provided the executive remains employed through October 7, 2010.
 
10.   Since the pre-established earnings per share performance target was met, these RSUs fully vest on March 1, 2010, provided the executive remains employed through March 1, 2010.
 
11.   Since the pre-established earnings per share performance target was met, these RSUs fully vest on March 1, 2011, provided the executive remains employed through March 1, 2011.
 
12.   Since the pre-established earnings per share performance target was met, these RSUs fully vest on March 1, 2012, provided the executive remains employed through March 1, 2012.
 
13.   The vesting of this RSU award is contingent upon the satisfaction of a pre-established 2008 and 2009 earnings per share performance target, achievement of specific performance criteria and continued employment through January 1, 2012.
 
14.   This amount includes 3,751 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
15.   This amount includes 3,071 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
16.   This amount includes 2,410 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
17.   This amount includes 938 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
18.   This amount includes 614 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
19.   This amount includes 482 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
20.   This amount includes 578 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
21.   This amount includes 750 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
22.   This amount includes 491 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
23.   This amount includes 1,593 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
24.   This amount includes 1,062 RSUs accumulated as a result of dividend equivalents credited to the executive at the same time and in the same amount as dividends were paid to shareholders of common stock in accordance with the governing RSU agreement.
 
25.   The closing price for a share of PBG common stock on December 24, 2009, the last trading day of PBG’s fiscal year, was $37.56

106


Table of Contents

Option Exercises and Stock Vested In Fiscal Year 2009
                                   
    Option Awards     Stock Awards
    Number of Shares   Value Realized     Number of Shares   Value Realized
Name   Acquired on Exercise (#)   on Exercise ($)(1)     Acquired on Vesting (#)   on Vesting($)(1)
Eric J. Foss
    369,147       5,096,363         35,893       664,021 (2)
                                   
Alfred H. Drewes
    443,011       4,681,047         17,947       332,020 (3)
                                   
Yiannis Petrides
    94,000       655,104         17,947       332,020 (3)
                                   
Robert C. King
    193,913       1,555,530         14,358       265,623 (4)
                                   
Victor L. Crawford
    0       0         10,320       190,920 (5)
 
1.   The value realized on exercise and vesting reflects the pre-tax amount.
 
2.   Mr. Foss’ 2006 award of 34,106 restricted stock units, including 1,787 dividend equivalent units, vested on March 1, 2009. The value realized upon vesting was $664,021, determined by multiplying the number of vested restricted stock units and dividend equivalent units by the closing price of $18.50 on February 27, 2009, the last trading day immediately preceding the vesting date.
 
3.   Messrs. Drewes’ and Petrides’ 2006 award of 17,053 restricted stock units, including 894 dividend equivalent units, vested on March 1, 2009. The value realized upon vesting was $332,020, determined by multiplying the number of vested restricted stock units and dividend equivalent units by the closing price of $18.50 on February 27, 2009, the last trading day immediately preceding the vesting date.
 
4.   Mr. King’s 2006 award of 13,643 restricted stock units, including 715 dividend equivalent units, vested on March 1, 2009. The value realized upon vesting was $265,623, determined by multiplying the number of vested restricted stock units and dividend equivalent units by the closing price of $18.50 on February 27, 2009, the last trading day immediately preceding the vesting date.
 
5.   Mr. Crawford’s 2006 award of 9,806 restricted stock units, including 514 dividend equivalent units, vested on March 1, 2009. The value realized upon vesting was $190,920, determined by multiplying the number of vested restricted stock units and dividend equivalent units by the closing price of $18.50 on February 27, 2009, the last trading day immediately preceding the vesting date.

107


Table of Contents

Pension Benefits for the 2009 Fiscal Year
                             
        Number of Years   Present Value of   Payments During
        Credited Service   Accumulated Benefit   Last Fiscal Year
Name   Plan Name   (#)(1)(2)   ($)(3)   ($)
Eric J. Foss
  PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan     26.8       510,000       0  
 
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     27.6       4,498,000       0  
 
                           
Alfred H. Drewes
  PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan     26.8 (4)     624,000       0  
 
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     27.6 (4)     2,171,000       0  
 
                           
Yiannis Petrides
  The PepsiCo International Retirement Plan     21.2 (5)     2,773,000 (6)     0  
 
                           
Robert C. King
  PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan     19.3       383,000       0  
 
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     20.0       979,000       0  
 
                           
Victor L. Crawford
  PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan     3.3 (7)     38,000       0  
 
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     3.3 (7)     65,000       0  
 
1.   The number of years of service shown for each executive includes service with PepsiCo, PBG’s parent company prior to March 31, 1999, at which time PBG became a separate, publicly traded company. The executive’s service with PepsiCo prior to March 31, 1999 has not been separately identified and the benefit attributable to such service has not been separately quantified for such period. Any benefit amount attributable to the executive’s service with PepsiCo after March 31, 1999 has been separately identified and quantified. In this regard, periods of PepsiCo service that Mr. Drewes accrued after PBG became a separate company has been separately identified and quantified in footnote 4.
 
2.   Effective April 1, 2009, the Company amended its qualified and non-qualified defined benefit pension plans to cease all future accruals for salaried and non-union hourly U.S. employees with the exception of employees who, on March 31, 2009, (1) met a Rule of 65 (combined age and years of service equal to or greater than 65) or (2) were at least age 50 with five years of service. Each of the U.S. Named Executive Officers, with the exception of Mr. Crawford, met the criteria for continued pension accruals. However, as a result of limitations imposed by the Code, the Named Executive Officers must accrue benefits solely under the non-qualified defined benefit pension plan. Consequently, the incremental year of credited service for 2009 is provided for the PEP benefit only and the years of credited service shown for the qualified plan are frozen at the level immediately prior to the effective date of the amendment to cease all future accruals.
 
3.   The material assumptions used to quantify the present value of the accumulated benefit for each executive are set forth in Note 11, Pension and Postretirement Medical Benefit Plans, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, except for the generally applicable assumptions regarding retirement age and pre-retirement mortality.
 
4.   Mr. Drewes transferred from PepsiCo on June 25, 2001. The years of credited service shown above include all prior PepsiCo service. However, only the portion of the pension benefit attributable to Mr. Drewes’ PepsiCo service that accrued after March 31, 1999 (two years of service) has been separately quantified as follows: $36,000 under the PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan and $129,000 under the PBG Pension Equalization Plan. PepsiCo transferred to the PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan an amount equal to the present value of Mr. Drewes’ pension benefit under the PepsiCo Salaried Employees Retirement Plan at the time Mr. Drewes transferred to the Company.
 
5.   The PepsiCo International Retirement Plan benefit is offset by all amounts paid to or on behalf of Mr. Petrides by the Company pursuant to any Company sponsored plan or government mandated programs.
 
6.   Mr. Petrides also meets the criteria for continued pension accruals, and he continues to participate in the PepsiCo International Retirement Plan without regard to limitations imposed by the Code which is inapplicable to his pension benefits.
 
7.   As noted in footnote 2 above, effective April 1, 2009, Mr. Crawford no longer accrues a benefit under either plan and his years of credited service under each plan will remain at 3.3 years of service.
Narrative to the Pension Benefits Table
          This narrative describes the terms of the PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan (“Salaried Plan”), the Pension Equalization Plan (“PEP”) and the PepsiCo International Retirement Plan (“PIRP”) in effect during 2009.

108


Table of Contents

          The PBG Salaried Employees Retirement Plan. Prior to April 1, 2009, the Salaried Plan, a tax qualified defined benefit pension plan, generally covered salaried employees in the U.S. hired by the Company (or PepsiCo in the case of an Approved Transfer) before January 1, 2007, who have completed one year of service. Eligible employees hired after January 1, 2007 received an annual employer retirement contribution of two percent of eligible pay in the PBG 401(k) Plan. All of our Named Executive Officers were hired before January 1, 2007.
          Effective April 1, 2009, benefits accrued under the Salaried Plan were frozen for all participants who, as of such date, did not have combined age and service totaling 65 or more, or who had not attained age 50 with five or more years of service. In addition, accrued benefits were frozen for executives in salary bands E3 and above, which includes all of our Named Executive Officers. Participants who did not satisfy the age and service requirements for continued accruals, including Mr. Crawford, and employees hired on or after January 1, 2007 receive an employer retirement contribution in the PBG 401(k) Plan of 2% of eligible pay (3% if the employee has ten or more years of service) and receive credits for compensation amounts in excess of eligible pay under the qualified plan at the same rate in the non-qualified PBG Supplemental Savings Plan. Executives in salary bands E3 and above who satisfied the age and service requirement continue to accrue pension benefits in the non-qualified PEP, but not in the Salaried Plan.
          Benefits are payable under the Salaried Plan to participants with five or more years of service commencing on the later of age 65 or retirement. Benefits are determined based on a participant’s earnings (which generally include base pay or salary, regular bonuses, and short term disability pay; and exclude income resulting from equity awards, extraordinary bonuses, fringe benefits, and earnings that exceed the applicable dollar limit of Section 401(a)(17) of the Code) and credited service (generally, service as an eligible employee), provided that earnings and credited service were frozen as of March 31, 2009 for participants who did not satisfy the requirements for continued participation as described above, including our Named Executive Officers. The primary purpose of the Salaried Plan is to provide retirement income to eligible employees.
          The annual retirement benefit formula for a participant with at least five years of service on December 31, 1999 is (a) 3% of the participant’s average earnings in the five consecutive calendar years in which earnings were the highest for each year of credited service up to ten years, plus (b) an additional 1% of such average earnings for each year of credited service in excess of ten years, minus (c) 0.43% of average earnings up to the Social Security covered compensation multiplied by years of credited service up to 35 years (“Basic Formula”). If a participant did not have five years of service on December 31, 1999, the retirement benefit formula is 1% of the participant’s average earnings in the five consecutive calendar years in which earnings were the highest for each year of credited service (“Primary Formula”).
          A participant who has attained age 55 and completed ten years of vesting service may retire and begin receiving early retirement benefits. If the participant retires before age 62, benefits are reduced by 1/3 of 1% for each month (4% for each year) of payment before age 62.
          Retirees have several payment options under the Salaried Plan. With the exception of the single lump sum payment option, each payment form provides monthly retirement income for the life of the retiree. Survivor options provide for continuing payments in full or part for the life of a contingent annuitant and, if selected, the survivor option reduces the benefit payable to the participant during his or her lifetime.
          A participant with five or more years of service who terminates employment prior to attaining age 55 and completing ten years of service is entitled to a deferred vested benefit. The deferred vested benefit of a participant entitled to a benefit under the Basic Formula described above is equal to the Basic Formula amount calculated based on projected service to age 65 prorated by a fraction, the numerator of which is the participant’s credited service at termination of employment (or the date accruals ended, if earlier) and the denominator of which is the participant’s potential credited service had the participant remained employed to age 65. The deferred vested benefit of a participant entitled to a benefit under the Primary Formula described above is the Primary Formula amount, determined based on earnings and credited service as of the date employment terminates (or the date accruals ended, if earlier). Deferred vested benefits are payable commencing at age 65. However, a participant may elect to commence benefits as early as age 55 on an actuarially reduced basis to reflect the longer payment period. Deferred vested benefits are payable in the form of a single life annuity or a joint and survivor annuity with the participant’s spouse as co-annuitant.
          The Salaried Plan also provides survivor spouse benefits in the event of a participant’s death prior to commencement of benefits under the Salaried Plan. After a participant’s benefits have commenced, any survivor benefits are determined by the form of payment elected by the participant.
          The Salaried Plan provides extra years of credited service for participants who become totally and permanently disabled after completing at least ten years of vesting service, if such participant was actively accruing benefits when the disability began, and with respect to pre-participation service in connection with specified events such as plan mergers, acquired groups of employees, designated employees who transferred to the Company from PepsiCo, and other special circumstances. Salaried Plan benefits are

109


Table of Contents

generally offset by any other qualified plan benefit the participant is entitled to under a plan maintained or contributed to by the Company.
          The PBG Pension Equalization Plan. The PEP is an unfunded nonqualified defined benefit pension plan designed to provide additional benefits to participants whose Salaried Plan benefits are limited (i) due to the annual compensation limit in Section 401(a)(17) of the Code or the annual benefit limit in Section 415 of the Code or (ii) because the individual made elective deferrals to the PBG Executive Income Deferral Program on or after April 1, 2009. Effective April 1, 2009, the PEP provides additional benefits to executives in salary bands E3 and above who, as of April 1, 2009, had age and service totaling 65 or more or who had attained age 50 and completed five or more years of service, and who ceased to accrue benefits under the Salaried Plan. The PEP also provides a subsidized 50% joint and survivor annuity for certain retirement eligible employees based on the Salaried Plan’s benefit formula using the participant’s total compensation including earnings that otherwise would be used to determine benefits payable under the Salaried Plan. Generally, for benefits accrued and vested prior to January 1, 2005 (“grandfathered PEP benefits”), a participant’s PEP benefit is payable under the same terms and conditions of the Salaried Plan, which include various actuarially equivalent forms as elected by participants, including lump sums. In addition, if the lump sum value of the grandfathered PEP benefit does not exceed $10,000, the benefit is paid as a single lump sum. Benefits accrued or vested on or after January 1, 2005 are payable as a lump sum at termination of employment; provided that a PEP participant who attained age 50 on or before January 1, 2009 was provided a one-time opportunity to elect to receive such benefits in the form of an annuity commencing on retirement. The PEP benefit, calculated under the terms of the plan in effect at fiscal year end, is equal to the Salaried Plan benefit (as determined without regard to the Code’s annual compensation limit and the annual benefit limit, and including in compensation elective deferrals after April 1, 2009), less the actual benefit payable under the Salaried Plan. For executives in Band E3 and above who satisfied the age and service conditions but ceased accruing benefits on April 1, 2009, the benefit is calculated as if such executives had continued to accrue Salaried Plan benefits, less the actual benefit payable under the Salaried Plan. However, the PEP benefit of a participant who had eligible earnings in 1988 in excess of $75,000, including Mr. Drewes, is determined as a subsidized 50% joint and survivor annuity benefit. The subsidized 50% joint and survivor benefit pays an unreduced benefit for the lifetime of the participant and 50% of that benefit amount to the surviving spouse upon the death of the participant.
          The PepsiCo International Retirement Plan. The PIRP is a nonqualified defined benefit pension plan sponsored and administered by PepsiCo in which certain Company employees participate, including Mr. Petrides. The Company has had a very limited number of active PIRP participants since 1999. The primary purpose of the PIRP is to provide retirement income to eligible international employees.
          The PIRP generally covers non-U.S. citizens who are on their second assignment outside of their home country. The material terms and conditions of the PIRP generally mirror the Basic Formula provisions of the Salaried Plan, without the Social Security offset, and the PIRP benefit is payable under the same terms and conditions as the Salaried Plan. Benefits are determined based on a participant’s earnings (which generally include base pay or salary, regular bonuses, and short term disability pay; and exclude income resulting from equity awards, extraordinary bonuses, fringe benefits) and credited service (generally, service as an eligible employee). The PIRP benefit is reduced by any benefits paid to or on behalf of a participant by the Company including benefits paid under any other Company provided retirement plan or pursuant to any government mandated retirement or severance plan.

110


Table of Contents

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation for the 2009 Fiscal Year
                                         
                            Aggregate    
    Executive   Company   Aggregate Earnings   Withdrawals/   Aggregate
    Contributions   Contributions   in Last FY   Distributions   Balance at
Name   in Last FY ($)   in Last FY ($)   ($)   ($)   Last FYE ($)(8)
Eric J. Foss
    192,000       0       1,597,928       0       3,679,749 (1)
                                   
Alfred H. Drewes
    79,968       0       631,612       0       2,810,416 (2)
                                   
Yiannis Petrides(3)
                             
                                   
Robert C. King
    82,755 (4)     0       179,089       (63,076 )     460,649 (5)
                                   
Victor L. Crawford
    0       2,458 (6)     56       0       2,514 (7)
 
1.   $2,157,025 of Mr. Foss’ aggregate balance was previously reported as compensation in Summary Compensation Tables for prior years.
 
2.   $755,866 of Mr. Drewes’ aggregate balance was previously reported as compensation in Summary Compensation Tables for prior years.
 
3.   Mr. Petrides is ineligible to participate in the Company’s deferred compensation program, which is available only to Company executives on the U.S. payroll.
 
4.   $26,250 of Mr. King’s contributions is reported as compensation in the “Salary” column of the Summary Compensation Table to this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
5.   $313,895 of Mr. King’s aggregate balance was previously reported as compensation in Summary Compensation Tables for prior years.
 
6.   This amount represents a Company retirement contribution equal to 3% of eligible pay to Mr. Crawford’s Supplemental Savings Program account and is reported as compensation in the “All Other Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table to this Annual Report on Form 10-K. As of April 1, 2009, Mr. Crawford is no longer eligible to accrue a benefit under the defined benefit plan. Instead, Mr. Crawford is eligible for this 3% Company retirement contribution based on his combined service with PepsiCo and the Company.
 
7.   None of Mr. Crawford’s aggregate balance has been previously reported as compensation in Summary Compensation Tables for prior years.
 
8.   The amount reflected in this column for Messrs. Drewes and King includes compensation deferred by the Named Executive Officer over the entirety of his career at both PepsiCo and PBG.
Narrative to the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table
Deferral Program
          The Deferral Program is the only nonqualified elective deferred compensation program sponsored by the Company. The Deferral Program is administered by the Committee. All Company executives on the U.S. payroll, including our Named Executive Officers, are eligible to participate in the Deferral Program. The Deferral Program allows executives to defer receipt of compensation and to defer federal and state income tax on the deferred amounts, including earnings, until such time as the deferred amounts are paid out. The Company makes no contributions to the Deferral Program on behalf of executives. The Deferral Program is unfunded and the executive’s deferrals under the Deferral Program are at all times subject to the claims of the Company’s general creditors.
          The terms and conditions of the Deferral Program vary with respect to deferrals made or vested on and after January 1, 2005. Such deferrals are subject to the requirements of Section 409A of the Code (“409A”) which became effective on such date. Deferrals made or vested before January 1, 2005 are not subject to the requirements of 409A (“grandfathered deferrals”).

111


Table of Contents

          Deferrals of Base Salary and Annual Non-Equity Incentive Award. Executives may irrevocably elect to defer up to 80% of their annual base salary and 100% of their annual non-equity incentive award (“Bonus”). In addition to elective deferrals, the Committee may mandate deferral of a portion of an executive’s base salary in excess of one million dollars.
          Phantom Investment Options. Executives select the phantom investment option(s) from those available under the terms of the Deferral Program. The phantom investment options available under the Deferral Program are a subset of the funds available under the Company’s 401(k) plan. Consequently, amounts deferred under the Deferral Program are subject to the same investment gains and losses during the deferral period as experienced by the participants in the Company’s 401(k) plan. Executives may change investment option elections and transfer balances between investment options on a daily basis.
          The phantom investment options currently available under the Deferral Program and their 2009 rates of return are:
         
    Return
Phantom Fund   Rate (%)
The Phantom PBG Stock Fund
    69.18  
The Phantom Security Plus Fund
    2.28  
The Phantom Bond Index Fund
    6.10  
The Phantom Total U.S. Equity Index Fund
    28.17  
The Phantom Large Cap Equity Index Fund
    26.64  
The Phantom Mid Cap Equity Index Fund
    37.32  
The Phantom Small Cap Equity Index Fund
    27.43  
The Phantom International Equity Index Fund
    32.10  
          Time and Form of Payment. Prior to deferral, executives are required to elect a specific payment date or payment event as well as the form of payment (lump sum or quarterly, semi-annual, or annual installments for a period of up to twenty years). The Committee selects the time and form of payment for mandatory deferrals. Executives with grandfathered deferrals were required to elect a specific payment date or event prior to deferral, but may elect the form of payment at a later date nearer to the payment date (not later than December 31 of the calendar year preceding the year of the scheduled payment and at least six months in advance of the scheduled payment date).
          Deferral Periods. Salary and Bonus deferrals are subject to minimum and maximum deferral periods. The minimum deferral period for salary deferrals is one year after the end of the applicable base salary year. The minimum deferral period for Bonus deferrals is two years after the Bonus payout would have been made but for the deferral.
          Distribution Rules. In general, deferrals are paid out in accordance with the executive’s deferral election, subject to the minimum deferral periods. The Deferral Program provides that, notwithstanding the minimum deferral periods or the executive’s time and form of payment elections, deferrals will automatically be paid out in a lump sum in the event of death or a separation from service for reasons other than retirement. Generally, payment will be made three months after the end of the quarter in which the separation from service occurred. However, special rules apply for “key employees,” as defined under 409A (which would encompass all Named Executive Officers). In the event of a separation from service, the Named Executive Officers may not receive a distribution for at least six months following separation from service. This six month rule does not apply in the event of the Named Executive Officer’s death.
          Generally, payment of grandfathered deferrals is made in the form of a lump sum in the event of voluntary termination of employment or termination of employment as a result of misconduct but only after the minimum deferral periods have been satisfied. If the executive’s balance is greater than $25,000, the executive will be paid out in a lump sum a year after his last day of employment. However, special distribution rules apply when an executive separates from service after reaching retirement eligibility (age 55 with ten years of service). In such case, payment is made in the time and form elected by the executive.
          Deferral Extensions (Second-Look Elections). In general, executives may extend their original deferral period by making a subsequent deferral election. This modification of an original deferral election is often referred to as a “second-look” election. More stringent requirements apply to second-look elections related to deferrals subject to 409A since 409A requires that any second-look election must be made at least 12 months prior to the originally scheduled payout date and the second-look election must provide for a deferral period of at least five years from the originally scheduled payment date. Grandfathered deferrals may also be extended at the election of the executive provided the election is made no later than December 31 of the year preceding the originally scheduled payout date and at least six months in advance of the originally scheduled payout date and is for a minimum deferral of at least two years from the originally scheduled payment date.
          Hardship Withdrawals. Accelerated distribution is only permissible upon the executive’s showing of severe, extraordinary and unforeseen financial hardship.

112


Table of Contents

Supplemental Savings Program
          The Supplemental Savings Program (“SSP”) is a nonqualified, non-elective, defined contribution deferred compensation program sponsored by the Company to provide benefits to employees whose participation in the CRC portion of the Company’s 401(k) plan is limited because of the compensation limit imposed on the 401(k) plan by the Code or because of the employee’s elective deferrals under the Deferral Program. The Company credits an amount equal to 2% of the sum of the eligible employee’s compensation in excess of the compensation limit and the employee’s elective deferrals under the Deferral Program to an SSP account. Effective April 1, 2009, the Company’s contribution was increased to 3% for employees with ten or more years of service. Only employees who are not eligible to accrue pension benefits under a Company-sponsored defined benefit plan are eligible for the CRC under the SSP or the 401(k) Plan.
          Each participant’s account, including hypothetical earnings, is vested after the participant has three years service but continues to be subject to forfeiture in the event of misconduct, as defined in the SSP. The SSP is unfunded and participants’ payments are at all times subject to the claims of the Company’s general creditors.
          Phantom Investment Options. Participants select the phantom investment option(s) from those available under the SSP, which are a subset of the funds available under the Company’s 401(k) plan. Consequently, amounts credited under the SSP are subject to the same investment gains and losses during the deferral period as experienced by the participants in the Company’s 401(k) plan. Participants may change investment options and transfer balances among the investment options on a daily basis.
          The phantom investment options currently available under the SSP and their 2009 rates of return are:
         
    Return
Phantom Fund   Rate (%)
The Phantom PBG Stock Fund
    69.18  
The Phantom Security Plus Fund
    2.28  
The Phantom Bond Index Fund
    6.10  
The Phantom Dodge and Cox Income Fund
    16.05  
The Phantom Large Cap Equity Index Fund
    26.64  
The Phantom Total U.S. Equity Index Fund
    28.17  
The Phantom Mid Cap Equity Index Fund
    37.32  
The Phantom Small Cap Equity Index Fund
    27.43  
The Phantom Fidelity Diversified International Fund
    31.78  
The Phantom International Equity Index Fund
    32.10  
The Phantom Fidelity Freedom Income Fund
    16.12  
The Phantom Fidelity Fund 2010 Fund
    24.82  
The Phantom Fidelity Fund 2020 Fund
    28.86  
The Phantom Fidelity Fund 2030 Fund
    30.57  
The Phantom Fidelity Fund 2040 Fund
    31.65  
The Phantom Fidelity Fund 2050 Fund
    32.47  
          Time and Form of Payment. A participant’s vested SSP account is paid in a single lump sum payment as soon as practicable following the last day of the month in which the participant separates from service; provided that “key employees,” as defined under 409A, may not receive a distribution for at least six months following separation from service. In the event of a participant’s death, the participant’s account is paid to the participant’s beneficiary as soon as practicable following the last day of the month in which the participant’s death occurs. If Section 162(m) of the Code would preclude the Company from taking a tax deduction for such payment at the time a payment would otherwise be made, such payment is automatically deferred until the first date Section 162(m) no longer applies.

113


Table of Contents

Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change In Control
          The terms and conditions of the Company’s compensation and benefit programs govern all payments to eligible executives, including the Named Executive Officers, in the event of termination of employment (other than in the context of a Change In Control) (“Termination”), retirement, death or disability. The terms and conditions of the Retention Agreements govern payments to eligible executives, including the Named Executive Officers, in the event of a Change In Control.
          This narrative and the accompanying tables are intended to show the value of all potential payments that would be payable to the Named Executive Officers upon Termination, retirement, death, disability or Change In Control to the extent that the triggering event would result in a payment or benefit that is not generally available to all salaried employees of the Company and that is incremental to, or an enhancement of, the payments and benefits described or shown in any preceding narrative or table. The following assumes the triggering event occurred on December 24, 2009 (the last trading day in the fiscal year).
Termination of Employment, Retirement, Death or Disability
          Nonqualified Pension Benefits. If Termination occurs prior to eligibility for early retirement benefits (age 55 and 10 years of service), the PEP would provide, for benefits accrued and vested before 2005, a deferred vested pension benefit, payable as an annual annuity for the life of the executive or as a joint and survivor annuity with the executive’s spouse commencing at the same time and in the same form as the qualified plan benefit. All of the Named Executive Officers would receive a deferred vested pension benefit based on a Termination date of December 24, 2009. An unreduced benefit would commence at age 65; actuarially reduced benefits may be commenced as early as age 55. If Termination occurs after eligibility for early retirement benefits, the PEP benefits accrued and vested before 2005 generally would be paid at the same time and in the same form as the tax-qualified pension plan benefit. PEP benefits accrued or vested after 2004 are generally payable in a single lump sum payment on termination of employment (six months following termination in the case of key employees) without regard to eligibility for retirement.
          The PIRP would provide a deferred vested pension benefit, payable as an annual annuity for the life of the executive commencing at age 65, if the executive were to Terminate on December 24, 2009, prior to age 55. The deferred vested PIRP benefit would be payable to the executive as early as age 55, but would be reduced on an actuarially equivalent basis given the longer payment period.
          The deferred vested PEP and PIRP benefit are significantly less than the benefit that would be payable to the executive had he remained employed until age 55 and is significantly less than the benefit valued in the Pension Benefits Table, which was calculated assuming the executive works until age 62, the earliest age at which unreduced benefits are available to a plan participant. No pension benefit would be payable in an enhanced form or in an amount in excess of the value shown in the Pension Benefits Table except in the event of death or, with respect to Mr. Petrides, disability. Therefore, we have not separately quantified pension benefits payable upon any event of Termination other than death under the terms of the PEP and the PIRP in effect on December 24, 2009.
          Disability. Under the terms of the PIRP, Mr. Petrides’ disability pension benefit would be calculated based on additional service that would be credited during the executive’s period of “Disability” (as defined under the Company’s broad-based long-term disability plan) up to the age of 65, assuming he remains Disabled and does not elect a distribution prior to such age. The disability pension benefit amount based on the foregoing assumptions would be $659,400. The executive could elect a distribution as early as age 55 but the benefit would be reduced by 4% for each year of payment prior to age 62. No incremental disability pension benefits are payable under the PEP to the other Named Executive Officers.
          Death. Under the terms of the PEP, a pre-retirement survivor spouse benefit would be payable with respect to pre-2005 accrued and vested PEP benefits, payable in the form of an annuity for the life of the surviving spouse. Surviving spouse benefits for post-2004 accrued and vested PEP benefits are payable in a single lump sum payment. Under the terms of the PIRP, a pre-retirement survivor spouse benefit would be immediately payable as an annual annuity to the executive’s surviving spouse for his/her lifetime.

114


Table of Contents

          The table below reflects the PEP and PIRP pension benefit that would be payable to the surviving spouse of each Named Executive Officer in the event of the executive’s death on December 24, 2009. To the extent the Named Executive Officer continues active service, the amounts shown below generally will increase year over year based on increases in eligible pay and service credit. The payments would be in lieu of the PEP and PIRP benefits valued in the Pension Benefits Table.
                           
        Death
Name   Plan Name   Annual Annuity     Lump Sum
Eric J. Foss
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan   $ 34,200       $ 4,062,000  
Alfred H. Drewes
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     21,900         1,416,000  
Yiannis Petrides
  PepsiCo International Retirement Plan     164,900         N/A  
Robert C. King
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     6,000         1,159,000  
Victor L. Crawford
  PBG Pension Equalization Plan     N/A         57,000  
          LTIP. The LTIP’s provisions apply to all equity awards made to employees of the Company, including the Named Executive Officers, and, with few exceptions, the terms of the individual LTIP agreements provide for accelerated vesting of stock options and RSUs upon retirement, death, and disability. This accelerated vesting is pro-rata or 100% depending on the triggering event as more fully described below. The payments that would result from each triggering event are quantified for each Named Executive Officer in the table below. The amounts were calculated based on the closing market price of PBG common stock on December 24, 2009, the last trading day of fiscal 2009, and reflect the incremental value to the executive that would result from the accelerated vesting of unvested equity awards.
          Disability. In the event of the Disability of a Named Executive Officer, a pro-rata number of stock options vest based on the executive’s active employment during the vesting period. The stock options would remain exercisable for the remainder of their original ten-year term. RSUs vest in the same pro-rata manner and would be paid out immediately upon vesting.
          Death. In the event of the death of a Named Executive Officer, all unvested stock options vest automatically and remain exercisable by the executive’s estate for the remainder of their original ten-year term. In general, RSUs similarly vest automatically and are immediately paid out in shares of PBG common stock to the executive’s legal representative or heir. This automatic vesting does not apply to the October 7, 2005 RSU awards granted to Messrs. Foss and Petrides as reflected in the Outstanding Equity Awards Table, and the special award of performance-based RSUs (Strategic Leadership Award) granted to Messrs. Drewes, Petrides, Crawford and King on January 1, 2008, that instead provide for pro-rata vesting upon the death of the executive. The pro-rata number of RSUs that would vest is determined based on the executive’s active employment during the vesting period.
          Retirement. In general, if a Named Executive Officer retires from the Company (generally, after attaining age 55 with ten or more years of service), a pro-rata number of stock options and RSUs would vest in proportion to the executive’s active employment during the vesting period subject to achievement of any applicable performance-based vesting condition. Certain RSU awards to the Named Executive Officers contain different retirement provisions. In particular, the October 7, 2005 RSU awards granted to Messrs. Foss and Petrides as reflected in the Outstanding Equity Awards Table, and the special award of performance-based RSUs (Strategic Leadership Award) granted to Messrs. Drewes, Petrides, Crawford and King on January 1, 2008 as reflected in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table for Fiscal Year 2008 set forth in last year’s proxy statement, do not provide for accelerated vesting and payout upon retirement. Since no Named Executive Officer was eligible for early or normal retirement during 2009, there is no quantification of vesting or payout based upon such occurrence.
          The following table reflects the incremental value the executive would receive as a result of accelerated vesting of unvested stock options and RSUs had disability or death occurred on December 24, 2009. The value was calculated using the closing market price of a share of PBG common stock on December 24, 2009, the last trading day of fiscal 2009.
                 
Name   Disability   Death
Eric J. Foss
  $ 13,762,263     $ 27,199,441  
Alfred H. Drewes
    2,561,365       4,689,711  
Yiannis Petrides
    4,835,539       6,963,885  
Robert C. King
    2,701,970       5,195,888  
Victor L. Crawford
    2,091,143       4,159,402  
Change In Control
          The terms and conditions of the Retention Agreements govern payments to eligible executives, including the Named Executive Officers, in the event of a Change In Control, which includes the pending merger with PepsiCo. Under the Retention Agreements, a Change In Control occurs if: (i) any person or entity becomes a beneficial owner of 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Company’s outstanding securities; (ii) 50% of the directors (other than directors approved by a majority of the

115


Table of Contents

Company’s directors) change in any consecutive two-year period; (iii) the Company is merged into or consolidated with another entity, or there is a disposition of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets unless the Company’s shareholders before and after the merger, consolidation or disposition of assets continue to hold 50% or more of the voting power of the surviving entity’s outstanding securities.
          Under the Retention Agreements, if a Change In Control occurs all outstanding equity-based, equity-related and other long-term incentive awards held by the Named Executive Officers that are subject to performance-based vesting criteria will be deemed to have been earned at target performance level. Any service-based vesting requirements applicable to such awards will remain in effect and lapse in accordance with the terms of the applicable award, subject to accelerated vesting as described in clause (iv) of the next paragraph.
          Each Named Executive Officer will also be entitled to certain severance payments and benefits if his employment is terminated under certain circumstances. The Named Executive Officer is entitled to those severance payments and benefits if, during the two-year period after a change in control, the executive is terminated without cause or resigns for good reason (which includes a material reduction in the executive’s authority, duties, titles or responsibilities, reduction in annual base salary, material reduction in target bonus, material reduction in employee benefits in the aggregate and a change in primary work location to a location 35 or more miles from the executive’s primary work location immediately prior to a change in control). If terminated or separated from the Company under those circumstances, the Named Executive Officer is entitled to the following severance payments and benefits under the Retention Agreement: (i) a lump-sum cash severance payment equal to two times the sum of (a) the executive’s base salary in effect on the date of termination and (b) the target annual bonus for the year of termination; (ii) a prorated target annual bonus for the year of termination (determined based on the number of days worked during the year of termination); (iii) reimbursement for the cost of continued medical, dental and vision coverage for up to 24 months; (iv) the accelerated vesting or settlement, as applicable, of all outstanding equity-based, equity-related and other long-term incentive awards; (v) reimbursement up to $50,000 for the cost of outplacement services; and (vi) early retirement benefits (consisting of a lump-sum cash payment based on standard early retirement benefit formulas under the Company’s retirement plans, as well as retiree medical coverage and retiree life insurance coverage), provided that the executive has been credited with at least 10 years of service and has attained an age of at least 50 at the time of the executive’s termination of employment.
          In order to obtain severance benefits under a Retention Agreement, each Named Executive Officer must first execute a separation agreement with the Company that includes a waiver and release of any and all claims against the Company. The Retention Agreements also provide that, for two years following termination, the executive will not compete with the Company, solicit or hire any employee of the Company or its affiliates, solicit any customer or prospective customer of the Company and its affiliates or interfere with any relationship between the Company and its customers or prospective customers.
          The payments and benefits under the Retention Agreements are subject to reduction so that each Named Executive Officer will receive the greatest after-tax benefit after taking into account any excise taxes that may be imposed in connection with payments relating to the termination of such executive’s employment. The Retention Agreements do not, however, include any gross-up for such taxes.

116


Table of Contents

          The following table reflects the incremental value the executive would receive under the terms of the Retention Agreements had a Change In Control occurred on December 24, 2009 and the Named Executive Officer was involuntarily terminated on such date. The value of the equity awards was calculated using the closing market price of a share of PBG common stock on December 24, 2009, the last trading day of fiscal 2009.
                                                                 
                            Accelerated                        
                    Accelerated   Vesting and                   Reimburse-    
                    Vesting and   Settlement of                   ment for   Total Value
                    Settlement of   Equity-Based   Reimburse-   Value of   Medical,   of Benefits
    Lump-   Prorated   Equity-Based   Awards -   ment for   Early   Dental and   Under The
    Sum Cash   Target   Awards -   Stock   Outplacement   Retirement   Vision   Retention
Name   Severance   Bonus   RSU   Options   Services   Benefits   Coverage   Agreements
Eric J. Foss
  $ 5,000,000     $ 1,491,781     $ 15,255,016     $ 12,686,595     $ 50,000     $ 4,640,000     $ 39,568     $ 39,162,960  
Alfred H. Drewes
    1,776,000       405,764       3,713,730       1,715,118       50,000       2,469,000       40,201       10,169,813  
Yiannis Petrides1
    2,631,905       601,314       6,412,003       1,715,118       50,000       2,809,000       47,566       14,266,906  
Robert C. King
    2,100,000       522,123       3,917,995       2,017,029       50,000       1,517,000       44,285       10,168,432  
Victor L. Crawford
    1,572,500       359,271       2,978,143       1,674,023       50,000       N/A       44,285       6,678,222  
 
1.   The Lump Sum Cash Severance and Prorated Target Bonus amounts for Mr. Petrides are paid to him in Euros and were translated into U.S. dollars using an exchange rate of 0.70033 U.S. dollars/Euro, which was the rate in effect on December 24, 2009. The average exchange rate of one U.S. dollar to Euros was 0.72 in 2009.
          Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Plans. The Named Executive Officers’ deferred compensation balances under the Deferral Program and the Supplemental Savings Program and a description of their respective payment provisions are set forth in the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table and accompanying narrative. No triggering event would serve to enhance such amounts. However, the deferred compensation balances set forth in the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table would be payable in the form of a lump sum in the event of death or separation from service for reasons other than retirement. If the Named Executive Officer is retirement eligible (age 55 with 10 years of service) and retires, amounts under the Deferral Program will be paid at the time and in the form elected by the Named Executive Officer and amounts under the Supplemental Savings Program will be paid in a lump sum at retirement. However, as noted above, no Named Executive Officer was eligible for early or normal retirement during 2009.
          Benefits Generally Available to All Salaried Employees. There are a number of employee benefits generally available to all salaried employees upon termination of employment. In accordance with SEC guidelines, these benefits are not discussed above since they do not discriminate in scope, terms or operation in favor of the Company’s executive officers. These include tax-qualified retirement benefits and long-term disability and government mandated termination benefits in non-U.S. locations, such as Greece.

117


Table of Contents

Director Compensation In Fiscal Year 2009
                                                             
    Fees Earned or Paid in Cash ($)                
              Committee     Committee   Stock   Option   All Other    
    Annual Board     Chair     Meeting   Awards(4)(5)   Awards(4)(5)   Compensation   Total
Name   Retainer(1)     Fee(1)(2)     Fees(3)   ($)   ($)   ($)   ($)
Linda G. Alvarado
    70,000         10,000         10,500       70,000       51,384       4,160 (6)     216,044  
                                                             
Barry H. Beracha
    90,000         0         40,500       70,000       51,384       24,160 (7)     276,044  
                                                             
John C. Compton
    70,000         0         0       6,442             4,160 (6)     80,602  
                                                             
Ira D. Hall
    70,000         46,250         42,000       70,000       51,384       24,052 (8)     303,686  
                                                             
Susan D. Kronick
    90,000         3,750         37,500       70,000       51,384       24,160 (7)     276,794  
                                                             
Blythe J. McGarvie
    90,000         15,000         34,500       70,000       51,384       24,160 (7)     285,044  
                                                             
John A. Quelch
    70,000 (9)       0         19,500 (9)     70,000       51,384       24,160 (7)     235,044  
                                                             
Javier G. Teruel
    120,000 (10)       0         27,000       70,000       51,384       4,160 (6)     272,544  
                                                             
Cynthia M. Trudell
    70,000         0         0       10,628             4,160 (6)     84,788  
 
1.   On April 20, 2009, the Company formed a Special Committee of the Board of Directors (“Special Committee”) comprised solely of independent Directors to consider the proposal received by PepsiCo to acquire all of the outstanding shares of the Company not already owned by PepsiCo. The amounts in this column include an annual cash retainer of $20,000 payable to Ms. Kronick, Ms. McGarvie and Messrs. Beracha and Teruel for serving as members of the Company’s Special Committee, and $35,000 payable to Mr. Hall who served as Chair of the Special Committee.
 
2.   Committee Chair fees are pro-rated based on length of service as Committee Chair during the year as more fully described in the Narrative to the Director Compensation Table and Director Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table.
 
3.   Each non-employee Director receives $1,500 for each formal Committee and Special Committee meeting he or she attends as a member. Neither Mr. Compton nor Ms. Trudell served on any Committee of the Board of Directors.
 
4.   The amount included in this column is the compensation cost recognized by the Company in fiscal year 2009 related to the Director’s outstanding equity awards that were unvested for all or any part of 2009, calculated in accordance with SFAS 123R without regard to forfeiture estimates. This amount encompasses equity awards that were granted in 2008 and 2009 as more fully described in the Narrative that follows this table and was determined using the assumptions set forth in Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
5.   The aggregate number of unvested stock awards and unexercised stock option awards outstanding for each Director at fiscal year end 2009 is provided in the table below:
                 
    Number of Outstanding   Number of Unexercised Stock
Director   Unvested Stock Awards   Option Awards
Linda G. Alvarado
    0       27,165  
Barry H. Beracha
    0       0  
John C. Compton
    0       0  
Ira D. Hall
    0       27,165  
Susan D. Kronick
    0       27,165  
Blythe J. McGarvie
    0       17,667  
John A. Quelch
    0       27,165  
Javier G. Teruel
    0       19,458  
Cynthia M. Trudell
    0       0  

118


Table of Contents

 
6.   This amount includes: (i) $2,754, which equals the total value of all perquisites and personal benefits provided to Ms. Alvarado, Mr. Compton, Mr. Teruel and Ms. Trudell in connection with nominal recognition awards; and (ii) $1,406, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Ms. Alvarado, Mr. Compton, Mr. Teruel and Ms. Trudell for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits.
 
7.   This amount includes: (i) $2,754, which equals the total value of all perquisites and personal benefits provided to Messrs. Beracha and Quelch, Ms. Kronick and Ms. McGarvie in connection with nominal recognition awards; (ii) $1,406, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Messrs. Beracha and Quelch, Ms. Kronick and Ms. McGarvie for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits; and (iii) $20,000, which represents the amount paid by the Company to match their eligible charitable contributions in 2009.
 
8.   This amount includes: (i) $2,754, which equals the total value of all perquisites and personal benefits provided to Mr. Hall in connection with nominal recognition awards; (ii) $1,406, which equals all tax reimbursements paid to Mr. Hall for the tax liability related to Company provided perquisites and personal benefits; and (iii) $19,888, which represents the amount paid by the Company to match Mr. Hall’s eligible charitable contributions in 2009.
 
9.   The 2009 retainer and fees earned by Mr. Quelch were deferred and converted into phantom stock units pursuant to the PBG Director Deferral Program, and which will be paid in cash on a later date elected by Mr. Quelch.
 
10.   This amount also includes $30,000 which represents the annual cash retainer payable to Mr. Teruel who served as Lead Director of the Board of Directors.
Director Grants of Plan-Based Awards In Fiscal Year 2009
                                                 
                    All Other Option            
            All Other Stock   Awards:   Exercise or   Closing    
            Awards:   Number of   Base Price of   Market Price   Grant Date Fair
            Number of Shares   Securities   Option   on   Value of Stock
    Grant   of Stock or Units   Underlying   Awards   Grant Date   and Option
Name   Date(1)   (#)(2)   Options (#)(2)   ($/Sh)   ($)   Awards ($)(3)
Linda G. Alvarado
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
Barry H. Beracha
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
John C. Compton(4)
    04/01/2009                                
 
Ira D. Hall
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
Susan D. Kronick
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
Blythe J. McGarvie
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
John A. Quelch
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
Javier G. Teruel
    04/01/2009       3,166                         70,000  
 
    04/01/2009             9,498       22.11       22.53       51,384  
 
Cynthia M. Trudell(4)
    04/01/2009                                
 
1.   No separate column for “Date of Board Action” appears in this Director Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table since the April 1 grant date for the Directors’ annual equity awards is mandated by the terms of The PBG Directors’ Stock Plan as amended and restated (the “Directors’ Stock Plan”).
 
2.   The 2009 stock awards and option awards were made under the terms of the Directors’ Stock Plan.

119


Table of Contents

3.   The assumptions used in calculating the SFAS 123R grant date fair value of the Option Awards and Stock Awards are set forth in Note 4, Share-Based Compensation, to this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
4.   Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell each waived receipt of their annual equity awards.
Narrative to the Director Compensation Table and Director Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
          The compensation paid to our non-employee Directors in 2009 is reflected in the table above entitled Director Compensation In Fiscal Year 2009. Management Directors do not receive additional compensation or benefits for serving on the Board of Directors.
          Retainers and Fees. During 2009, our Directors received an annual retainer of $70,000 which was paid in quarterly installments. For the year in which a Director commences service, his or her annual retainer is pro-rated on a quarterly basis, beginning with the quarter in which he or she commenced services. Conversely, a Director who ceases to serve as a Director will not receive a quarterly payment for the quarter in which he or she ceases service unless he or she attended a meeting during such quarter.
          During 2009, the Chair of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee received an additional $10,000 for her service and each of the Chairs for the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee and the Compensation and Management Development Committee received an additional $15,000. Committee Chair fees are pro-rated depending on length of service as Chair during the year. Committee Chairs receive their first quarterly payment in the quarter following the quarter in which they were appointed Chair. An exiting Chair receives a quarterly payment for any quarter during which he or she served any portion as Chair. Mr. Teruel, who served as the Lead Director, received an additional annual retainer of $30,000.
          Committee members also receive fees of $1,500 for each formal meeting in which the Committee member participated (in person or by telephone).
          During 2009, Directors could elect to defer receipt of all or a portion of their annual cash compensation under the PBG Director Deferral Program (“Director Deferral Program”) for a minimum period of one year. Under this Director Deferral Plan, amounts deferred by our Directors are recorded in book accounts that are deemed invested in our common stock and dividend equivalents credited to such common stock are similarly deemed to be invested in our common stock. Deferred amounts are paid out in a lump sum cash payment on the date specified by the Director or upon the Director’s death, if earlier. One of our directors participates in this program as reflected in the Director Compensation Table.
          In April 2009, the Company formed a Special Committee comprised solely of independent Directors to consider the proposal received by PepsiCo to acquire all of the outstanding shares of the Company not already owned by PepsiCo. Ms. Kronick, Ms. McGarvie and Messrs. Beracha and Teruel received an annual cash retainer of $20,000 for serving as members of the Company’s Special Committee, and Mr. Hall, who served as Chair of the Special Committee, received $35,000. Special Committee members also received fees of $1,500 for each formal meeting in which the member participated (in person or by telephone).
          Equity Awards. All equity awards to our non-employee Directors are made pursuant to the terms of the Directors’ Stock Plan which was approved by shareholders in May 2001. The Directors’ Stock Plan expressly sets forth the material terms relating to all equity awards available to our Directors, including specific grant dates and award values.
          Initial Grant of Restricted Shares. Under the Directors’ Stock Plan, a new Board member receives a one-time grant of $25,000 in restricted shares of PBG common stock (“Restricted Shares”) upon joining the Board. This grant vests on the first anniversary of the grant date and the Director may elect to defer receipt of the Restricted Shares until he or she leaves the Board. The amount shown for Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell in the “Stock Awards” column reflects the compensation expense recognized for the Restricted Shares granted to each of them upon their joining the Board in 2008. Mr. Compton’s award vested in April 2009 and Ms. Trudell’s award vested in June 2009.
          Annual Grant of Restricted Stock Units and Stock Options. The Directors’ Stock Plan also provides for annual equity grants to our Directors on April 1 of each year. The 2009 annual equity grants were comprised of RSUs with a value of $70,000 and stock options with a face value of $210,000. The annual award amounts are pro-rated to the extent a Director commences services as a Director after April 1. Generally, no award is payable to a Director who does not stand for re-election. Also, PepsiCo Board designates typically elect to waive the annual grant of restricted stock and stock options.
          On April 1, 2009, each of our Directors, with the exception of Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell (each, a PepsiCo Board designate), received an annual grant of RSUs with a value of $70,000. The number of RSUs granted was determined by dividing $70,000 by the “Fair Market Value” (as defined in the Directors’ Stock Plan) of PBG common stock on the grant date, rounded up to the nearest whole share. The Directors’ Stock Plan defines Fair Market Value as the average of the high and low sales price for PBG common stock as reported on the NYSE on the grant date. Since our definition of Fair Market Value differs from that established under SEC regulations, we have included the “Closing Market Price on Grant Date” column in the Director Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table above as required by SEC regulations. The RSUs vest immediately and are credited with dividend equivalents in the

120


Table of Contents

form of additional RSUs at the same time and in the same amount as dividends are paid to our shareholders. RSUs are settled in shares of PBG common stock. Directors were given an opportunity to defer payment of their RSUs until such time as they elect, subject to a minimum deferral period of two years. Notwithstanding any Director’s deferral election, all RSUs shall be immediately payable upon a Director’s separation from service for any reason (including death and “Disability,” as defined in the Directors’ Stock Plan).
          Our Directors, with the exception of Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell, received an annual grant of options to purchase PBG common stock with a face value of $210,000 on April 1, 2009. The number of options granted was determined by dividing $210,000 by the exercise price of the stock options. The exercise price is equal to the Fair Market Value of PBG common stock on the grant date, rounded to the nearest penny. Under the terms of the Directors’ Stock Plan, these options vested immediately and remain exercisable until the earlier of the tenth anniversary of the grant date or five years from the recipient’s termination of services as a Director (the full ten-year term also applies in the case of death or Disability).
          All Other Compensation. Our Directors are eligible to participate in the Company’s charitable gift match program on the same basis as all Company employees. Under this program, certain charitable donations of up to an annual, aggregate maximum of $10,000 are matched on a one-for-one basis or, if the Director serves on the board of the recipient charitable institution, on a two-for-one basis. The amount of the Company match for each Director is reflected in the “All Other Compensation” column of the Director Compensation Table. In addition, in certain circumstances, limited perquisites and personal benefits may be provided by the Company to our Directors. Tax reimbursements related to these Company-provided perquisites and personal benefits may be provided in these limited circumstances. In 2009, perquisites and personal benefits were provided to our Directors in connection with nominal recognition awards which are reflected in the “All Other Compensation” column of the Director Compensation Table. Directors do not receive any other compensation except as discussed above, nor do they receive retirement, health or life insurance benefits.
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation
          During fiscal year 2009, the following individuals served as members of our Compensation and Management Development Committee: Barry H. Beracha, Ira D. Hall, Susan D. Kronick and John A. Quelch. None of these individuals has ever served as an officer or employee of PBG or any of our subsidiaries. No member of the Compensation and Management Development Committee has any interlocking relationship requiring disclosure under the rules of the SEC.
The Compensation Committee Report
          The Compensation and Management Development Committee reviewed and discussed the Compensation Discussion and Analysis with management and, based on that review and discussion, the Compensation and Management Development Committee recommended to our Board of Directors that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Respectfully submitted,
The Compensation and Management Development Committee
Ira D. Hall (Chairperson)
Barry H. Beracha
Susan D. Kronick
John A. Quelch

121


Table of Contents

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans
          The table below sets forth certain information as of December 26, 2009, the last day of the fiscal year, for (i) all equity compensation plans previously approved by our shareholders and (ii) all equity compensation plans not previously approved by our shareholders.
                         
                    Number of securities
                    remaining available for
    Number of securities   Weighted-average   future issuance under
    to be issued upon exercise   exercise price of   equity compensation plans
    of outstanding options,   outstanding options,   (excluding securities
Plan Category   warrants and rights   warrants and rights   reflected in column (a))
 
  (a)   (b)   (c)
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders
    27,787,430 (1)     22.36       9,527,880  
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
    315,314 (2)     22.84          
Total
    28,102,744       22.36       9,527,880 (3)
 
(1)   The securities reflected in this category are authorized for issuance (i) upon exercise of awards granted under the Directors’ Stock Plan and the 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan and (ii) upon exercise of awards granted prior to May 26, 2004 under the following PBG plans: (A) 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan; (B) 2000 Long-Term Incentive Plan and (C) 2002 Long-Term Incentive Plan. Effective May 26, 2004, no securities were available for future issuance under the 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan, the 2000 Long-Term Incentive Plan or the 2002 Long-Term Incentive Plan.
 
(2)   The securities reflected in this category are authorized for issuance upon exercise of awards granted prior to May 26, 2004 under the PBG Stock Incentive Plan (the “SIP”). Effective May 26, 2004, no securities were available for future issuance under the SIP.
 
(3)   The 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan and the Directors’ Stock Plan, both of which have been approved by our shareholders, are the only equity compensation plans that provide securities remaining available for future issuance.
          Description of the PBG Stock Incentive Plan. Effective May 26, 2004, no securities were available for future issuance under the SIP. The SIP is a non-shareholder approved, broad-based plan that was adopted by our Board of Directors on March 30, 1999. No grants, other than stock option awards, have been made under the SIP. All stock options were granted to select groups of non-management employees with an exercise price equal to the fair market value of our common stock on the grant date. The options generally become exercisable three years from the date of grant and have a ten-year term. At year-end 2009, options covering 315,314 shares of our common stock were outstanding under the SIP. The SIP is filed as Exhibit 10.11 to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 25, 1999 and qualifies this summary in its entirety.
Security Ownership
          Stock Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners. Based on the most recent Schedule 13G filings, shareholders holding more than 5% of our common stock as of February 12, 2010 are:
                         
            Number of    
            Shares        
Name and Address   Title of   Beneficially   Percent
Of Beneficial Owner   Class   Owned   of Class
PepsiCo, Inc.(1)
  Class B Common Stock     100,000       100 %
700 Anderson Hill Road
Purchase, NY 10577
  Common Stock     70,066,458       31.6 %(2)
 
(1)   PepsiCo reported its beneficial ownership on a Schedule 13G/A filed with the SEC on February 9, 2009. PepsiCo has sole voting power and sole dispositive power for all shares of our common stock and Class B common stock beneficially owned by PepsiCo.
 
(2)   Percentage is calculated based upon the number of outstanding shares of our common stock as of February 12, 2010.

122


Table of Contents

          Ownership of Common Stock by Directors and Executive Officers. The following table shows, as of February 12, 2010, the shares of our common stock beneficially owned by (i) each director and director nominee, (ii) each Named Executive Officer, and (iii) all directors and executive officers as a group. Except as otherwise noted, each of the following persons has sole voting or investment power with respect to the shares of common stock beneficially owned by him or her.
                                 
    Number of                
    Shares                
    Beneficially   Deferral           Percent of
Name of Individual   Owned   Plans(1)   Total   Class
Linda G. Alvarado
    36,212       9,831       46,043       *  
Barry H. Beracha
    31,475       6,205       37,680       *  
John C. Compton
    0       759       759 (2)     *  
Victor L. Crawford
    142,047       0       142,047 (3)(4)     *  
Alfred H. Drewes
    59,001       0       59,001 (4)     *  
Eric J. Foss
    319,359       0       319,359 (4)     *  
Ira D. Hall
    34,648       6,839       41,487       *  
Robert C. King
    77,951       0       77,951 (4)     *  
Susan D. Kronick
    44,436       8,639       53,075       *  
Blythe J. McGarvie
    30,369       9,096       39,465       *  
Yiannis Petrides
    160,290       0       160,290 (4)     *  
John A. Quelch
    30,769       10,437       41,206       *  
Javier G. Teruel
    26,669       0       26,669       *  
Cynthia M. Trudell
    0       804       804 (2)     *  
All directors and all executive officers as a group (16 persons)
    1,142,765       52,610       1,195,375       *  
 
*   Less than 1%
 
(1)   Reflects PBG phantom stock units and restricted stock units deferred under deferred compensation arrangements that will be settled in shares of PBG common stock on a one-for-one basis.
 
(2)   Mr. Compton and Ms. Trudell each disclaim any beneficial ownership that he or she may have in PepsiCo’s shares of our common stock and Class B common stock.
 
(3)   The shares shown for Mr. Crawford include 1,600 shares over which Mr. Crawford shares voting power with his spouse.
 
(4)   Includes shares of our common stock that our executive officers will have the right to acquire within 60 days of February 12, 2010 through the exercise of stock options as follows: Victor L. Crawford, 51,203 shares; Alfred H. Drewes, 57,393 shares; Eric J. Foss, 270,432 shares; Robert C. King, 62,681 shares; Yiannis Petrides, 57,393 shares; and all directors and executive officers as a group, 590,930 shares.
          Stock Ownership Guidelines. Our stock ownership guidelines call for key senior executives to own our common stock (or deferral plan units) ranging from 15,000 shares for certain executives and up to 175,000 shares for our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer. The stock ownership goal must be reached by no later than January 2012 for our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and for the other executives, within five years of their election or appointment. Annual requirements equal to 20% of the total number of shares required must also be met during the five-year period. Our Board maintains a mandatory holding policy for stock options and restricted stock pursuant to which each of our executive officers is expected to retain 20% of his shares of our common stock acquired upon the exercise of stock options and vesting of restricted stock until such executive officer satisfies our stock ownership guidelines described above.
          In addition, our Board amended our Corporate Governance Principles and Practices in 2006 to include stock ownership guidelines for non-employee directors. The stock ownership guidelines call for non-employee directors to own 6,000 shares of common stock within five years of their election to our Board. Outstanding stock options are not counted towards the satisfaction of the ownership guidelines for either executives or directors. All of our executive officers and non-employee directors have met or exceeded their annual stock ownership guideline requirements.

123


Table of Contents

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
          Stock Ownership and Director Relationships with PepsiCo. We were initially incorporated in January 1999 as a wholly owned subsidiary of PepsiCo to effect the separation of most of PepsiCo’s company-owned bottling businesses. We became a publicly traded company on March 31, 1999. As of January 22, 2010, PepsiCo’s ownership represented 31.6% of our outstanding common stock and 100% of our outstanding Class B common stock, together representing 38.6% of the voting power of all classes of our voting stock. PepsiCo also owns approximately 6.6% of the equity of Bottling Group, LLC, our principal operating subsidiary (“Bottling LLC”). In addition, two of our directors, John C. Compton and Cynthia M. Trudell, are executive officers of PepsiCo.
          Agreements and Transactions with PepsiCo and Affiliates. We and PepsiCo (and certain of its affiliates) have entered into transactions and agreements with one another, incident to our respective businesses, and we and PepsiCo are expected to enter into material transactions and agreements from time to time in the future. As used in this section, “PBG,” “we,” “us” and “our” include PBG and our subsidiaries.
          Material agreements and transactions between PBG and PepsiCo (and certain of its affiliates) during 2009 are described below.
          Merger Agreement. On August 3, 2009, PBG and PepsiCo entered into a definitive merger agreement, under which PepsiCo will acquire all outstanding shares of PBG common stock it does not already own for the price of $36.50 in cash or 0.6432 shares of PepsiCo common stock, subject to proration such that the aggregate consideration to be paid to PBG shareholders shall be 50 percent in cash and 50 percent in PepsiCo common stock. At a special meeting of our shareholders held on February 17, 2010, our shareholders adopted the merger agreement. The transaction is subject to certain regulatory approvals and is expected to be finalized by the end of the first quarter of 2010.
          Beverage Agreements and Purchases of Concentrates and Finished Products. We purchase concentrates from PepsiCo and manufacture, package, distribute and sell carbonated and non-carbonated beverages under license agreements with PepsiCo. These agreements give us the right to manufacture, sell and distribute beverage products of PepsiCo in both bottles and cans and fountain syrup in specified territories. The agreements also provide PepsiCo with the ability to set prices of such concentrates, as well as the terms of payment and other terms and conditions under which we purchase such concentrates. In addition, we bottle water under the Aquafina trademark pursuant to an agreement with PepsiCo, which provides for the payment of a royalty fee to PepsiCo. In certain instances, we purchase finished beverage products from PepsiCo. During 2009, total payments by PBG to PepsiCo for concentrates, royalties and finished beverage products that were recognized in cost of goods sold were approximately $2.6 billion.
          There are certain manufacturing cooperatives whose assets, liabilities and results of operations are consolidated in our financial statements. Concentrate purchases from PepsiCo by these cooperatives for 2009 were $144 million.
          Transactions with Joint Ventures in which PepsiCo holds an equity interest. We purchase tea concentrate and finished beverage products from the Pepsi/Lipton Tea Partnership, a joint venture of Pepsi-Cola North America, a division of PepsiCo, and Lipton. During 2009, total payments to PepsiCo for the benefit of the Pepsi/Lipton Tea Partnership that were recognized in cost of goods sold were approximately $300 million.
          We purchase finished beverage products from the North American Coffee Partnership, a joint venture of Pepsi-Cola North America and Starbucks in which PepsiCo has a 50% interest. During 2009, total payments to the North American Coffee Partnership by us that were recognized in cost of goods sold were approximately $275 million.
          Under tax sharing arrangements we have with PepsiCo and PepsiCo joint ventures, we received approximately $1 million in tax related benefits in 2009.
          In 2008, together with PepsiCo, we completed a joint acquisition of JSC Lebedyansky (“Lebedyansky”) for approximately $1.8 billion. Lebedyansky was acquired 58.3% by PepsiCo and 41.7% by PR Beverages Limited. We and PepsiCo have an ownership interest in PR Beverages Limited of 60% and 40%, respectively. As a result, PepsiCo and we have acquired a 75% and 25% economic stake in Lebedyansky, respectively.
          During the first quarter of 2009, we issued a ruble-denominated three-year note with an interest rate of 10.0% to Lebedyansky valued at $73 million at December 26, 2009. This funding was contemplated as part of the initial capitalization of the purchase of Lebedyansky between PepsiCo and us.
          As a result of the formation of PR Beverages Limited, our Russian venture with PepsiCo, PepsiCo has agreed to contribute a note payable of $83 million plus accrued interest to the venture to be settled in the form of property, plant and equipment. During 2009, PepsiCo has contributed $24 million in regards to this note.

124


Table of Contents

          Purchase of Frito-Lay Snack Food Products. Pursuant to a Distribution Agreement between PR Beverages and Frito-Lay Manufacturing, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of PepsiCo, PR Beverages purchases snack food products from Frito-Lay Manufacturing for sale and distribution through Russia. In 2009, amounts paid or payable by PR Beverages to Frito-Lay Manufacturing were approximately $350 million. Net fees associated with the sale of the Frito product after selling, delivery and administrative costs were $14 million.
          Shared Services. PepsiCo provides various services to us pursuant to a shared services agreement and other arrangements, including information technology maintenance and the procurement of raw materials. During 2009, amounts paid or payable to PepsiCo for these services totaled approximately $52 million. Pursuant to the shared services agreement and other arrangements, we provide various services to PepsiCo, including credit and collection, international tax and supplier services. During 2009, payments to us from PepsiCo for these services totaled approximately $4 million.
          Rental Payments. Amounts paid or payable by PepsiCo to us for rental of office space at certain of our facilities were approximately $3 million in 2009.
          National Fountain Services. We provide certain manufacturing, delivery and equipment maintenance services to PepsiCo’s national fountain customers in specified territories. In 2009, net amounts paid or payable by PepsiCo to us for these services were approximately $205 million.
          Bottler Incentives. PepsiCo provides us with marketing support in the form of bottler incentives. The level of this support is negotiated annually and can be increased or decreased at the discretion of PepsiCo. These bottler incentives are intended to cover a variety of programs and initiatives, including direct marketplace support (including point-of-sale materials) and advertising support. For 2009, total bottler incentives received from PepsiCo, including media costs shared by PepsiCo, were approximately $623 million.
          Bottling Group, LLC Distribution. PepsiCo has approximately a 6.6% ownership interest in Bottling LLC, our principal operating subsidiary. In accordance with Bottling LLC’s Limited Liability Company Agreement, PepsiCo received a $30 million cash distribution from Bottling LLC in 2009.
          Review and Approval of Transactions with PepsiCo. The Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee is responsible for reviewing and approving transactions between us and PepsiCo, or any entity in which PepsiCo has a 20% or greater interest, that are outside the ordinary course of business and have a value of more than $10 million. This policy is embodied in the charter of the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee. None of the transactions described above involving PepsiCo or its affiliates, other than the PepsiCo merger agreement, required the review, approval or ratification of the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee because the transactions were not outside the ordinary course of business.
          Relationships and Transactions with Management and Others. Linda G. Alvarado, a member of our Board of Directors, together with certain of her family members, wholly own interests in several YUM Brands franchise restaurant companies that purchase beverage products from us. In 2009, the total amount of these purchases was approximately $525,000.
          Review and Approval of Transactions Involving our Management and Others. We have procedures to determine whether any related-person transaction impairs the independence of a director or presents a conflict of interest on the part of a director or executive officer. In 2007, the Board adopted a written Policy and Procedures Governing Related-Person Transactions that requires our Audit Committee to review and approve any transaction or series of transactions with related persons where the aggregate amount involved exceeds $120,000 in any calendar year. The policy is posted on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance.
          Under the policy, a “related person” includes:
    any person who is or was an executive officer, director or director nominee (since the beginning of the last fiscal year);
 
    a 5% or more beneficial owner of our voting securities; and
 
    immediate family members of the people listed above.
          We annually require each of our directors and executive officers to complete a questionnaire that elicits information about related-person transactions. Our Audit Committee must review the material facts of any related-person transaction and approve or ratify such transaction. In determining whether to approve or disapprove a related-person transaction, our Audit Committee should consider all material factors, including without limitation:

125


Table of Contents

    the extent of the related person’s interest in the transaction;
 
    if applicable, the availability of other sources of comparable products or services;
 
    whether the terms of the transaction are no less favorable than terms generally available in unaffiliated transactions under like circumstances;
 
    the benefit to us; and
 
    the aggregate value of the transaction.
          The transaction described above involving Ms. Alvarado was ratified by the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee pursuant to this policy.
Director Independence
          In December 2008, our Board adopted a revised Director Independence Policy that sets forth the standards for determining the independence of each member of our Board, which standards are consistent with the applicable rules of the NYSE and SEC. Each director affirmatively determined by our Board to have met the standards set forth in our Director Independence Policy is referred to herein as an independent director. The PBG Director Independence Policy can be found on our website at www.pbg.com under Investor Relations — Company Information — Corporate Governance. Our Board has determined that the following directors are independent: Linda G. Alvarado, Barry H. Beracha, Ira D. Hall, Susan D. Kronick, Blythe J. McGarvie, John A. Quelch and Javier G. Teruel.
          In assessing the independence of our directors, our Board carefully considered all of the business relationships between PBG and our directors or their affiliated companies. This review was based primarily on responses of the directors to questions in a questionnaire regarding employment, business, familial, compensation and other relationships with our company and our management. Where business relationships existed, the Board determined that none of the relationships between our company and the directors or the directors’ affiliated companies impair the directors’ independence because the amounts involved are immaterial to the directors or to those companies when compared to their annual income or gross revenues. The Board also determined for all of the relationships between our company and our directors or the directors’ affiliated companies, that none of the relationships would interfere with the director’s impartial judgment as a director of PBG.
          The business relationships between PBG and our directors or the directors’ affiliated companies that were considered by the Board were:
    The sale by PBG of approximately $18,000 worth of beverage products to Macy’s, Inc., of which Susan D. Kronick is Vice Chair, in 2009; and
 
    The relationship between PBG and Linda G. Alvarado, which is described in the section above entitled “Relationships and Transactions with Management and Others.”

126


Table of Contents

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
          Deloitte & Touche LLP has served as our independent registered public accounting firm since June 2005. In addition to retaining independent accountants to audit our consolidated financial statements for 2009, we and our affiliates retained Deloitte & Touche LLP, as well as other accounting firms, to provide various services in 2009. The aggregate fees billed for professional services by Deloitte & Touche LLP in 2008 and 2009 were as follows:
Audit and Non-Audit Fees
(in millions)
                 
    2009   2008
Audit Fees(1)
  $ 5.9     $ 5.8  
Audit-Related Fees(2)
  $ 1.1     $ 0.8  
Tax Fees(3)
  $ 1.2     $ 0.4  
All Other Fees
  $ 0.0     $ 0.0  
             
Total
  $ 8.2     $ 7.0  
             
 
(1)   Represents fees for the audit of our consolidated financial statements, audit of internal controls, the reviews of interim financial statements included in our Forms 10-Q and all statutory audits.
 
(2)   Represents fees primarily related to audits of employee benefit plans and other audit-related services.
 
(3)   Represents fees primarily related to assistance with tax compliance and consultation matters.
          Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures. We have a policy that defines audit, audit-related and non-audit services to be provided to us by our independent registered public accounting firm and requires such services to be pre-approved by the Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee. In accordance with our policy and applicable SEC rules and regulations, the Committee or its Chairperson pre-approves such services provided to us. Pre-approval is detailed as to the particular service or category of services. If the services are required prior to a regularly scheduled Committee meeting, the Committee Chairperson is authorized to approve such services, provided that they are consistent with our policy and applicable SEC rules and regulations, and that the full Committee is advised of such services at the next regularly scheduled Committee meeting. The independent accountants and management periodically report to the Committee regarding the extent of the services provided by the independent accountants in accordance with this pre-approval, and the fees for the services performed to date. The Audit and Affiliated Transactions Committee pre-approved all audit and non-audit fees of Deloitte & Touche LLP billed for fiscal years 2009 and 2008.

127


Table of Contents

PART IV
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a) 1. Financial Statements. The following consolidated financial statements of PBG and its subsidiaries are included herein:
Consolidated Statements of Operations — Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows — Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007.
Consolidated Balance Sheets — December 26, 2009 and December 27, 2008.
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity — Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) — Fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
2. Financial Statement Schedules. The following financial statement schedule of PBG and its subsidiaries is included in this Report on the page indicated:
     
    Page
 
Schedule II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for the fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007
  131
3. Exhibits
See Index to Exhibits on pages 132 — 135.

128


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES
          Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
Dated: February 22, 2010
         
  The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
 
 
  /s/ Eric J. Foss    
  Eric J. Foss   
  Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer   
 
          Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc. and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
         
SIGNATURE   TITLE   DATE
 
       
/s/ Eric J. Foss
 
Eric J. Foss
  Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)   February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Alfred H. Drewes
 
Alfred H. Drewes
  Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
  February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Thomas M. Lardieri
 
Thomas M. Lardieri
  Vice President and Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)
  February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Linda G. Alvarado
 
Linda G. Alvarado
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Barry H. Beracha
 
Barry H. Beracha
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ John C. Compton
 
John C. Compton
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Ira D. Hall
 
Ira D. Hall
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Susan D. Kronick
 
Susan D. Kronick
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Blythe J. McGarvie
 
Blythe J. McGarvie
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ John A. Quelch
 
John A. Quelch
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Javier G. Teruel
 
Javier G. Teruel
  Director    February 22, 2010
 
       
/s/ Cynthia M. Trudell
 
Cynthia M. Trudell
  Director    February 22, 2010

129


Table of Contents

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
         
    Page  
Schedule II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for the fiscal years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007
    131  

130


Table of Contents

Schedule Of Valuation And Qualifying Accounts Disclosure
SCHEDULE II — VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS THE PEPSI BOTTLING GROUP, INC.
                                         
    Balance at   Charges to   Accounts   Foreign   Balance at
    Beginning   Cost and   Written   Currency   End of
In millions   of Period   Expenses   Off   Translation   Period
Fiscal Year Ended December 26, 2009
                                       
Allowance for losses on trade accounts receivable
  $ 71     $ 11     $ (13 )   $     $ 69  
Fiscal Year Ended December 27, 2008
                                       
Allowance for losses on trade accounts receivable
  $ 54     $ 30     $ (9 )   $ (4 )   $ 71  
Fiscal Year Ended December 29, 2007
                                       
Allowance for losses on trade accounts receivable
  $ 50     $ 11     $ (10 )   $ 3     $ 54  

131


Table of Contents

Index to Exhibits
     
EXHIBIT NO.   DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT
 
   
2.1
  Agreement and Plan of Merger dated as of August 3, 2009 among PepsiCo, Inc., PBG and Pepsi-Cola Metropolitan Bottling Company, Inc., which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to PBG’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 3, 2009.
 
   
3.1
  Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of PBG, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 14, 2008.
 
   
3.2
  By-Laws of PBG, which are incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
3.3
  Amendments to By-Laws of PBG effective as of May 18, 2009, which are incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to PBG’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 18, 2009.
 
   
4.1
  Form of common stock certificate, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
4.2
  Indenture dated as of March 8, 1999 by and among PBG, as obligor, Bottling Group, LLC, as guarantor, and The Chase Manhattan Bank, as trustee, relating to $1,000,000,000 7% Series B Senior Notes due 2029, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
4.3
  Indenture dated as of November 15, 2002 among Bottling Group, LLC, PepsiCo, Inc., as guarantor, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as trustee, relating to $1,000,000,000 4 5/8% Senior Notes due November 15, 2012, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 28, 2002.
 
   
4.4
  Registration Rights Agreement dated as of November 7, 2002 relating to the $1,000,000,000 4 5/8% Senior Notes due November 15, 2012, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to Bottling Group LLC’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 28, 2002.
 
   
4.5
  Indenture, dated as of June 10, 2003 by and between Bottling Group, LLC, as obligor, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as trustee, relating to $250,000,000 4 1/8% Senior Notes due June 15, 2015, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s registration statement on Form S-4 (Registration No. 333-106285).
 
   
4.6
  Registration Rights Agreement dated June 10, 2003 by and among Bottling Group, LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Lehman Brothers Inc., Banc of America Securities LLC, Citigroup Global Markets Inc, Credit Suisse First Boston LLC, Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Blaylock & Partners, L.P. and Fleet Securities, Inc, relating to $250,000,000 4 1/8% Senior Notes due June 15, 2015, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Bottling Group, LLC’s registration statement on Form S-4 (Registration No. 333-106285).
 
   
4.7
  Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2003, by and between Bottling Group, LLC, as obligor, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as trustee, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 3, 2003.
 
   
4.8
  Form of Note for the $400,000,000 5.00% Senior Notes due November 15, 2013, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 13, 2003.
 
   
4.9
  Indenture, dated as of March 30, 2006, by and between Bottling Group, LLC, as obligor, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as trustee, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 25, 2006.
 
   
4.10
  Form of Note for the $800,000,000 5 1/2% Senior Notes due April 1, 2016, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 25, 2006.
 
   
4.11
  Indenture, dated as of October 24, 2008, by and among Bottling Group, LLC, as obligor, PepsiCo, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, relating to $1,300,000,000 6.95% Senior Notes due March 15, 2014, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 21, 2008.
 
   
4.12
  Form of Note for the $1,300,000,000 6.95% Senior Notes due March 15, 2014, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 21, 2008.
 
   
4.13
  Form of Note for the $750,000,000 5.125% Senior Notes due January 15, 2019, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 14, 2009.
 
   
10.1
  Form of Master Bottling Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.2
  Form of Master Syrup Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).

132


Table of Contents

     
EXHIBIT NO.   DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT
 
   
10.3
  Form of Non-Cola Bottling Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.4
  Form of Separation Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.5
  Form of Shared Services Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.6
  Form of Tax Separation Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.7
  Form of Employee Programs Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to PBG’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-70291).
 
   
10.8
  PBG 1999 Long-Term Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 25, 1999.
 
   
10.9
  PBG Stock Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 25, 1999.
 
   
10.10
  PBG Executive Income Deferral Program as amended, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 30, 2000.
 
   
10.11
  PBG Long Term Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 30, 2000.
 
   
10.12
  2002 PBG Long-Term Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 28, 2002.
 
   
10.13
  Form of Mexican Master Bottling Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 28, 2002.
 
   
10.14
  Form of Employee Restricted Stock Agreement under the PBG 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 4, 2004.
 
   
10.15
  Form of Employee Stock Option Agreement under the PBG 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 4, 2004.
 
   
10.16
  Form of Non-Employee Director Annual Stock Option Agreement under the PBG Directors’ Stock Plan which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 4, 2004.
 
   
10.17
  Form of Non-Employee Director Restricted Stock Agreement under the PBG Directors’ Stock Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 4, 2004.
 
   
10.18
  Summary of the material terms of the PBG Executive Incentive Compensation Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 4, 2004.
 
   
10.19
  Description of the compensation paid by PBG to its non- management directors which is incorporated herein by reference to the Directors’ Compensation section in PBG’s Proxy Statement for the 2009 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.
 
   
10.20
  Form of Director Indemnification, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 11, 2005.
 
   
10.21
  PBG 2005 Executive Incentive Compensation Plan, which is incorporated herein by reference to Appendix A to PBG’s Proxy Statement for the 2005 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.
 
   
10.22
  Form of Employee Restricted Stock Unit Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 3, 2005.
 
   
10.23
  Form of Non-Employee Director Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under the Amended and Restated PBG Directors’ Stock Plan which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005.

133


Table of Contents

     
EXHIBIT NO.   DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT
 
   
10.24
  Private Limited Company Agreement of PR Beverages Limited dated as of March 1, 2007 among PBG Beverages Ireland Limited, PepsiCo (Ireland), Limited and PR Beverages Limited, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 24, 2007.
 
   
10.25
  U.S. $1,200,000,000 First Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of October 19, 2007 among The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc., as borrower; Bottling Group, LLC, as guarantor; Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and HSBC Securities (USA) Inc., as joint lead arrangers and book managers; Citibank, N.A., as agent; HSBC Bank USA, N.A., as syndication agent; and certain other banks identified in the First Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 19, 2007 and filed October 25, 2007.
 
   
10.26
  Distribution Agreement between PBG and the North American Coffee Partnership, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 14, 2008.
 
   
10.27
  Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Bottling Group, LLC, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 14, 2008.
 
   
10.28
  Amendment No. 1 to Bottling Group, LLC’s Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 14, 2008.
 
   
10.29
  Amended and Restated PBG Directors’ Stock Plan effective as of October 2, 2008, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.30
  Amended and Restated PBG 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.31
  PBG Director Deferral Program effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.32
  Amended and Restated PBG Pension Equalization Plan effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.33
  PBG 409A Executive Income Deferral Program as amended effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.34
  Amended and Restated PBG Supplemental Savings Program effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.35
  Distribution Agreement between PepsiCo Holdings LLC and Frito-Lay Manufacturing LLC effective as of January 1, 2009, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to PBG’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2008.
 
   
10.36
  Rights Agreement, dated May 18, 2009, between PBG and Mellon Investor Services LLC, as Rights Agent (“Mellon”), which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 13, 2009.
 
   
10.37
  Amendment No. 1, dated May 18, 2009, to Rights Agreement dated May 4, 2009 between PBG and Mellon, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to PBG’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 13, 2009.
 
   
10.38
  Form of Retention Agreement, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to PBG’s Current Reports on Form 8-K dated May 3, 2009 and to Item 5.02 of PBG’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 18, 2009.
 
   
10.39
  Amendment No. 1, dated as of August 3, 2009, to the Rights Agreement dated as of May 18, 2009, between PBG and Mellon, which is incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to PBG’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 3, 2009.
 
   
12*
  Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
 
   
21*
  Subsidiaries of The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.
 
   
23*
  Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP.
 
   
24*
  Power of Attorney.
 
   
31.1*
  Certification by the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

134


Table of Contents

     
EXHIBIT NO.   DESCRIPTION OF EXHIBIT
 
   
31.2*
  Certification by the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.1*
  Certification by the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.2*
  Certification by the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
101*
  The following financial statements from The Pepsi Bottling Group, Inc.’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the years ended December 26, 2009, December 27, 2008 and December 29, 2007, formatted in Extensive Business Reporting Language (XBRL): (i) Consolidated Statements of Operations, (ii) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, (iii) Consolidated Balance Sheets, (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity, (v) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss), and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, tagged as blocks of text.
 
*   Filed herewith.

135